summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/old
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
Diffstat (limited to 'old')
-rw-r--r--old/26744-8.txt4703
-rw-r--r--old/26744.txt4703
2 files changed, 9406 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/old/26744-8.txt b/old/26744-8.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..89df527
--- /dev/null
+++ b/old/26744-8.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,4703 @@
+The Project Gutenberg EBook of A Retrospect, by James Hudson Taylor
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+Title: A Retrospect
+
+Author: James Hudson Taylor
+
+Release Date: October 1, 2008 [EBook #26744]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ISO-8859-1
+
+*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK A RETROSPECT ***
+
+
+
+
+Produced by Free Elf, Emmy and the Online Distributed
+Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net Music files created
+by Linda Cantoni.(This file was produced from images
+generously made available by The Internet Archive/Canadian
+Libraries) Full-color map generously provided by The
+Missionary E-texts Archive at
+http://www.missionaryetexts.org
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+[Illustration: Signature: J. Hudson Taylor.]
+
+
+
+
+A RETROSPECT
+
+BY
+
+J. HUDSON TAYLOR, M.R.C.S., F.R.G.S.
+
+_Thou shalt remember all the way which the Lord thy God led thee._
+
+THIRD EDITION
+
+ TORONTO
+ CHINA INLAND MISSION
+ 507 CHURCH STREET
+
+[Illustration: THE "LAMMERMUIR" PARTY. _See page 125._]
+
+
+
+
+CONTENTS
+
+ CHAP. PAGE
+ I. THE POWER OF PRAYER 1
+ II. THE CALL TO SERVICE 7
+ III. PREPARATION FOR SERVICE 13
+ IV. FURTHER ANSWERS TO PRAYER 19
+ V. LIFE IN LONDON 24
+ VI. STRENGTHENED BY FAITH 30
+ VII. MIGHTY TO SAVE 35
+ VIII. VOYAGE TO CHINA 39
+ IX. EARLY MISSIONARY EXPERIENCES 45
+ X. FIRST EVANGELISTIC EFFORTS 49
+ XI. WITH THE REV. W. C. BURNS 57
+ XII. THE CALL TO SWATOW 70
+ "The Missionary Call": Words and Music 75
+ XIII. MAN PROPOSES, GOD DISPOSES 77
+ XIV. PROVIDENTIAL GUIDANCE 92
+ XV. SETTLEMENT IN NINGPO 98
+ XVI. TIMELY SUPPLIES 105
+ XVII. GOD A REFUGE FOR US 110
+ XVIII. A NEW AGENCY NEEDED 116
+ XIX. FORMATION OF THE C. I. M. 121
+ XX. THE MISSION IN 1894 126
+ THE MISSION IN 1902 128
+ STATIONS OF THE C. I. M. 131
+
+ * * * * *
+
+ MAP OF CHINA
+
+ SHOWING THE STATIONS OF THE CHINA INLAND MISSION:
+ CORRECTED TO JUNE 1900 _To face page_ 131
+
+
+
+
+ILLUSTRATIONS
+
+
+ 1. Portrait of J. Hudson Taylor _Frontispiece_
+ 2. The "Lammermuir" party _Facing "Contents"_
+ PAGE
+ 3. Honorary banner presented to a missionary 1
+ 4. A heavy road in North China 7
+ 5. Salt junk on the Yang-tsi 13
+ 6. Travelling by mule cart on "the great plain" 19
+ 7. Ch'ung-k'ing, the Yang-tsi, and mountains beyond 24
+ 8. Water gate and Custom house, Soo-chow 29
+ 9. View on the Kwang-sin River 30
+ 10. Temple and memorial portal 34
+ 11. "Compassionate heart, benevolent methods" 35
+ 12. Outside the wall of Gan-k'ing 38
+ 13. The new girls school at Chefoo 39
+ 14. Entrance to the Po-yang lake 44
+ 15. A fair wind, at sunset, on the lake 45
+ 16. A view on the grand canal 49
+ 17. Down the Yang-tsi on a cargo boat 57
+ 18. East gate and sentry box, Bhamô, Burmah 69
+ 19. Farmhouse, with buffalo shed attached 70
+ 20. A fishing village on the lake near Yünnan Fu 77
+ 21. Teng-yueh, the westernmost walled city in China 91
+ 22. A small temple near Wun-chau 92
+ 23. Group of Christians at Lan-k'i, Cheh-kiang 97
+ 24. A boat on the Red River, Tonquin 98
+ 25. Students' quarters, Gan-k'ing Training Home 104
+ 26. A Mandarin's sedan chair 105
+ 27. A presentation banner (a mark of high respect) 110
+ 28. View on the Po-yang lake 116
+ 29. A village on the grand canal 121
+ 30. The battlements of Pekin 126
+ 31. Native woodcut of a landscape 131
+ 32. Elder Liu and wife, Kwei-k'i 136
+
+ The hearty thanks of the Mission for the use of
+ photographs and sketches are hereby tendered to
+ Rev. George Hayes for Nos. 4 and 6; Dr. G.
+ Whitfield Guinness for Nos. 8, 12, 16, 25, and 28;
+ Miss Davies for No. 23; Mr. Thomas Selkirk for
+ Nos. 18 and 21; Mr. J. T. Reid for Nos. 14, 15,
+ and 27; Mr. J. S. Rough for No. 30; Mr. Grainger
+ for No. 19; Mr. E. Murray for No. 13, and also to
+ other friends unknown by name.
+
+
+
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER I
+
+THE POWER OF PRAYER
+
+
+THE following account of some of the experiences which eventually led to
+the formation of the CHINA INLAND MISSION, and to its taking the form in
+which it has been developed, first appeared in the pages of _China's
+Millions_. Many of those who read it there asked that it might appear in
+separate form. Miss Guinness incorporated it in the _Story of the China
+Inland Mission_, a record which contained the account of GOD'S goodness
+to the beginning of 1894. But friends still asking for it in pamphlet
+form, for wider distribution, this edition is brought out.
+
+Much of the material was taken from notes of addresses given in China
+during a conference of our missionaries; this will account for the
+direct and narrative form of the papers, which it has not been thought
+necessary to change.
+
+It is always helpful to us to fix our attention on the GOD-ward aspect
+of Christian work; to realise that the work of GOD does not mean so much
+man's work for GOD, as GOD'S own work through man. Furthermore, in our
+privileged position of fellow-workers with Him, while fully recognising
+all the benefits and blessings to be bestowed on a sin-stricken world
+through the proclamation of the Gospel and spread of the Truth, we
+should never lose sight of the higher aspect of our work--that of
+obedience to GOD, of bringing glory to His Name, of gladdening the
+heart of our GOD and FATHER by living and serving as His beloved
+children.
+
+Many circumstances connected with my own early life and service
+presented this aspect of work vividly to me; and as I think of some of
+them, I am reminded of how much the cause of missions is indebted to
+many who are never themselves permitted to see the mission field--many,
+it may be, who are unable to give largely of their substance, and who
+will be not a little surprised in the Great Day to see how much the work
+has been advanced by their love, their sympathy, and their prayers.
+
+For myself, and for the work that I have been permitted to do for GOD, I
+owe an unspeakable debt of gratitude to my beloved and honoured parents,
+who have passed away and entered into rest, but the influence of whose
+lives will never pass away.
+
+Many years ago, probably about 1830, the heart of my dear father, then
+himself an earnest and successful evangelist at home, was deeply stirred
+as to the spiritual state of China by reading several books, and
+especially an account of the travels of Captain Basil Hall. His
+circumstances were such as to preclude the hope of his ever going to
+China for personal service, but he was led to pray that if GOD should
+give him a son, he might be called and privileged to labour in the vast
+needy empire which was then apparently so sealed against the truth. I
+was not aware of this desire or prayer myself until my return to
+England, more than seven years after I had sailed for China; but it was
+very interesting then to know how prayer offered before my birth had
+been answered in this matter.
+
+All thought of my becoming a missionary was abandoned for many years by
+my dear parents on account of the feebleness of my health. When the
+time came, however, GOD gave increased health, and my life has been
+spared, and strength has been given for not a little toilsome service
+both in the mission field and at home, while many stronger men and women
+have succumbed.
+
+I had many opportunities in early years of learning the value of prayer
+and of the Word of GOD; for it was the delight of my dear parents to
+point out that if there were any such Being as GOD, to trust Him, to
+obey Him, and to be fully given up to His service, must of necessity be
+the best and wisest course both for myself and others. But in spite of
+these helpful examples and precepts my heart was unchanged. Often I had
+tried to make myself a Christian; and failing of course in such efforts,
+I began at last to think that for some reason or other I could not be
+saved, and that the best I could do was to take my fill of this world,
+as there was no hope for me beyond the grave.
+
+While in this state of mind I came in contact with persons holding
+sceptical and infidel views, and accepted their teaching, only too
+thankful for some hope of escape from the doom which, if my parents were
+right and the Bible true, awaited the impenitent. It may seem strange to
+say it, but I have often felt thankful for the experience of this time
+of scepticism. The inconsistencies of Christian people, who while
+professing to believe their Bibles were yet content to live just as they
+would if there were no such book, had been one of the strongest
+arguments of my sceptical companions; and I frequently felt at that
+time, and said, that if I pretended to believe the Bible I would at any
+rate attempt to live by it, putting it fairly to the test, and if it
+failed to prove true and reliable, would throw it overboard altogether.
+These views I retained when the LORD was pleased to bring me to
+Himself; and I think I may say that since then I _have_ put GOD'S Word
+to the test. Certainly it has never failed me. I have never had reason
+to regret the confidence I have placed in its promises, or to deplore
+following the guidance I have found in its directions.
+
+Let me tell you how GOD answered the prayers of my dear mother and of my
+beloved sister, now Mrs. Broomhall, for my conversion. On a day which I
+shall never forget, when I was about fifteen years of age, my dear
+mother being absent from home, I had a holiday, and in the afternoon
+looked through my father's library to find some book with which to while
+away the unoccupied hours. Nothing attracting me, I turned over a little
+basket of pamphlets, and selected from amongst them a Gospel tract which
+looked interesting, saying to myself, "There will be a story at the
+commencement, and a sermon or moral at the close: I will take the former
+and leave the latter for those who like it."
+
+I sat down to read the little book in an utterly unconcerned state of
+mind, believing indeed at the time that if there were any salvation it
+was not for me, and with a distinct intention to put away the tract as
+soon as it should seem prosy. I may say that it was not uncommon in
+those days to call conversion "becoming serious"; and judging by the
+faces of some of its professors, it appeared to be a very serious matter
+indeed. Would it not be well if the people of GOD had always tell-tale
+faces, evincing the blessings and gladness of salvation so clearly that
+unconverted people might have to call conversion "becoming joyful"
+instead of "becoming serious"?
+
+Little did I know at the time what was going on in the heart of my dear
+mother, seventy or eighty miles away. She rose from the dinner-table
+that afternoon with an intense yearning for the conversion of her boy,
+and feeling that--absent from home, and having more leisure than she
+could otherwise secure--a special opportunity was afforded her of
+pleading with GOD on my behalf. She went to her room and turned the key
+in the door, resolved not to leave that spot until her prayers were
+answered. Hour after hour did that dear mother plead for me, until at
+length she could pray no longer, but was constrained to praise GOD for
+that which His SPIRIT taught her had already been accomplished--the
+conversion of her only son.
+
+I in the meantime had been led in the way I have mentioned to take up
+this little tract, and while reading it was struck with the sentence,
+"The finished work of CHRIST." The thought passed through my mind, "Why
+does the author use this expression? why not say the atoning or
+propitiatory work of CHRIST?" Immediately the words "It is finished"
+suggested themselves to my mind. What was finished? And I at once
+replied, "A full and perfect atonement and satisfaction for sin: the
+debt was paid by the Substitute; CHRIST died for our sins, and not for
+ours only, but also for the sins of the whole world." Then came the
+thought, "If the whole work was finished and the whole debt paid, what
+is there left for me to do?" And with this dawned the joyful conviction,
+as light was flashed into my soul by the HOLY SPIRIT, that there was
+nothing in the world to be done but to fall down on one's knees, and
+accepting this SAVIOUR and His salvation, to praise Him for evermore.
+Thus while my dear mother was praising GOD on her knees in her chamber,
+I was praising Him in the old warehouse to which I had gone alone to
+read at my leisure this little book.
+
+Several days elapsed ere I ventured to make my beloved sister the
+confidante of my joy, and then only after she had promised not to tell
+any one of my soul secret. When our dear mother came home a fortnight
+later, I was the first to meet her at the door, and to tell her I had
+such glad news to give. I can almost feel that dear mother's arms around
+my neck, as she pressed me to her bosom and said, "I know, my boy; I
+have been rejoicing for a fortnight in the glad tidings you have to tell
+me." "Why," I asked in surprise, "has Amelia broken her promise? She
+said she would tell no one." My dear mother assured me that it was not
+from any human source that she had learned the tidings, and went on to
+tell the little incident mentioned above. You will agree with me that it
+would be strange indeed if I were not a believer in the power of prayer.
+
+Nor was this all. Some little time after, I picked up a pocket-book
+exactly like one of my own, and thinking that it was mine, opened it.
+The lines that caught my eye were an entry in the little diary, which
+belonged to my sister, to the effect that she would give herself daily
+to prayer until GOD should answer in the conversion of her brother.
+Exactly one month later the LORD was pleased to turn me from darkness to
+light.
+
+Brought up in such a circle and saved under such circumstances, it was
+perhaps natural that from the commencement of my Christian life I was
+led to feel that the promises were very real, and that prayer was in
+sober matter of fact transacting business with GOD, whether on one's own
+behalf or on behalf of those for whom one sought His blessing.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II
+
+THE CALL TO SERVICE
+
+
+THE first joys of conversion passed away after a time, and were
+succeeded by a period of painful deadness of soul, with much conflict.
+But this also came to an end, leaving a deepened sense of personal
+weakness and dependence on the LORD as the only KEEPER as well as
+SAVIOUR of His people. How sweet to the soul, wearied and disappointed
+in its struggles with sin, is the calm repose of trust in the SHEPHERD
+of Israel.
+
+Not many months after my conversion, having a leisure afternoon, I
+retired to my own chamber to spend it largely in communion with GOD.
+Well do I remember that occasion. How in the gladness of my heart I
+poured out my soul before GOD; and again and again confessing my
+grateful love to Him who had done everything for me--who had saved me
+when I had given up all hope and even desire for salvation--I besought
+Him to give me some work to do for Him, as an outlet for love and
+gratitude; some self-denying service, no matter what it might be,
+however trying or however trivial; something with which He would be
+pleased, and that I might do for Him who had done so much for me. Well
+do I remember, as in unreserved consecration I put myself, my life, my
+friends, my all, upon the altar, the deep solemnity that came over my
+soul with the assurance that my offering was accepted. The presence of
+GOD became unutterably real and blessed; and though but a child under
+sixteen, I remember stretching myself on the ground, and lying there
+silent before Him with unspeakable awe and unspeakable joy.
+
+For what service I was accepted I knew not; but a deep consciousness
+that I was no longer my own took possession of me, which has never since
+been effaced. It has been a very practical consciousness. Two or three
+years later propositions of an unusually favourable nature were made to
+me with regard to medical study, on the condition of my becoming
+apprenticed to the medical man who was my friend and teacher. But I felt
+I dared not accept any binding engagement such as was suggested. I was
+not my own to give myself away; for I knew not when or how He whose
+alone I was, and for whose disposal I felt I must ever keep myself free,
+might call for service.
+
+Within a few months of this time of consecration the impression was
+wrought into my soul that it was in China the LORD wanted me. It seemed
+to me highly probable that the work to which I was thus called might
+cost my life; for China was not then open as it is now. But few
+missionary societies had at that time workers in China, and but few
+books on the subject of China missions were accessible to me. I learned,
+however, that the Congregational minister of my native town possessed a
+copy of Medhurst's _China_, and I called upon him to ask a loan of the
+book. This he kindly granted, asking me why I wished to read it. I told
+him that GOD had called me to spend my life in missionary service in
+that land. "And how do you propose to go there?" he inquired. I answered
+that I did not at all know; that it seemed to me probable that I should
+need to do as the Twelve and the Seventy had done in Judæa--go without
+purse or scrip, relying on Him who had called me to supply all my need.
+Kindly placing his hand upon my shoulder, the minister replied, "Ah, my
+boy, as you grow older you will get wiser than that. Such an idea would
+do very well in the days when CHRIST Himself was on earth, but not now."
+
+I have grown older since then, but not wiser. I am more than ever
+convinced that if we were to take the directions of our MASTER and the
+assurances He gave to His first disciples more fully as our guide, we
+should find them to be just as suited to our times as to those in which
+they were originally given.
+
+Medhurst's book on China emphasised the value of medical missions there,
+and this directed my attention to medical studies as a valuable mode of
+preparation.
+
+My beloved parents neither discouraged nor encouraged my desire to
+engage in missionary work. They advised me, with such convictions, to
+use all the means in my power to develop the resources of body, mind,
+heart, and soul, and to wait prayerfully upon GOD, quite willing, should
+He show me that I was mistaken, to follow His guidance, or to go forward
+if in due time He should open the way to missionary service. The
+importance of this advice I have often since had occasion to prove. I
+began to take more exercise in the open air to strengthen my physique.
+My feather bed I had taken away, and sought to dispense with as many
+other home comforts as I could, in order to prepare myself for rougher
+lines of life. I began also to do what Christian work was in my power,
+in the way of tract distribution, Sunday-school teaching, and visiting
+the poor and sick, as opportunity afforded.
+
+After a time of preparatory study at home, I went to Hull for medical
+and surgical training. There I became assistant to a doctor who was
+connected with the Hull school of medicine, and was surgeon also to a
+number of factories, which brought many accident cases to our
+dispensary, and gave me the opportunity of seeing and practising the
+minor operations of surgery.
+
+And here an event took place that I must not omit to mention. Before
+leaving home my attention was drawn to the subject of setting apart the
+firstfruits of all one's increase and a proportionate part of one's
+possessions to the LORD'S service. I thought it well to study the
+question with my Bible in hand before I went away from home, and was
+placed in circumstances which might bias my conclusions by the pressure
+of surrounding wants and cares. I was thus led to the determination to
+set apart not less than one-tenth of whatever moneys I might earn or
+become possessed of for the LORD'S service. The salary I received as
+medical assistant in Hull at the time now referred to would have allowed
+me with ease to do this. But owing to changes in the family of my kind
+friend and employer, it was necessary for me to reside out of doors.
+Comfortable quarters were secured with a relative, and in addition to
+the sum determined on as remuneration for my services I received the
+exact amount I had to pay for board and lodging.
+
+Now arose in my mind the question, Ought not this sum also to be tithed?
+It was surely a part of my income, and I felt that if it had been a
+question of Government income tax it certainly would not have been
+excluded. On the other hand, to take a tithe from the whole would not
+leave me sufficient for other purposes; and for some little time I was
+much embarrassed to know what to do. After much thought and prayer I was
+led to leave the comfortable quarters and happy circle in which I was
+now residing, and to engage a little lodging in the suburbs--a
+sitting-room and bedroom in one--undertaking to board myself. In this
+way I was able without difficulty to tithe the whole of my income; and
+while I felt the change a good deal, it was attended with no small
+blessing.
+
+More time was given in my solitude to the study of the Word of GOD, to
+visiting the poor, and to evangelistic work on summer evenings than
+would otherwise have been the case. Brought into contact in this way
+with many who were in distress, I soon saw the privilege of still
+further economising, and found it not difficult to give away much more
+than the proportion of my income I had at first intended.
+
+About this time a friend drew my attention to the question of the
+personal and pre-millennial coming of our LORD JESUS CHRIST, and gave me
+a list of passages bearing upon it, without note or comment, advising me
+to ponder the subject. For a while I gave much time to studying the
+Scriptures about it, with the result that I was led to see that this
+same JESUS who left our earth in His resurrection body was so to come
+again, that His feet were to stand on the Mount of Olives, and that He
+was to take possession of the temporal throne of His father David which
+was promised before His birth. I saw, further, that all through the New
+Testament the coming of the LORD was the great hope of His people, and
+was always appealed to as the strongest motive for consecration and
+service, and as the greatest comfort in trial and affliction. I learned,
+too, that the period of His return for His people was not revealed, and
+that it was their privilege, from day to day and from hour to hour, to
+live as men who wait for the LORD; that thus living it was immaterial,
+so to speak, whether He should or should not come at any particular
+hour, the important thing being to be so ready for Him as to be able,
+whenever He might appear, to give an account of one's stewardship with
+joy, and not with grief.
+
+The effect of this blessed hope was a thoroughly practical one. It led
+me to look carefully through my little library to see if there were any
+books there that were not needed or likely to be of further service, and
+to examine my small wardrobe, to be quite sure that it contained nothing
+that I should be sorry to give an account of should the MASTER come at
+once. The result was that the library was considerably diminished, to
+the benefit of some poor neighbours, and to the far greater benefit of
+my own and that I found I had articles of clothing also which might be
+put to better advantage in other directions.
+
+It has been very helpful to me from time to time through life, as
+occasion has served, to act again in a similar way; and I have never
+gone through my house, from basement to attic, with this object in view,
+without receiving a great accession of spiritual joy and blessing. I
+believe we are all in danger of accumulating--it may be from
+thoughtlessness, or from pressure of occupation--things which would be
+useful to others, while not needed by ourselves, and the retention of
+which entails loss of blessing. If the whole resources of the Church of
+GOD were well utilised, how much more might be accomplished! How many
+poor might be fed and naked clothed, and to how many of those as yet
+unreached the Gospel might be carried! Let me advise this line of things
+as a constant habit of mind, and a profitable course to be practically
+adopted whenever circumstances permit.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III
+
+PREPARATION FOR SERVICE
+
+
+HAVING now the twofold object in view of accustoming myself to endure
+hardness, and of economising in order to be able more largely to assist
+those amongst whom I spent a good deal of time labouring in the Gospel,
+I soon found that I could live upon very much less than I had previously
+thought possible. Butter, milk, and other such luxuries I soon ceased to
+use; and I found that by living mainly on oatmeal and rice, with
+occasional variations, a very small sum was sufficient for my needs. In
+this way I had more than two-thirds of my income available for other
+purposes; and my experience was that the less I spent on myself and the
+more I gave away, the fuller of happiness and blessing did my soul
+become. Unspeakable joy all the day long, and every day, was my happy
+experience. GOD, even my GOD, was a living, bright Reality; and all I
+had to do was joyful service.
+
+It was to me a very grave matter, however, to contemplate going out to
+China, far away from all human aid, there to depend upon the living GOD
+alone for protection, supplies, and help of every kind. I felt that
+one's spiritual muscles required strengthening for such an undertaking.
+There was no doubt that if faith did not fail, GOD would not fail; but,
+then, what if one's faith should prove insufficient? I had not at that
+time learned that even "if we believe not, He abideth faithful, He
+cannot deny Himself"; and it was consequently a very serious question to
+my mind, not whether _He_ was faithful, but whether I had strong enough
+faith to warrant my embarking in the enterprise set before me.
+
+I thought to myself, "When I get out to China, I shall have no claim on
+any one for anything; my only claim will be on GOD. How important,
+therefore, to learn before leaving England to move man, through GOD, by
+prayer alone."
+
+At Hull my kind employer, always busily occupied, wished me to remind
+him whenever my salary became due. This I determined not to do directly,
+but to ask that GOD would bring the fact to his recollection, and thus
+encourage me by answering prayer. At one time, as the day drew near for
+the payment of a quarter's salary, I was as usual much in prayer about
+it. The time arrived, but my kind friend made no allusion to the matter.
+I continued praying, and days passed on, but he did not remember, until
+at length, on settling up my weekly accounts one Saturday night, I found
+myself possessed of only a single coin--one half-crown piece. Still I
+had hitherto had no lack, and I continued in prayer.
+
+That Sunday was a very happy one. As usual my heart was full and
+brimming over with blessing. After attending Divine service in the
+morning, my afternoons and evenings were filled with Gospel work, in the
+various lodging-houses I was accustomed to visit in the lowest part of
+the town. At such times it almost seemed to me as if heaven were begun
+below, and that all that could be looked for was an enlargement of one's
+capacity for joy, not a truer filling than I possessed. After concluding
+my last service about ten o'clock that night, a poor man asked me to go
+and pray with his wife, saying that she was dying. I readily agreed, and
+on the way to his house asked him why he had not sent for the priest, as
+his accent told me he was an Irishman. He had done so, he said, but the
+priest refused to come without a payment of eighteenpence, which the man
+did not possess, as the family was starving. Immediately it occurred to
+my mind that all the money I had in the world was the solitary
+half-crown, and that it was in one coin; moreover, that while the basin
+of water gruel I usually took for supper was awaiting me, and there was
+sufficient in the house for breakfast in the morning, I certainly had
+nothing for dinner on the coming day.
+
+Somehow or other there was at once a stoppage in the flow of joy in my
+heart; but instead of reproving myself I began to reprove the poor man,
+telling him that it was very wrong to have allowed matters to get into
+such a state as he described, and that he ought to have applied to the
+relieving officer. His answer was that he had done so, and was told to
+come at eleven o'clock the next morning, but that he feared that his
+wife might not live through the night. "Ah," thought I, "if only I had
+two shillings and a sixpence instead of this half-crown, how gladly
+would I give these poor people one shilling of it!" But to part with the
+half-crown was far from my thoughts. I little dreamed that the real
+truth of the matter simply was that I could trust in GOD plus
+one-and-sixpence, but was not yet prepared to trust Him only, without
+any money at all in my pocket.
+
+My conductor led me into a court, down which I followed him with some
+degree of nervousness. I had found myself there before, and at my last
+visit had been very roughly handled, while my tracts were torn to
+pieces, and I received such a warning not to come again that I felt
+more than a little concerned. Still, it was the path of duty, and I
+followed on. Up a miserable flight of stairs, into a wretched room, he
+led me; and oh what a sight there presented itself to our eyes! Four or
+five poor children stood about, their sunken cheeks and temples all
+telling unmistakably the story of slow starvation; and lying on a
+wretched pallet was a poor exhausted mother, with a tiny infant
+thirty-six hours old, moaning rather than crying at her side, for it too
+seemed spent and failing. "Ah!" thought I, "if I had two shillings and a
+sixpence instead of half-a-crown, how gladly should they have
+one-and-sixpence of it!" But still a wretched unbelief prevented me from
+obeying the impulse to relieve their distress at the cost of all I
+possessed.
+
+It will scarcely seem strange that I was unable to say much to comfort
+these poor people. I needed comfort myself. I began to tell them,
+however, that they must not be cast down, that though their
+circumstances were very distressing, there was a kind and loving FATHER
+in heaven; but something within me said, "You hypocrite! telling these
+unconverted people about a kind and loving FATHER in heaven, and not
+prepared yourself to trust Him without half-a-crown!" I was nearly
+choked. How gladly would I have compromised with conscience if I had had
+a florin and a sixpence! I would have given the florin thankfully and
+kept the rest; but I was not yet prepared to trust in GOD alone, without
+the sixpence.
+
+To talk was impossible under these circumstances; yet, strange to say, I
+thought I should have no difficulty in praying. Prayer was a delightful
+occupation to me in those days; time thus spent never seemed wearisome,
+and I knew nothing of lack of words. I seemed to think that all I should
+have to do would be to kneel down and engage in prayer, and that relief
+would come to them and to myself together. "You asked me to come and
+pray with your wife," I said to the man, "let us pray." And I knelt
+down. But scarcely had I opened my lips with "Our FATHER who art in
+heaven" than conscience said within, "Dare you mock GOD? Dare you kneel
+down and call Him FATHER with that half-crown in your pocket?" Such a
+time of conflict came upon me then as I have never experienced before or
+since. How I got through that form of prayer I know not, and whether the
+words uttered were connected or disconnected I cannot tell; but I arose
+from my knees in great distress of mind.
+
+The poor father turned to me and said, "You see what a terrible state we
+are in, sir; if you can help us, for GOD'S sake do!" Just then the word
+flashed into my mind, "Give to him that asketh of thee," and in the word
+of a KING there is power. I put my hand into my pocket, and slowly
+drawing forth the half-crown, gave it to the man, telling him that it
+might seem a small matter for me to relieve them, seeing that I was
+comparatively well off, but that in parting with that coin I was giving
+him my all; what I had been trying to tell him was indeed true--GOD
+really was a FATHER, and might be trusted. The joy all came back in full
+flood-tide to my heart; I could say anything and feel it then, and the
+hindrance to blessing was gone--gone, I trust, for ever.
+
+Not only was the poor woman's life saved, but I realised that my life
+was saved too! It might have been a wreck--would have been a wreck
+probably, as a Christian life--had not grace at that time conquered, and
+the striving of GOD'S SPIRIT been obeyed. I well remember how that
+night, as I went home to my lodgings, my heart was as light as my
+pocket. The lonely, deserted streets resounded with a hymn of praise
+which I could not restrain. When I took my basin of gruel before
+retiring, I would not have exchanged it for a prince's feast. I
+reminded the LORD as I knelt at my bedside of His own Word, that he who
+giveth to the poor lendeth to the LORD: I asked Him not to let my loan
+be a long one, or I should have no dinner next day; and with peace
+within and peace without, I spent a happy, restful night.
+
+Next morning for breakfast my plate of porridge remained, and before it
+was consumed the postman's knock was heard at the door. I was not in the
+habit of receiving letters on Monday, as my parents and most of my
+friends refrained from posting on Saturday; so that I was somewhat
+surprised when the landlady came in holding a letter or packet in her
+wet hand covered by her apron. I looked at the letter, but could not
+make out the handwriting. It was either a strange hand or a feigned one,
+and the postmark was blurred. Where it came from I could not tell. On
+opening the envelope I found nothing written within; but inside a sheet
+of blank paper was folded a pair of kid gloves, from which, as I opened
+them in astonishment, half-a-sovereign fell to the ground. "Praise the
+LORD!" I exclaimed; "400 per cent for twelve hours investment; that is
+good interest. How glad the merchants of Hull would be if they could
+lend their money at such a rate!" I then and there determined that a
+bank which could not break should have my savings or earnings as the
+case might be--a determination I have not yet learned to regret.
+
+I cannot tell you how often my mind has recurred to this incident, or
+all the help it has been to me in circumstances of difficulty in
+after-life. If we are faithful to GOD in little things, we shall gain
+experience and strength that will be helpful to us in the more serious
+trials of life.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV
+
+FURTHER ANSWERS TO PRAYER
+
+
+THE remarkable and gracious deliverance I have spoken of, was a great
+joy to me, as well as a strong confirmation of faith; but of course ten
+shillings, however economically used, will not go very far, and it was
+none the less necessary to continue in prayer, asking that the larger
+supply which was still due might be remembered and paid. All my
+petitions, however, appeared to remain unanswered; and before a
+fortnight had elapsed I found myself pretty much in the same position
+that I had occupied on the Sunday night already made so memorable.
+Meanwhile, I continued pleading with GOD, more and more earnestly, that
+He would graciously remind my employer that my salary was overdue. Of
+course it was not the want of the money that distressed me--that could
+have been had at any time for the asking--but the question uppermost in
+my mind was this: "Can I go to China? or will my want of faith and power
+with GOD prove to be so serious an obstacle as to preclude my entering
+upon this much-prized service?"
+
+As the week drew to a close I felt exceedingly embarrassed. There was
+not only myself to consider; on Saturday night a payment would be due to
+my Christian landlady which I knew she could not well dispense with.
+Ought I not, for her sake, to speak about the matter of the salary? Yet
+to do so would be, to myself at any rate, the admission that I was not
+fitted to undertake a missionary enterprise. I gave nearly the whole of
+Thursday and Friday--all the time not occupied in my necessary
+employment--to earnest wrestling with GOD in prayer. But still on
+Saturday morning I was in the same position as before. And now my
+earnest cry was for guidance as to whether it was my duty to break
+silence and speak to my employer, or whether I should still continue to
+wait the FATHER's time. As far as I could judge, I received the
+assurance that to wait His time was best; and that GOD in some way or
+other would interpose on my behalf. So I waited, my heart being now at
+rest and the burden gone.
+
+About five o'clock that Saturday afternoon, when the doctor had finished
+writing his prescriptions, his last circuit for the day being taken, he
+threw himself back in his arm-chair, as he was wont, and began to speak
+of the things of GOD. He was a truly Christian man, and many seasons of
+very happy spiritual fellowship we had together. I was busily watching,
+at the time, a pan in which a decoction was boiling that required a good
+deal of attention. It was indeed fortunate for me that it was so, for
+without any obvious connection with what had been going on, all at once
+he said, "By-the-bye, Taylor, is not your salary due again?" My emotion
+may be imagined! I had to swallow two or three times before I could
+answer. With my eye fixed on the pan and my back to the doctor, I told
+him as quietly as I could that it was overdue some little time. How
+thankful I felt at that moment! GOD surely had heard my prayer, and
+caused him, in this time of my great need, to remember the salary
+without any word or suggestion from me. He replied, "Oh, I am so sorry
+you did not remind me! You know how busy I am; I wish I had thought of
+it a little sooner, for only this afternoon I sent all the money I had
+to the bank, otherwise I would pay you at once." It is impossible to
+describe the revulsion of feeling caused by this unexpected statement. I
+knew not what to do. Fortunately for me my pan boiled up, and I had a
+good reason for rushing with it from the room. Glad indeed I was to get
+away, and keep out of sight until after the doctor had returned to his
+house, and most thankful that he had not perceived my emotion.
+
+As soon as he was gone I had to seek my little sanctum, and pour out my
+heart before the LORD for some time, before calmness--and more than
+calmness--thankfulness, and joy were restored to me. I felt that GOD had
+His own way, and was not going to fail me. I had sought to know His will
+early in the day, and as far as I could judge had received guidance to
+wait patiently; and now GOD was going to work for me in some other way.
+
+That evening was spent, as my Saturday evenings usually were, in reading
+the Word and preparing the subjects on which I expected to speak in the
+various lodging-houses on the morrow. I waited, perhaps, a little longer
+than usual. At last, about ten o'clock, there being no interruption of
+any kind, I put on my overcoat, and was preparing to leave for home,
+rather thankful to know that by that time I should have to let myself in
+with the latch-key, as my landlady retired early to rest. There was
+certainly no help for that night; but perhaps GOD would interpose for me
+by Monday, and I might be able to pay my landlady early in the week the
+money I would have given her before, had it been possible.
+
+Just as I was preparing to turn down the gas, I heard the doctor's step
+in the garden which lay between the dwelling-house and surgery. He was
+laughing to himself very heartily, as though greatly amused by
+something. Entering the surgery, he asked for the ledger, and told me
+that, strange to say, one of his richest patients had just come to pay
+his doctor's bill--was it not an odd thing to do? It never struck me
+that it might have any bearing on my own particular case, or I might
+have felt embarrassed; but looking at it simply from the position of an
+uninterested spectator, I also was highly amused that a man who was
+rolling in wealth should come after ten o'clock at night to pay a
+doctor's bill, which he could any day have met by a cheque with the
+greatest ease. It appeared that somehow or other he could not rest with
+this on his mind, and had been constrained to come at that unusual hour
+to discharge his liability.
+
+The account was duly receipted in the ledger, and the doctor was about
+to leave, when suddenly he turned, and handing me some of the bank notes
+just received, said, to my surprise and thankfulness, "By the way,
+Taylor, you might as well take these notes; I have not any change, but
+can give you the balance next week." Again I was left--my feelings
+undiscovered--to go back to my own little closet and praise the LORD
+with a joyful heart that after all I might go to China.
+
+To me this incident was not a trivial one; and to recall it sometimes,
+in circumstances of great difficulty, in China or elsewhere, has proved
+no small comfort and strength.
+
+By-and-by the time drew near when it was thought desirable that I should
+leave Hull to attend the medical course of the London Hospital. A little
+while spent there, and then I had every reason to believe that my
+life-work in China would commence. But much as I had rejoiced at the
+willingness of GOD to hear and answer prayer and to help His
+half-trusting, half-timid child, I felt that I could not go to China
+without having still further developed and tested my power to rest upon
+His faithfulness; and a marked opportunity for doing so was
+providentially afforded me.
+
+My dear father had offered to bear all the expense of my stay in London.
+I knew, however, that, owing to recent losses, it would mean a
+considerable sacrifice for him to undertake this just when it seemed
+necessary for me to go forward. I had recently become acquainted with
+the Committee of the Chinese Evangelisation Society, in connection with
+which I ultimately left for China, and especially with its secretary, my
+esteemed and much-loved friend Mr. George Pearse, then of the Stock
+Exchange, but now[1] and for many years himself a missionary. Not
+knowing of my father's proposition, the Committee also kindly offered to
+bear my expenses while in London. When these proposals were first made
+to me, I was not quite clear as to what I ought to do, and in writing to
+my father and the secretaries, told them that I would take a few days to
+pray about the matter before deciding any course of action. I mentioned
+to my father that I had had this offer from the Society, and told the
+secretaries also of his proffered aid.
+
+Subsequently, while waiting upon GOD in prayer for guidance, it became
+clear to my mind that I could without difficulty decline both offers.
+The secretaries of the Society would not know that I had cast myself
+wholly on GOD for supplies, and my father would conclude that I had
+accepted the other offer. I therefore wrote declining both propositions,
+and felt that without any one having either care or anxiety on my
+account I was simply in the hands of GOD, and that He, who knew my
+heart, if He wished to encourage me to go to China, would bless my
+effort to depend upon Him alone at home.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+FOOTNOTE:
+
+[1] Since the above was written Mr. George Pearse has died.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER V
+
+LIFE IN LONDON
+
+
+I MUST not now attempt to detail the ways in which the LORD was
+pleased--often to my surprise, as well as to my delight--to help me from
+time to time. I soon found that it was not possible to live quite as
+economically in London as in Hull. To lessen expenses I shared a room
+with a cousin, four miles from the hospital, providing myself with
+board; and after various experiments I found that the most economical
+way was to live almost exclusively on brown bread and water. Thus I was
+able to make the means that GOD gave me last as long as possible. Some
+of my expenses I could not diminish, but my board was largely within my
+own control. A large twopenny loaf of brown bread, purchased daily on my
+long walk from the hospital, furnished me with supper and breakfast; and
+on that diet, with a few apples for lunch, I managed to walk eight or
+nine miles a day, besides being a good deal on foot while attending the
+practice of the hospital and the medical school.
+
+One incident that occurred just about this time I must refer to. The
+husband of my former landlady in Hull was chief officer of a ship that
+sailed from London, and by receiving his half-pay monthly and remitting
+it to her I was able to save her the cost of a commission. This I had
+been doing for several months, when she wrote requesting that I would
+obtain the next payment as early as possible, as her rent was almost
+due, and she depended upon that sum to meet it. The request came at an
+inconvenient time. I was working hard for an examination in the hope of
+obtaining a scholarship which would be of service to me, and felt that I
+could ill afford the time to go during the busiest part of the day to
+the city and procure the money. I had, however, sufficient of my own in
+hand to enable me to send the required sum. I made the remittance
+therefore, purposing, as soon as the examination was over, to go and
+draw the regular allowance with which to refund myself.
+
+Before the time of examination the medical school was closed for a day,
+on account of the funeral of the Duke of Wellington, and I had an
+opportunity of going at once to the office, which was situated in a
+street on Cheapside, and applying for the due amount. To my surprise and
+dismay the cleric told me that he could not pay it, as the officer in
+question had run away from his ship and gone to the gold diggings.
+"Well," I remarked, "that is very inconvenient for me, as I have already
+advanced the money, and I know his wife will have no means of repaying
+it." The clerk said he was sorry, but could of course only act according
+to orders; so there was no help for me in that direction. A little more
+time and thought, however, brought the comforting conclusion to my mind,
+that as I was depending on the LORD for everything, and His means were
+not limited, it was a small matter to be brought a little sooner or
+later into the position of needing fresh supplies from Him; and so the
+joy and the peace were not long interfered with.
+
+Very soon after this, possibly the same evening, while sewing together
+some sheets of paper on which to take notes of the lectures, I
+accidentally pricked the first finger of my right hand, and in a few
+moments forgot all about it. The next day at the hospital I continued
+dissecting as before. The body was that of a person who had died of
+fever, and was more than usually disagreeable and dangerous. I need
+scarcely say that those of us who were at work upon it dissected with
+special care, knowing that the slightest scratch might cost us our
+lives. Before the morning was far advanced I began to feel very weary,
+and while going through the surgical wards at noon was obliged to run
+out, being suddenly very sick--a most unusual circumstance with me, as I
+took but little food and nothing that could disagree with me. After
+feeling faint for some time, a draught of cold water revived me, and I
+was able to rejoin the students. I became more and more unwell, however,
+and ere the afternoon lecture on surgery was over found it impossible to
+hold the pencil and continue taking notes. By the time the next lecture
+was through, my whole arm and right side were full of severe pain, and I
+was both looking and feeling very ill.
+
+Finding that I could not resume work, I went into the dissecting-room to
+bind up the portion I was engaged upon and put away my apparatus, and
+said to the demonstrator, who was a very skilful surgeon, "I cannot
+think what has come over me," describing the symptoms. "Why," said he,
+"what has happened is clear enough: you must have cut yourself in
+dissecting, and you know that this is a case of malignant fever." I
+assured him that I had been most careful, and was quite certain that I
+had no cut or scratch. "Well," he replied, "you certainly must have had
+one;" and he very closely scrutinised my hand to find it, but in vain.
+All at once it occurred to me that I had pricked my finger the night
+before, and I asked him if it were possible that a prick from a needle,
+at that time, could have been still unclosed. His opinion was that this
+was probably the cause of the trouble, and he advised me to get a
+hansom, drive home as fast as I could, and arrange my affairs forthwith.
+"For," he said, "you are a dead man."
+
+My first thought was one of sorrow that I could not go to China; but
+very soon came the feeling, "Unless I am greatly mistaken, I have work
+to do in China, and shall not die." I was glad, however, to take the
+opportunity of speaking to my medical friend, who was a confirmed
+sceptic as to things spiritual, of the joy that the prospect of perhaps
+soon being with my MASTER gave me; telling him at the same time that I
+did not think I should die, as, unless I were much mistaken, I had work
+to do in China; and if so, however severe the struggle, I must be
+brought through. "That is all very well," he answered, "but you get a
+hansom and drive home as fast as you can. You have no time to lose, for
+you will soon be incapable of winding up your affairs."
+
+I smiled a little at the idea of my driving home in a hansom, for by
+this time my means were too exhausted to allow of such a proceeding, and
+I set out to walk the distance if possible. Before long, however, my
+strength gave way, and I felt it was no use to attempt to reach home by
+walking. Availing myself of an omnibus from Whitechapel Church to
+Farringdon Street, and another from Farringdon Street onwards, I
+reached, in great suffering, the neighbourhood of Soho Square, behind
+which I lived. On going into the house I got some hot water from the
+servant, and charging her very earnestly--literally as a dying man--to
+accept eternal life as the gift of GOD through JESUS CHRIST, I bathed my
+head and lanced the finger, hoping to let out some of the poisoned
+blood. The pain was very severe; I fainted away, and was for some time
+unconscious, so long that when I came to myself I found that I had been
+carried to bed.
+
+An uncle of mine who lived near at hand had come in, and sent for his
+own medical man, an assistant surgeon at the Westminster Hospital. I
+assured my uncle that medical help would be of no service to me, and
+that I did not wish to go to the expense involved. He, however, quieted
+me on this score, saying that he had sent for his own doctor, and that
+the bill would be charged to himself. When the surgeon came and learned
+all the particulars, he said, "Well, if you have been living moderately,
+you may pull through; but if you have been going in for beer and that
+sort of thing, there is no manner of chance for you." I thought that if
+sober living was to do anything, few could have a better chance, as
+little but bread and water had been my diet for a good while past. I
+told him I had lived abstemiously, and found that it helped me in study.
+"But now," he said, "you must keep up your strength, for it will be a
+pretty hard struggle." And he ordered me a bottle of port wine every
+day, and as many chops as I could consume. Again I smiled inwardly,
+having no means for the purchase of such luxuries. This difficulty,
+however, was also met by my kind uncle, who sent me at once all that was
+needed.
+
+I was much concerned, notwithstanding the agony I suffered, that my dear
+parents should not be made acquainted with my state. Thought and prayer
+had satisfied me that I was not going to die, but that there was indeed
+a work for me to do in China. If my dear parents should come up and find
+me in that condition, I must lose the opportunity of seeing how GOD was
+going to work for me, now that my money had almost come to an end. So,
+after prayer for guidance, I obtained a promise from my uncle and cousin
+not to write to my parents, but to leave me to communicate with them
+myself. I felt it was a very distinct answer to prayer when they gave me
+this promise, and I took care to defer all communication with them
+myself until the crisis was past and the worst of the attack over. At
+home they knew that I was working hard for an examination, and did not
+wonder at my silence.
+
+Days and nights of suffering passed slowly by; but at length, after
+several weeks, I was sufficiently restored to leave my room; and then I
+learned that two men, though not from the London Hospital, who had had
+dissection wounds at the same time as myself, had both succumbed, while
+I was spared in answer to prayer to work for GOD in China.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VI
+
+STRENGTHENED BY FAITH
+
+
+ONE day the doctor coming in found me on the sofa, and was surprised to
+learn that with assistance I had walked downstairs. "Now," he said, "the
+best thing you can go is to get off to the country as soon as you feel
+equal to the journey. You must rusticate until you have recovered a fair
+amount of health and strength, for if you begin your work too soon the
+consequences may still be serious." When he had left, as I lay very
+exhausted on the sofa, I just told the LORD all about it, and that I was
+refraining from making my circumstances known to those who would delight
+to meet my need, in order that my faith might be strengthened by
+receiving help from Himself in answer to prayer alone. What was I to do?
+And I waited for His answer.
+
+It seemed to me as if He were directing my mind to the conclusion to go
+again to the shipping office, and inquire about the wages I had been
+unable to draw. I reminded the LORD that I could not afford to take a
+conveyance, and that it did not seem at all likely that I should succeed
+in getting the money, and asked whether this impulse was not a mere
+clutching at a straw, some mental process of my own, rather than His
+guidance and teaching. After prayer, however, and renewed waiting upon
+GOD, I was confirmed in my belief that He Himself was teaching me to go
+to the office.
+
+The next question was, "How am I to go?" I had had to seek help in
+coming downstairs, and the place was at least two miles away. The
+assurance was brought vividly home to me that whatever I asked of GOD in
+the name of CHRIST would be done, that the FATHER might be glorified in
+the SON; that what I had to do was to seek strength for the long walk,
+to receive it by faith, and to set out upon it. Unhesitatingly I told
+the LORD that I was quite willing to take the walk if He would give me
+the strength. I asked in the name of CHRIST that the strength might be
+immediately given; and sending the servant up to my room for my hat and
+stick, I set out, not to _attempt_ to walk, but TO WALK to Cheapside.
+
+Although undoubtedly strengthened by faith, I never took so much
+interest in shop windows as I did upon that journey. At every second or
+third step I was glad to lean a little against the plate glass, and take
+time to examine the contents of the windows before passing on. It needed
+a special effort of faith when I got to the bottom of Farringdon Street
+to attempt the toilsome ascent of Snow Hill: there was no Holborn
+Viaduct in those days, and it had to be done. GOD did wonderfully help
+me, and in due time I reached Cheapside, turned into the by-street in
+which the office was found, and sat down much exhausted on the steps
+leading to the first floor, which was my destination. I felt my position
+to be a little peculiar--sitting there on the steps, so evidently
+spent--and the gentlemen who rushed up and downstairs looked at me with
+an inquiring gaze. After a little rest, however, and a further season of
+prayer, I succeeded in climbing the staircase, and to my comfort found
+in the office the clerk with whom I had hitherto dealt in the matter.
+Seeing me looking pale and exhausted, he kindly inquired as to my
+health, and I told him that I had had a serious illness, and was ordered
+to the country, but thought it well to call first, and make further
+inquiry, lest there should have been any mistake about the mate having
+run off to the gold diggings. "Oh," he said, "I am so glad you have
+come, for it turns out that it was an able seaman of the same name that
+ran away. The mate is still on board; the ship has just reached
+Gravesend, and will be up very soon. I shall be glad to give you the
+half-pay up to date, for doubtless it will reach his wife more safely
+through you. We all know what temptations beset the men when they arrive
+at home after a voyage."
+
+Before, however, giving me the sum of money, he insisted upon my coming
+inside and sharing his lunch. I felt it was the LORD indeed who was
+providing for me, and accepted his offer with thankfulness. When I was
+refreshed and rested, he gave me a sheet of paper to write a few lines
+to the wife, telling her of the circumstances. On my way back I procured
+in Cheapside a money order for the balance due to her, and posted it;
+and returning home again, felt myself now quite justified in taking an
+omnibus as far as it would serve me.
+
+Very much better the next morning, after seeing to some little matters
+that I had to settle, I made my way to the surgery of the doctor who had
+attended me, feeling that, although my uncle was prepared to pay the
+bill, it was right for me, now that I had some money in hand, to ask for
+the account myself. The kind surgeon refused to allow me, as a medical
+student, to pay anything for his attendance: but he had supplied me with
+quinine, which he allowed me to pay for to the extent of eight
+shillings. When that was settled, I saw that the sum left was just
+sufficient to take me home; and to my mind the whole thing seemed a
+wonderful interposition of GOD on my behalf.
+
+I knew that the surgeon was sceptical, and told him that I should very
+much like to speak to him freely, if I might do so without offence; that
+I felt that under GOD I owed my life to his kind care, and wished very
+earnestly that he himself might become a partaker of the same precious
+faith that I possessed. So I told him my reason for being in London, and
+about my circumstances, and why I had declined the help of both my
+father and the officers of the Society in connection with which it was
+probable that I should go to China. I told him of the recent
+providential dealings of GOD with me, and how apparently hopeless my
+position had been the day before, when he had ordered me to go to the
+country, unless I would reveal my need, which I had determined not to
+do. I described to him the mental exercises I had gone through; but when
+I added that I had actually got up from the sofa and walked to
+Cheapside, he looked at me incredulously, and "Impossible! Why, I left
+you lying there more like a ghost than a man." And I had to assure him
+again and again that, strengthened by faith, the walk had really been
+taken. I told him also what money was left to me, and what payments
+there had been to make, and showed him that just sufficient remained to
+take me home to Yorkshire, providing for needful refreshment by the way
+and the omnibus journey at the end.
+
+My kind friend was completely broken down, and said with tears in his
+eyes, "I would give all the world for a faith like yours." I, on the
+other hand, had the joy of telling him that it was to be obtained
+without money and without price. We never met again. When I came back to
+town, restored to health and strength, I found that he had had a
+stroke, and left for the country; and I subsequently learned that he
+never rallied. I was able to gain no information as to his state of mind
+when taken away; but I have always felt very thankful that I had the
+opportunity, and embraced it, of bearing that testimony for GOD. I
+cannot but entertain the hope that the MASTER Himself was speaking to
+him through His dealings with me, and that I shall meet him again in the
+Better Land. It would be no small joy to be welcomed by him, when my own
+service is over.
+
+The next day found me in my dear parents' home. My joy in the LORD's
+help and deliverance was so great that I was unable to keep it to
+myself, and before my return to London my dear mother knew the secret of
+my life for some time past. I need scarcely say that when I went up
+again to town I was not allowed to live--as, indeed, I was not fit to
+live--on the same economical lines as before my illness. I needed more
+now, and the LORD did provide.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VII
+
+MIGHTY TO SAVE
+
+
+RETURNING to London when sufficiently recovered to resume my studies,
+the busy life of hospital and lecture-hall was resumed; often relieved
+by happy Sundays of fellowship with Christian friends, especially in
+London or Tottenham. Opportunities for service are to be found in every
+sphere, and mine was no exception. I shall only mention one case now
+that gave me great encouragement in seeking conversion even when it
+seemed apparently hopeless.
+
+GOD had given me the joy of winning souls before, but not in
+surroundings of such special difficulty. With GOD all things are
+possible, and no conversion ever takes place save by the almighty power
+of the HOLY GHOST. The great need, therefore, of every Christian worker
+is to _know_ GOD. Indeed, this is the purpose for which He has given us
+eternal life, as our SAVIOUR Himself says, in the oft misquoted verse,
+John xvii. 3: "This is [the object of] life eternal, [not _to_ know but]
+that they _might_ know Thee the only true GOD, and JESUS CHRIST, whom
+Thou hast sent." I was now to prove the willingness of GOD to answer
+prayer for spiritual blessing under most unpromising circumstances, and
+thus to gain an increased acquaintance with the prayer-answering GOD as
+One "mighty to save."
+
+A short time before leaving for China, it became my duty daily to dress
+the foot of a patient suffering from senile gangrene. The disease
+commenced, as usual, insidiously, and the patient had little idea that
+he was a doomed man, and probably had not long to live. I was not the
+first to attend to him, but when the case was transferred to me, I
+naturally became very anxious about his soul. The family with whom he
+lived were Christians, and from them I learned that he was an avowed
+atheist, and very antagonistic to anything religious. They had, without
+asking his consent, invited a Scripture reader to visit him, but in
+great passion he had ordered him from the room. The vicar of the
+district had also called, hoping to help him; but he had spit in his
+face, and refused to allow him to speak to him. His passionate temper
+was described to me as very violent, and altogether the case seemed to
+be as hopeless as could well be imagined.
+
+Upon first commencing to attend him I prayed much about it; but for two
+or three days said nothing to him of a religious nature. By special care
+in dressing his diseased limb I was able considerably to lessen his
+sufferings, and he soon began to manifest grateful appreciation of my
+services. One day, with a trembling heart, I took advantage of his warm
+acknowledgments to tell him what was the spring of my action, and to
+speak of his own solemn position and need of GOD's mercy through CHRIST.
+It was evidently only by a powerful effort of self-restraint that he
+kept his lips closed. He turned over in bed with his back to me, and
+uttered no word.
+
+I could not get the poor man out of my mind, and very often through each
+day I pleaded with GOD, by His SPIRIT, to save him ere He took him
+hence. After dressing the wound and relieving his pain, I never failed
+to say a few words to him, which I hoped the LORD would bless. He
+always turned his back to me, looking annoyed, but never spoke a word in
+reply.
+
+After continuing this for some time, my heart sank. It seemed to me that
+I was not only doing no good, but perhaps really hardening him and
+increasing his guilt. One day, after dressing his limb and washing my
+hands, instead of returning to the bedside to speak to him, I went to
+the door, and stood hesitating for a few moments with the thought in my
+mind, "Ephraim is joined to his idols; let him alone." I looked at the
+man and saw his surprise, as it was the first time since speaking to him
+that I had attempted to leave without going up to his bedside to say a
+few words for my MASTER. I could bear it no longer. Bursting into tears,
+I crossed the room and said, "My friend, whether you will hear or
+whether you will forbear, I _must_ deliver _my_ soul," and went on to
+speak very earnestly to him, telling him with many tears how much I
+wished that he would let me pray with him. To my unspeakable joy he did
+not turn away, but replied, "If it will be a relief to you, do." I need
+scarcely say that I fell on my knees and poured out my whole soul to GOD
+on his behalf. I believe the LORD then and there wrought a change in his
+soul.
+
+He was never afterwards unwilling to be spoken to and prayed with, and
+within a few days he definitely accepted CHRIST as his SAVIOUR. Oh the
+joy it was to me to see that dear man rejoicing in hope of the glory of
+GOD! He told me that for forty years he had never darkened the door of
+church or chapel, and that then--forty years ago--he had only entered a
+place of worship to be married, and could not be persuaded to go inside
+when his wife was buried. Now, thank GOD, his sin-stained soul, I had
+every reason to believe, was washed, was sanctified, was justified, in
+the Name of the LORD JESUS CHRIST and in the SPIRIT of our GOD.
+Oftentimes, when in my early work in China circumstances rendered me
+almost hopeless of success, I have thought of this man's conversion, and
+have been encouraged to persevere in speaking the Word, whether men
+would hear or whether they would forbear.
+
+The now happy sufferer lived for some time after this change, and was
+never tired of bearing testimony to the grace of GOD. Though his
+condition was most distressing, the alteration in his character and
+behaviour made the previously painful duty of attending him one of real
+pleasure. I have often thought since, in connection with this case and
+the work of GOD generally, of the words, "He that goeth forth _weeping_,
+bearing precious seed, shall doubtless come again rejoicing, bringing
+his sheaves with him." Perhaps if there were more of that intense
+distress for souls that leads to tears, we should more frequently see
+the results we desire. Sometimes it may be that while we are complaining
+of the hardness of the hearts of those we are seeking to benefit, the
+hardness of our own hearts, and our own feeble apprehension of the
+solemn reality of eternal things, may be the true cause of our want of
+success.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VIII
+
+VOYAGE TO CHINA
+
+
+SOON after this the time so long looked forward to arrived--the time
+that I was to leave England for China. After being set apart with many
+prayers for the ministry of GOD's Word among the heathen Chinese I left
+London for Liverpool; and on the 19th of September 1853 a little service
+was held in the stern cabin of the _Dumfries_, which had been secured
+for me by the Committee of the Chinese Evangelisation Society, under
+whose auspices I was going to China.
+
+My beloved, now sainted, mother had come to see me off from Liverpool.
+Never shall I forget that day, nor how she went with me into the little
+cabin that was to be my home for nearly six long months. With a mother's
+loving hand she smoothed the little bed. She sat by my side, and joined
+me in the last hymn that we should sing together before the long
+parting. We knelt down, and she prayed--the last mother's prayer I was
+to hear before starting for China. Then notice was given that we must
+separate, and we had to say good-bye, never expecting to meet on earth
+again.
+
+For my sake she restrained her feelings as much as possible. We parted;
+and she went on shore, giving me her blessing; I stood alone on deck,
+and she followed the ship as we moved towards the dock gates. As we
+passed through the gates, and the separation really commenced, I shall
+never forget the cry of anguish wrung from that mother's heart. It went
+through me like a knife. I never knew so fully, until then, what GOD
+_so_ loved the world meant. And I am quite sure that my precious mother
+learned more of the love of GOD to the perishing in that hour than in
+all her life before.
+
+Oh, how it must grieve the heart of GOD when He sees His children
+indifferent to the needs of that wide world for which His beloved, His
+only begotten SON died!
+
+ Hearken, O daughter, and consider, and incline thine ear;
+ Forget also thine own people, and thy father's house;
+ So shall the KING desire thy beauty:
+ For He is thy LORD; and worship thou Him.
+
+Praise GOD, the number is increasing who are finding out the exceeding
+joys, the wondrous revelations of His mercies, vouchsafed to those who
+follow Him, and emptying themselves, leave all in obedience to His great
+commission.
+
+It was on 19th September 1853 that the _Dumfries_ sailed for China; and
+not until 1st March, in the spring of the following year, did I arrive
+in Shanghai.
+
+Our voyage had a rough beginning, but many had promised to remember us
+in constant prayer. No small comfort was this; for we had scarcely left
+the Mersey when a violent equinoctial gale caught us, and for twelve
+days we were beating backwards and forwards in the Irish Channel, unable
+to get out to sea. The gale steadily increased, and after almost a week
+we lay to for a time; but drifting on a lee coast, we were compelled
+again to make sail, and endeavoured to beat on to windward. The utmost
+efforts of the captain and crew, however, were unavailing; and Sunday
+night, 25th September, found us drifting into Carnarvon Bay, each tack
+becoming shorter, until at last we were within a stone's-throw of the
+rocks. About this time, as the ship, which had refused to stay, was put
+round in the other direction, the Christian captain said to me, "We
+cannot live half an hour now: what of your call to labour for the LORD
+in China?" I had previously passed through a time of much conflict, but
+that was over, and it was a great joy to feel and to tell him that I
+would not for any consideration be in any other position; that I
+strongly expected to reach China; but that, if otherwise, at any rate
+the Master would say it was well that I was found seeking to obey His
+command.
+
+Within a few minutes after wearing ship the captain walked, up to the
+compass, and said to me, "The wind has freed two points; we shall be
+able to beat out of the bay." And so we did. The bowsprit was sprung and
+the vessel seriously strained; but in a few days we got out to sea, and
+the necessary repairs were so thoroughly effected on board that our
+journey to China was in due time satisfactorily accomplished.
+
+One thing was a great trouble to me that night. I was a very young
+believer, and had not sufficient faith in GOD to see Him in and through
+the use of means. I had felt it a duty to comply with the earnest wish
+of my beloved and honoured mother, and for her sake to procure a
+swimming-belt. But in my own soul I felt as if I could not simply trust
+in GOD while I had this swimming-belt; and my heart had no rest until on
+that night, after all hope of being saved was gone, I had given it away.
+Then I had perfect peace; and, strange to say, put several light things
+together, likely to float at the time we struck, without any thought of
+inconsistency or scruple. Ever since, I have seen clearly the mistake I
+made--a mistake that is very common in these days, when erroneous
+teaching on faith-healing does much harm, misleading some as to the
+purposes of GOD, shaking the faith of others, and distressing the minds
+of many. The use of means ought not to lessen our faith in GOD; and our
+faith in GOD ought not to hinder our using whatever means He has given
+us for the accomplishment of His own purposes.
+
+For years after this I always took a swimming-belt with me, and never
+had any trouble about it; for after the storm was over, the question was
+settled for me, through the prayerful study of the Scriptures. GOD gave
+me then to see my mistake, probably to deliver me from a great deal of
+trouble on similar questions now so constantly raised. When in medical
+or surgical charge of any case, I have never thought of neglecting to
+ask GOD's guidance and blessing in the use of appropriate means, nor yet
+of omitting to give Him thanks for answered prayer and restored health.
+But to me it would appear as presumptuous and wrong to neglect the use
+of those measures which He Himself has put within our reach, as to
+neglect to take daily food, and suppose that life and health might be
+maintained by prayer alone.
+
+The voyage was a very tedious one. We lost a good deal of time on the
+equator from calms; and when we finally reached the Eastern Archipelago,
+were again detained from the same cause. Usually a breeze would spring
+up soon after sunset, and last until about dawn. The utmost use was made
+of it, but during the day we lay still with flapping sails, often
+drifting back and losing a good deal of the advantage we had gained
+during the night.
+
+This happened notably on one occasion, when we were in dangerous
+proximity to the north of New Guinea. Saturday night had brought us to a
+point some thirty miles off the land; but during the Sunday morning
+service, which was held on deck, I could not fail to notice that the
+captain looked troubled, and frequently went over to the side of the
+ship. When the service was ended, I learnt from him the cause--a
+four-knot current was carrying us rapidly towards some sunken reefs, and
+we were already so near that it seemed improbable that we should get
+through the afternoon in safety. After dinner the long-boat was put out,
+and all hands endeavoured, without success, to turn the ship's head from
+the shore. As we drifted nearer we could plainly see the natives rushing
+about the sands and lighting fires every here and there. The captain's
+horn-book informed him that these people were cannibals, so that our
+position was not a little alarming.
+
+After standing together on the deck for some time in silence, the
+captain said to me, "Well, we have done everything that can be done; we
+can only await the result." A thought occurred to me, and I replied,
+"No, there is one thing we have not done yet." "What is it?" he queried.
+"Four of us on board are Christians," I answered (the Swedish carpenter
+and our coloured steward, with the captain and myself); "let us each
+retire to his own cabin, and in agreed prayer ask the LORD to give us
+immediately a breeze. He can as easily send it now as at sunset."
+
+The captain complied with this proposal. I went and spoke to the other
+two men, and after prayer with the carpenter we all four retired to wait
+upon GOD. I had a good but very brief season in prayer, and then felt so
+satisfied that our request was granted that I could not continue asking,
+and very soon went up again on deck. The first officer, a godless man,
+was in charge. I went over and asked him to let down the clews or
+corners of the mainsail, which had been drawn up in order to lessen the
+useless flapping of the sail against the rigging. He answered, "What
+would be the good of that?" I told him we had been asking a wind from
+GOD, that it was coming immediately, and we were so near the reef by
+this time that there was not a minute to lose. With a look of
+incredulity and contempt, he said with an oath that he would rather see
+a wind than hear of it! But while he was speaking I watched his eye, and
+followed it up to the royal (the topmost sail), and there, sure enough,
+the corner of the sail was beginning to tremble in the coming breeze.
+"Don't you see the wind is coming? Look at the royal!" I exclaimed. "No,
+it is only a cat's-paw," he rejoined (a mere puff of wind). "Cat's-paw
+or not," I cried, "pray let down the mainsail, and let us have the
+benefit!"
+
+This he was not slow to do. In another minute the heavy tread of the men
+on the deck brought up the captain from his cabin to see what was the
+matter; and he saw that the breeze had indeed come. In a few minutes we
+were ploughing our way at six or seven knots an hour through the water,
+and the multitude of naked savages whom we had seen on the beach had no
+wreckage that night. We were soon out of danger; and though the wind was
+sometimes unsteady, we did not altogether lose it until after passing
+the Pelew Islands.
+
+Thus GOD encouraged me, ere landing on China's shores, to bring every
+variety of need to Him in prayer, and _to expect that He would honour
+the Name_ of the LORD JESUS, and give the help which each emergency
+required.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IX
+
+EARLY MISSIONARY EXPERIENCES
+
+
+ON landing in Shanghai on 1st March 1854, I found myself surrounded with
+difficulties that were wholly unexpected. A band of rebels, known as the
+"Red Turbans," had taken possession of the native city, against which
+was encamped an Imperial army of from forty to fifty thousand men, who
+were a much greater source of discomfort and danger to the little
+European community than were the rebels themselves. Upon landing, I was
+told that to live outside the Settlement was impossible, while within
+the foreign concession apartments were scarcely obtainable at any price.
+The dollar, now worth about three shillings, had risen to a value of
+eight-and-ninepence, and the prospect for one with only a small income
+of English money was dark indeed. However, I had three letters of
+introduction, and counted on counsel and help, especially from one of
+those to whom I had been commended, whose friends I well knew and highly
+valued. Of course I sought him out at once, but only to learn that he
+had been buried a month or two before, having died from fever during the
+time of my voyage.
+
+Saddened by these tidings, I inquired for a missionary to whom another
+of my letters of introduction was addressed; but a further
+disappointment awaited me--he had left for America. The third letter
+remained; but as it had been given by a comparative stranger, I had
+expected less from it than from the other two. It proved, however, to be
+GOD's channel of help. The Rev. Dr. Medhurst, of the London Mission, to
+whom it was addressed, introduced me to Dr. Lockhart, who kindly allowed
+me to live with him for six months. Dr. Medhurst procured my first
+Chinese teacher; and he, Dr. Edkins, and the late Mr. Alexander Wylie
+gave me considerable help with the language.
+
+Those were indeed troublous times, and times of danger. Coming out of
+the city one day with Mr. Wylie, he entered into conversation with two
+coolies, while we waited a little while at the East Gate for a companion
+who was behind us. Before our companion came up an attack upon the city
+from the batteries on the opposite side of the river commenced, which
+caused us to hurry away to a place of less danger, the whiz of the balls
+being unpleasantly near. The coolies, unfortunately, stayed too long,
+and were wounded. On reaching the Settlement we stopped a few minutes to
+make a purchase, and then proceeded at once to the London Mission
+compound, where, at the door of the hospital, we found the two poor
+coolies with whom Mr. Wylie had conversed, their four ankles terribly
+shattered by a cannon ball. The poor fellows declined amputation, and
+both died. We felt how narrow had been our escape.
+
+At another time, early in the morning, I had joined one of the
+missionaries on his verandah to watch the battle proceeding, at a
+distance of perhaps three-quarters of a mile, when suddenly a spent ball
+passed between us and buried itself in the verandah wall. Another day my
+friend Mr. Wylie left a book on the table after luncheon, and returning
+for it about five minutes later, found the arm of the chair on which he
+had been sitting shot clean away. But in the midst of these and many
+other dangers GOD protected us.
+
+After six months' stay with Dr. Lockhart, I rented a native house
+outside the Settlement, and commenced a little missionary work amongst
+my Chinese neighbours, which for a few months continued practicable.
+When the French joined the Imperialists in attacking the city, the
+position of my house became so dangerous that during the last few weeks,
+in consequence of nightly recurring skirmishes, I gave up attempting to
+sleep except in the daytime. One night a fire appeared very near, and I
+climbed up to a little observatory I had arranged on the roof of the
+house, to see whether it was necessary to attempt escape. While there a
+ball struck the ridge of the roof on the opposite side of the
+quadrangle, showering pieces of broken tile all around me, while the
+ball itself rolled down into the court below. It weighed four or five
+pounds; and had it come a few inches higher, would probably have spent
+its force on me instead of on the building. My dear mother kept the ball
+for many years. Shortly after this I had to abandon the house and return
+to the Foreign Settlement--a step that was taken none too soon, for
+before the last of my belongings were removed, the house was burnt to
+the ground.
+
+Of the trials of this early period it is scarcely possible to convey any
+adequate idea. To one of a sensitive nature, the horrors, atrocities,
+and misery connected with war were a terrible ordeal. The embarrassment
+also of the times was considerable. With an income of only eighty pounds
+a year, I was compelled, upon moving into the Settlement, to give one
+hundred and twenty for rent, and sublet half the house; and though the
+Committee of the Chinese Evangelisation Society increased my income
+when, after the arrival of Dr. Parker, they learned more of our
+circumstances, many painful experiences had necessarily been passed
+through. Few can realise how distressing to so young and untried a
+worker these difficulties seemed, or the intense loneliness of the
+position of a pioneer who could not even hint at many of his
+circumstances, as to do so would have been a tacit appeal for help.
+
+The great enemy is always ready with his oft-repeated suggestion, "All
+these things are against me." But oh, how false the word! The cold, and
+even the hunger, the watchings and sleeplessness of nights of danger,
+and the feeling at times of utter isolation and helplessness, were well
+and wisely chosen, and tenderly and lovingly meted out. What
+circumstances could have rendered the Word of GOD more sweet, the
+presence of GOD more real, the help of GOD more precious? They were
+times, indeed, of emptying and humbling, but were experiences that made
+not ashamed, and that strengthened purpose to go forward as GOD might
+direct, with His _proved_ promise, "I will not fail thee, nor forsake
+thee." One can see, even now, that as for GOD, His way is perfect, and
+yet can rejoice that the missionary path of to-day is comparatively a
+smooth and an easy one.
+
+Journeying inland was contrary to treaty arrangements, and attended with
+much difficulty, especially for some time after the battle of Muddy
+Flat, in which an Anglo-American contingent of about three hundred
+marines and seamen, with a volunteer corps of less than a hundred
+residents, attacked the Imperial camp, and drove away from thirty to
+fifty thousand Chinese soldiers, the range of our shot and shell making
+the native artillery useless. Still, in the autumn of 1854 a journey of
+perhaps a week's duration was safely accomplished with Dr. Edkins, who
+of course did the speaking and preaching, while I was able to help in
+the distribution of books.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER X
+
+FIRST EVANGELISTIC EFFORTS
+
+
+A JOURNEY taken in the spring of 1855 with the Rev. J. S. Burden of the
+Church Missionary Society (now the Bishop of Victoria, Hong-kong) was
+attended with some serious dangers.
+
+In the great mouth of the river Yang-tse, distant some thirty miles to
+the north of Shanghai, lies the group of islands of which Ts'ung-ming
+and Hai-men are the largest and most important; and farther up the
+river, where the estuary narrows away from the sea, is situated the
+influential city of T'ung-chau, close to Lang-shan, or the Wolf
+Mountains, famous as a resort for pilgrim devotees. We spent some time
+in evangelising on those islands, and then proceeded to Lang-shan, where
+we preached and gave books to thousands of the devotees who were
+attending an idolatrous festival. From thence we went on to T'ung-chau,
+and of our painful experiences there the following journal will tell:--
+
+
+ _Thursday, April 26th, 1855._
+
+After breakfast we commended ourselves to the care of our Heavenly
+FATHER, and sought His Blessing before proceeding to this great city.
+The day was dull and wet. We felt persuaded that Satan would not allow
+us to assail his kingdom, as we were attempting to do, without raising
+serious opposition; but we were also fully assured that it was the will
+of GOD that we should preach CHRIST in this city, and distribute the
+Word of Truth among its people. We were sorry that we had but few books
+left for such an important place: the result, however, proved that this
+also was providential.
+
+Our native teachers did their best to persuade us not to go into the
+city; but we determined that, by GOD'S help, nothing should hinder us.
+We directed them, however, to remain in one of the boats; and if we did
+not return, to learn whatever they could respecting our fate, and make
+all possible haste to Shanghai with the information. We also arranged
+that the other boat should wait for us, even if we could not get back
+that night, so that we might not be detained for want of a boat in case
+of returning later. We then put our books into two bags, and with a
+servant who always accompanied us on these occasions, set off for the
+city, distant about seven miles. Walking was out of the question, from
+the state of the roads, so we availed ourselves of wheel-barrows, the
+only conveyance to be had in these parts. A wheel-barrow is cheaper than
+a sedan, only requiring one coolie; but is by no means an agreeable
+conveyance on rough, dirty roads.
+
+We had not gone far before the servant requested permission to go back,
+as he was thoroughly frightened by reports concerning the native
+soldiery. Of course we at once consented, not wishing to involve another
+in trouble, and determined to carry the books ourselves, and look for
+physical as well as spiritual strength to Him who had promised to supply
+all our need.
+
+At this point a respectable man came up, and earnestly warned us against
+proceeding, saying that if we did we should find to our sorrow what the
+T'ung-chau militia were like. We thanked him for his kindly counsel, but
+could not act upon it, as our hearts were fixed, whether it were to
+bonds, imprisonment, and death, or whether to distribute our Scriptures
+and tracts in safety, and return unhurt, we knew not; but we were
+determined, by the grace of GOD, not to leave T'ung-chau any longer
+without the Gospel, nor its teeming thousands to die in uncared-for
+ignorance of the Way of life.
+
+After this my wheel-barrow man would proceed no farther, and I had to
+seek another, who was fortunately not difficult to find. As we went on,
+the ride in the mud and rain was anything but agreeable, and we could
+not help feeling the danger of our position, although wavering not for a
+moment. At intervals we encouraged one another with promises from the
+Scripture and verses of hymns. That verse--
+
+ "The perils of the sea, the perils of the land,
+ Should not dishearten thee: thy LORD is nigh at hand.
+ But should thy courage fail, when tried and sore oppressed,
+ His promise shall avail, and set thy soul at rest."
+
+seemed particularly appropriate to our circumstances, and was very
+comforting to me.
+
+On our way we passed through one small town of about a thousand
+inhabitants; and here, in the Mandarin dialect, I preached JESUS to a
+good number of people. Never was I so happy in speaking of the love of
+GOD and the atonement of JESUS CHRIST. My own soul was richly blessed,
+and filled with joy and peace; and I was able to speak with unusual
+freedom and ease. And how rejoiced I was when, afterwards, I heard one
+of our hearers repeating to the newcomers, in his own local dialect, the
+truths upon which I had been dwelling! Oh, how thankful I felt to hear a
+Chinaman, of his own accord, telling his fellow-countrymen that GOD
+loved them; that they were sinners, but that JESUS died instead of
+them, and paid the penalty of their guilt. That one moment repaid me for
+all the trials we had passed through; and I felt that if the LORD should
+grant HIS HOLY SPIRIT to change the heart of that man, we had not come
+in vain.
+
+We distributed a few Testaments and tracts, for the people were able to
+read, and we could not leave them without the Gospel. It was well that
+we did so, for when we reached T'ung-chau we found we had quite as many
+left as we had strength to carry.
+
+Nearing the end of our journey, as we approached the western suburb of
+the city, the prayer of the early Christians, when persecution was
+commencing, came to my mind: "And now, LORD, behold their threatenings,
+and grant unto Thy servants that with all boldness they may speak Thy
+Word." In this petition we most heartily united. Before entering the
+suburb we laid our plans, so as to act in concert, and told our
+wheel-barrow men where to await us, that they might not be involved in
+any trouble on our account. Then looking up to our Heavenly FATHER, we
+committed ourselves to His keeping, took our books, and set on for the
+city.
+
+For some distance we walked along the principal street of the suburb
+leading to the West Gate unmolested, and were amused at the unusual
+title of _Heh-kwei-tsi_ (black devils) which was applied to us. We
+wondered about it at the time, but afterwards found that it was our
+clothes, and not our skin, that gave rise to it. As we passed several of
+the soldiers, I remarked to Mr. Burdon that these were the men we had
+heard so much about, and that they seemed willing to receive us quietly
+enough. Long before we reached the gate, however, a tall powerful man,
+made tenfold fiercer by partial intoxication, let us know that all the
+militia were not so peaceably inclined, by seizing Mr. Burdon by the
+shoulders. My companion endeavoured to shake him off. I turned to see
+what was the matter, and at once we were surrounded by a dozen or more
+brutal men, who hurried us on to the city at a fearful pace.
+
+My bag now began to feel very heavy, and I could not change hands to
+relieve myself. I was soon in a profuse perspiration, and was scarcely
+able to keep pace with them. We demanded to be taken before the chief
+magistrate, but were told that they knew where to take us, and what to
+do with such persons as we were, with the most insulting epithets. The
+man who first seized Mr. Burdon soon afterwards left him for me, and
+became my principal tormentor; for I was neither so tall nor so strong
+as my friend, and was therefore less able to resist him. He all but
+knocked me down again and again, seized me by the hair, took hold of my
+collar so as to almost choke me, and grasped my arms and shoulders,
+making them black and blue. Had this treatment continued much longer, I
+must have fainted. All but exhausted, how refreshing was the remembrance
+of a verse quoted by my dear mother in one of my last home letters--
+
+ "We speak of the realms of the blest,
+ That country so bright and so fair,
+ And oft are its glories confessed;
+ But what must it be to be there!"
+
+To be absent from the body! to be present with the LORD! to be free from
+sin! And this is the end of the worst that man's malice can ever bring
+upon us.
+
+As we were walking along Mr. Burdon tried to give away a few books that
+he was carrying, not knowing whether we might have another opportunity
+of doing so; but the fearful rage of the soldier, and the way he
+insisted on manacles being brought, which fortunately were not at hand,
+convinced us that in our present position we could do no good in
+attempting book-distribution. There was nothing to be done but quietly
+to submit, and go along with our captors.
+
+Once or twice a quarrel arose as to how we should be dealt with; the
+more mild of our conductors saying that we ought to be taken to the
+magistrate's office, but others wishing to kill us at once without
+appeal to any authority. Our minds were kept in perfect peace; and when
+thrown together on one of these occasions, we reminded each other that
+the Apostles rejoiced that they were counted _worthy_ to suffer in the
+cause of CHRIST. Having succeeded in getting my hand into my pocket, I
+produced a Chinese card (if the large red paper, bearing one's name, may
+be so called), and after this was treated with more respect. I demanded
+it should be given to the chief official of the place, and that we
+should be led to his office. Before this we had been unable, say what we
+would, to persuade them that we were foreigners, although we were both
+in English attire.
+
+Oh the long weary streets that we were dragged through! I thought they
+would never end; and seldom have I felt more thankful than when we
+stopped at a place where we were told a mandarin resided. Quite
+exhausted, bathed in perspiration, and with my tongue cleaving to the
+roof of my mouth, I leaned against the wall, and saw that Mr. Burdon was
+in much the same condition. I requested them to bring us chairs, but
+they told us to wait; and when I begged them to give us some tea,
+received only the same answer. Round the doorway a large crowd had
+gathered; and Mr. Burdon, collecting his remaining strength, preached
+CHRIST JESUS to them. Our cards and books had been taken in to the
+mandarin, but he proved to be one of low rank, and after keeping us
+waiting for some time he referred us to his superiors in office.
+
+Upon hearing this, and finding that it was their purpose to turn us out
+again into the crowded streets, we positively refused to move a single
+step, and insisted on chairs being brought. After some demur this was
+done; we seated ourselves in them, and were carried on. On the road we
+felt so glad of the rest which the chairs afforded us, and so thankful
+at having been able to preach JESUS in spite of Satan's malice, that our
+joy was depicted on our countenances; and as we passed along we heard
+some say that we did not look like bad men, while others seemed to pity
+us. When we arrived at the magistrate's office, I wondered where we were
+being taken; for though we passed through some great gates that looked
+like those of the city wall, we were still evidently within the city. A
+second pair of gates suggested the idea that it was a prison into which
+we were being carried; but when we came in sight of a large tablet, with
+the inscription "_Ming chï fu mu_" (the father and mother of the
+people), we felt that we had been conveyed to the right place; this
+being the title assumed by the mandarins.
+
+Our cards were again sent in, and after a short delay we were taken into
+the presence of Ch'en Ta Lao-ie (the Great Venerable Father Ch'en), who,
+as it proved, had formerly been Tao-tai of Shanghai, and consequently
+knew the importance of treating foreigners with courtesy. Coming before
+him, some of the people fell on their knees and bowed down to the
+ground, and my conductor motioned for me to do the same, but without
+success. This mandarin, who seemed to be the highest authority of
+T'ung-chau, and wore an opaque blue button on his cap, came out to meet
+us, and treated us with every possible token of respect. He took us to
+an inner apartment, a more private room, but was followed by a large
+number of writers, runners, and other semi-officials. I related the
+object of our visit, and begged permission to give him copies of our
+books and tracts, for which he thanked me. As I handed him a copy of the
+New Testament with part of the Old (from Genesis to Ruth) and some
+tracts, I tried to explain a little about them, and also to give him a
+brief summary of our teachings. . . . He listened very attentively, as of
+course did all the others present. He then ordered some refreshments to
+be brought in, which were very welcome, and himself partook of them with
+us.
+
+After a long stay, we asked permission to see something of the city, and
+to distribute the books we had brought, before our return. To this he
+kindly consented. We then mentioned that we had been most
+disrespectfully treated as we came in, but that we did not attach much
+importance to the fact, being aware that the soldiers knew no better.
+Not desiring, however, to have such an experience repeated, we requested
+him to give orders that we were not to be further molested. This also he
+promised to do, and with every possible token of respect accompanied us
+to the door of his official residence, sending several runners to see
+that we were respectfully treated. We distributed our books well and
+quickly, and left the city quite in state. It was amusing to us to see
+the way in which the runners made use of their tails. When the street
+was blocked by the crowd, they turned them into whips, and laid them
+about the people's shoulders to right and left!
+
+We had a little trouble in finding our wheel-barrows; but eventually
+succeeding, we paid off the chair coolies, mounted our humble vehicles,
+and returned to the river, accompanied for fully half the distance by an
+attendant from the magistrate's office. Early in the evening we got back
+to the boats in safety, sincerely thankful to our Heavenly FATHER for
+His gracious protection and aid.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XI
+
+WITH THE REV. WILLIAM BURNS
+
+
+AFTER the retaking of Shanghai by the Imperialists, in February 1855, I
+was enabled to rent a house within the walls of the native city, and
+gladly availed myself of this opportunity to reside amidst the crowded
+population left to inhabit the ruins that had survived the war. Here I
+made my headquarters, though often absent on more or less prolonged
+itinerations.
+
+At the suggestion of the Rev. Dr. Medhurst, the veteran leader of the
+London Mission, I was led at about this period to adopt the native
+costume in preference to foreign dress, to facilitate travel and
+residence inland. The Chinese had permitted a foreign firm to build a
+silk factory some distance inland, with the proviso that the style of
+building must be purely Chinese, and that there should be nothing
+external to suggest that it was foreign. Much benefit was found to
+result from this change of costume; and I, and most of those associated
+with me, have continued to use native dress.
+
+The T'ai-p'ing rebellion, commenced in 1851, had by this time reached
+the height of its ephemeral success. The great city of Nan-king had
+fallen before the invading host; and there, within two hundred miles of
+Shanghai, the rebels had established their headquarters, and proceeded
+to fortify themselves for further conquests. During the summer of 1855
+various attempts were made to visit the leaders of the movement, in
+order to bring to bear some decidedly Christian influence upon them; but
+so little success was met with, that these efforts were abandoned.
+
+I, amongst others, had sought to reach Nan-king; but finding it
+impossible to do so, turned my attention again to evangelistic work on
+the island of Ts'ung-ming. After some time I was enabled so far to
+overcome the prejudice and fears of the people as to rent a little house
+and settle down in their midst. This was a great joy and encouragement
+to me; but before many weeks were over complaints were made by the local
+authorities to the British Consul, who compelled me to retire; though
+the French Consul had himself secured to the Romish missionaries a
+property within three or four miles of the house I had to vacate. Sorely
+tried and disappointed by this unexpected hindrance, I reluctantly
+returned to Shanghai, little dreaming of the blessing that GOD had in
+store for me there.
+
+A few months previously the Rev. William Burns, of the English
+Presbyterian Mission, had arrived in that port on his return journey
+from home; and before proceeding to his former sphere of service in the
+southern province of FU-KIEN, he had endeavoured, like myself, without
+success, to visit the T'ai-p'ing rebels at Nan-king. Failing in this
+attempt, he made his headquarters in Shanghai for a season, devoting
+himself to the evangelisation of the surrounding populous regions. Thus
+in the autumn of the year I was providentially led into association with
+this beloved and honoured servant of GOD.
+
+We journeyed together, evangelising cities and towns in southern
+KIANG-SU and north CHEH-KIANG, living in our boats, and following the
+course of the canals and rivers which here spread like a network over
+the whole face of the rich and fertile country. Mr. Burns at that time
+was wearing English dress; but saw that while I was the younger and in
+every way less experienced, I had the quiet hearers, while he was
+followed by the rude boys, and by the curious but careless; that I was
+invited to the homes of the people, while he received an apology that
+the crowd that would follow precluded his being invited. After some
+weeks of observation he also adopted the native dress, and enjoyed the
+increased facilities which it gave.
+
+Those happy months were an unspeakable joy and privilege to me. His love
+for the Word was delightful, and his holy, reverential life and constant
+communings with GOD made fellowship with him satisfying to the deep
+cravings of my heart. His accounts of revival work and of persecutions
+in Canada, and Dublin, and in Southern China were most instructive, as
+well as interesting; for with true spiritual insight he often pointed
+out GOD's purposes in trial in a way that made all life assume quite a
+new aspect and value. His views especially about evangelism as the great
+work of the Church, and the order of lay evangelists as a lost order
+that Scripture required to be restored, were seed-thoughts which were to
+prove fruitful in the subsequent organisation of the China Inland
+Mission.
+
+Externally, however, our path was not always a smooth one; but when
+permitted to stay for any length of time in town or city, the
+opportunity was well utilised. We were in the habit of leaving our
+boats, after prayer for blessing, at about nine o'clock in the morning,
+with a light bamboo stool in hand. Selecting a suitable station, one
+would mount the stool and speak for twenty minutes, while the other was
+pleading for blessing; and then changing places, the voice of the first
+speaker had a rest. After an hour or two thus occupied, we would move on
+to another point at some distance from the first, and speak again.
+Usually about midday we returned to our boats for dinner, fellowship,
+and prayer, and then resumed our out-door work until dusk. After tea and
+further rest, we would go with our native helpers to some tea-shop,
+where several hours might be spent in free conversation with the people.
+Not infrequently before leaving a town we had good reason to believe
+that much truth had been grasped; and we placed many Scriptures and
+books in the hands of those interested. The following letter was written
+by Mr. Burns to his mother at home in Scotland about this time:--
+
+
+ "TWENTY-FIVE MILES FROM SHANGHAI,
+ _January 26th, 1856_.
+
+ "Taking advantage of a rainy day which confines me
+ to my boat, I pen a few lines, in addition to a
+ letter to Dundee, containing particulars which I
+ need not repeat. It is now forty-one days since I
+ left Shanghai on this last occasion. A young
+ English missionary, Mr. Taylor, of the Chinese
+ Evangelisation Society, has been my companion
+ during these weeks--he in his boat, and I in
+ mine--and we have experienced much mercy, and on
+ some occasions considerable assistance in our
+ work.
+
+ "I must once more tell the story I have had to
+ tell already more than once--how four weeks ago,
+ on December 29th, I put on the Chinese dress,
+ which I am now wearing. Mr. Taylor had made this
+ change a few months before, and I found that he
+ was, in consequence, so much less incommoded in
+ preaching, etc., by the crowd, that I concluded it
+ was my duty to follow his example. We were at that
+ time more than double the distance from Shanghai
+ that we are now, and would still have been at as
+ great a distance had we not met at one place with
+ a band of lawless people, who demanded money and
+ threatened to break our boats if their demands
+ were refused. The boatmen were very much alarmed,
+ and insisted on returning to some place nearer
+ home. These people had previously broken in,
+ violently, a part of Mr. Taylor's boat, because
+ their unreasonable demand for books was not
+ complied with.
+
+ "We have a large, very large, field of labour in
+ this region, though it might be difficult in the
+ meantime for one to establish himself in any
+ particular place; the people listen with
+ attention, but we need the Power from on High to
+ convince and convert. Is there any spirit of
+ prayer on our behalf among GOD's people in
+ Kilsyth? or is there any effort to seek this
+ spirit? How great the need is, and how great the
+ arguments and motives for prayer in this case. The
+ harvest here is indeed great, and the labourers
+ are few, and imperfectly fitted without much grace
+ for such a work. And yet grace can make the few
+ and feeble instruments the means of accomplishing
+ great things--things greater than we can even
+ conceive."
+
+The incident referred to in this letter, which led to our return to
+Shanghai more speedily than we had at first intended, took place on the
+northern border of CHEH-KIANG. We had reached a busy market town known
+by the name of Wu-chen, or Black Town, the inhabitants of which, we had
+been told, were the wildest and most lawless people in that part of the
+country. Such indeed we found them to be: the town was a refuge for salt
+smugglers and other bad characters. The following extracts are taken
+from my journal, written at the time:--
+
+
+ _January 8th, 1856._
+
+Commenced our work in Wu-chen this morning by distributing a large
+number of tracts and some Testaments. The people seemed much surprised,
+and we could not learn that any foreigner had been here before. We
+preached twice--once in the temple of the God of War, and afterwards in
+an empty space left by a fire, which had completely destroyed many
+houses. In the afternoon we preached again to a large and attentive
+audience on the same site; and in the evening adjourned to a tea-shop,
+where we had a good opportunity of speaking until it got noised abroad
+that we were there, when, too many people coming in, we were obliged to
+leave. Our native assistants, Tsien and Kuei-hua, were able, however, to
+remain. Returning to our boats, we spoke to a number of people standing
+on a bridge, and felt we had abundant reason to be thankful and
+encouraged by the result of our first day's labour.
+
+
+ _January 10th._
+
+First sent Tsien and Kuei-hua to distribute some sheet tracts. After
+their return we went with them, and in a space cleared by fire we
+separated, and addressed two audiences. On our return to the boats for
+lunch, we found people waiting, as usual, and desiring books. Some were
+distributed to those who were able to read them; and then asking them
+kindly to excuse us while we took our midday meal, I went into my boat
+and shut the door.
+
+Hardly was there time to pour out a cup of tea when a battering began,
+and the roof was at once broken in. I went out at the back, and found
+four or five men taking the large lumps of frozen earth turned up in a
+field close by--weighing, I should suppose, from seven to fourteen
+pounds each--and throwing them at the boat. Remonstrance was of no
+avail, and it was not long ere a considerable part of the upper
+structure of the boat was broken to pieces, and a quantity of earth
+covered the things inside. Finally, Tsien got a boat that was passing to
+land him at a short distance, and by a few tracts drew away the
+attention of the men, thus ending the assault.
+
+We now learned that of those who had done the mischief only two were
+natives of the place, the others being salt smugglers, and that the
+cause was our not having satisfied their unreasonable demand for books.
+Most providentially no one was injured; and as soon as quiet was
+somewhat restored, we all met in Mr. Burns's boat and joined in
+thanksgiving that we had been preserved from personal harm, praying also
+for the perpetrators of the mischief, and that it might be over-ruled
+for good to us and to those with us. We then took our lunch and went on
+shore, and but a few steps from the boats addressed a large multitude
+that soon assembled. We were specially assisted; never were we heard
+with more attention, and not one voice was found to sympathise with the
+men who had molested us. In the evening, at the tea-shops, the same
+spirit was manifested, and some seemed to hear with joy the glad tidings
+of salvation through a crucified and risen SAVIOUR.
+
+As we came home we passed a barber's shop still open, and I went in, and
+while getting my head shaved had an opportunity of speaking to a few
+people, and afterwards pasted a couple of sheet tracts on the wall for
+the benefit of future customers.
+
+
+ _January 11th._
+
+A respectable shop-keeper of the name of Yao, who on the first or second
+day of our stay at Wu-chen had received portions of the New Testament
+and a tract, came yesterday, when our boat was broken, to beg for some
+more books. At that time we were all in confusion from the damage done,
+and from the earth thrown into the boat, and so invited him to come
+again in a day or two's time, when we would gladly supply him. This
+morning he appeared and handed in the following note:--
+
+"On a former day I begged Burns and Taylor, the two '_Rabbis_,' to give
+me good books. It happened at that time those of our town whose hearts
+were deceived by _Satan_, not knowing the _Son of David_, went so far as
+to dare to '_raca_' and '_moreh_' and injure your respected boat. I
+thank you for promising afterwards to give the books, and beg the
+following: Complete New Testament, 'Discourse of a Good Man when near
+his Death,' 'Important Christian Doctrines,' an Almanack, 'Principles of
+Christianity,' 'Way to make the World happy,'--of each one copy. Sung
+and Tsien, and all teachers I hope are well. Further compliments are
+unwritten."
+
+This note is interesting, as showing that he had been reading the New
+Testament attentively, as the italicised words were all taken from it.
+His use of "raca" and "moreh" for reviling, shows their meaning was not
+lost upon him.
+
+After supplying this man, we went out with Tsien and Kuei-hua to the
+east of the town, and spoke in the street for a short time. Upon
+returning to the boats, I was visited by two CHIH-LI men, who are in the
+magistrate's office here. I was greatly helped in speaking to them of a
+crucified SAVIOUR in the Mandarin dialect; and though one of them did
+not pay much attention, the other did, and made inquiries that showed
+the interest he was feeling. When they had left, I went on shore and
+spoke to the people collected there, to whom Kuei-hua had been
+preaching. The setting sun afforded a parable, and reminded one of the
+words of JESUS, "The night cometh, when no man can work;" and as I spoke
+of the uncertain duration of this life, and of our ignorance as to the
+time of CHRIST'S return, a degree of deep seriousness prevailed that I
+had never previously witnessed in China. I engaged in prayer, and the
+greatest decorum was observed. I then returned to my boat with a
+Buddhist priest who had been in the audience, and he admitted that
+Buddhism was a system of deceit that could give no hope in death.
+
+
+ _January 12th._
+
+In the afternoon we addressed the people on shore close to our boats,
+also in one of the streets of the city, and in a tea-shop, books being
+distributed on each occasion. In the evening we went as usual to speak
+in the tea-shops, but determined to go to the opposite end of the town,
+in order to afford those who lived there a better opportunity of meeting
+with us. It was a long straggling place, nearly two English miles in
+length. As Mr. Burns and I were accustomed to talk together in Chinese,
+this conclusion was known to those in the boats.
+
+After we had proceeded a short distance we changed our minds, and went
+instead to the usual tea-shop, thinking that persons might have gone
+there expecting to meet us. But this was not the case; and we did not
+find such serious hearers as we had done on previous occasions. On this
+account Mr. Burns proposed leaving earlier than usual, and we did so,
+telling Tsien and Kuei-hua that they might remain a little longer.
+Returning to the boats, we gave away a few books; but, singularly
+enough, were left to go alone, no one accompanying us, as is so
+generally the case. Instead of being a clear night, as it was when we
+started, we found that it had become intensely dark. On our way we met
+the boatman, whose manner seemed very strange, and without giving us any
+explanation he blew out the candle of our lantern; we relighted the
+lantern, telling him not to put it out again, when to our surprise he
+deliberately removed the candle and threw it into the canal. He then
+walked down along a low wall jutting out to the river's edge, and gazed
+into the water.
+
+Not knowing what was the matter with him, I ran forward to hold him,
+fearful lest he were going to drown himself; but to my great relief he
+came quietly back. In answer to our repeated questions he told us not to
+speak, for some bad men were seeking to destroy the boats, and they had
+moved away to avoid them. He then led us to the place where one of them
+was lying. Before long Tsien and Kuei-hua came and got safely on board,
+and soon after we were joined by the teacher Sung, and the boat moved
+away.
+
+The cause of all this disturbance was then explained. A man professing
+to be the constable had come to the boats in our absence, with a written
+demand for ten dollars and a quantity of opium. He stated that there
+were more than fifty country people (salt smugglers) awaiting our reply
+in an adjoining tea-shop; and if we gave them what they wanted, and
+three hundred cash to pay for their tea, we might remain in peace; but
+that if not, they would come at once and destroy our boats. Sung told
+them that we could not comply with their demand; for, not being engaged
+in trade, but only in preaching and book-distribution, we had not an
+atom of opium, and that our money was nearly all expended. The man,
+however, told him plainly that he did not believe him, and Sung had no
+alternative but to seek us out, desiring the man to await our reply. Not
+knowing that we had changed our plans, he sought us in the wrong
+direction, and of course in vain.
+
+In the meanwhile the boatmen had succeeded in moving off. They were very
+much alarmed; and having so recently had proof of what these men would
+do in open daylight, felt no desire to experience what they might
+attempt by night. Moving away, therefore, they had separated, so that if
+one boat should be injured the other might afford us a refuge. It was
+after this that we had providentially met the boatman, and had been
+safely led on board. As Sung repassed the place where we were previously
+moored, he saw between the trees a dozen or more men, and heard them
+inquiring where the boats had gone to; but no one could tell.
+Fortunately they sought in vain.
+
+After a while the two boats joined, and rowed together for some time. It
+was already late, and to travel by night in that part of the country was
+not the way to avoid danger from evil men; so the question arose as to
+what should be done. This we left for the boatmen to decide; they had
+moved off of their own accord, and we felt that whatever we personally
+might desire we could not constrain others to remain in a position of
+danger on our account. We urged them, however, to do quickly whatever
+they intended to do, as the morrow was the LORD'S DAY, when we should
+not wish to travel. We also informed them that wherever we were we must
+fulfil our mission, and preach the Gospel; it therefore made but little
+difference where we might stay, for even if we passed the night
+unperceived, we were sure to be found out on the following morning. The
+men consequently concluded that we might as well return to the place
+from which we had started; to this we fully agreed, and they turned back
+accordingly. But--whether by accident or no we could not tell--they got
+into another stream, and rowed for some time they knew not whither. At
+last, as it was very dark, they moored for the night.
+
+We then called all the boatmen together, with our native assistants, and
+read to them the ninety-first Psalm. It may be imagined how appropriate
+to our position and need and how sweetly consoling was this portion of
+GOD'S Word:--
+
+ "He that dwelleth in the secret place of the MOST HIGH
+ Shall abide under the shadow of the ALMIGHTY.
+ I will say of the LORD, _He_ is my refuge and my fortress:
+ My GOD; in Him will I trust.
+
+ "Surely He shall deliver thee from the snare of the fowler,
+ And from the noisome pestilence.
+
+ He shall cover thee with His feathers, and under His wings
+ shalt thou trust:
+ His truth shall be thy shield and buckler.
+ Thou shalt not be afraid for the terror by night;
+ Nor for the arrow that flieth by day.
+
+ "Because he hath set his love upon Me, therefore will I deliver him.
+ I will set him on high, because he hath known My Name.
+ He shall call upon Me, and I will answer him;
+ I will be with him in trouble;--I will deliver him, and honour him.
+ With long life will I satisfy him,--and show him My salvation."
+
+Committing ourselves in prayer to His care and keeping Who had covered
+us with thick darkness and permitted us to escape from the hand of the
+violent, we retired for the night; which--thanks to the kind protection
+of the WATCHMAN OF ISRAEL, who neither slumbers nor forgets His
+people--we passed in peace and quietness, and were enabled, in some
+measure, to realise the truth of that precious word, "_Thou_ art my
+_Hiding-place_, and my _Shield_."
+
+
+ _Sunday, January 13th._
+
+This morning I was awakened about 4 A.M. by violent pain in the
+knee-joint. I had bruised it the day before, and severe inflammation was
+the result. To my great surprise I heard the rain pouring down in
+torrents, the weather having previously been particularly fine. On
+looking out, we found ourselves so near our former stopping-place, that,
+had nothing happened to prevent it, we should not have felt justified in
+neglecting to go into the town to preach as usual; but the rain was so
+heavy all day that no one could leave the boats. Thus we enjoyed a
+delightful day of rest, such as we had not had for some time; and the
+weather prevented much inquiry being made for us. Had the day been fine
+we should most likely have been discovered, even if we had not left the
+boats. As it was, we were allowed to think in peace, with wonder and
+gratitude, of the gracious dealings of our GOD, who had thus led us
+apart into "a desert place" to rest awhile.
+
+
+ _Monday, January 14th._
+
+A cloudless morning. One of the native assistants went before daybreak
+to get some clothes which had been given out for washing. He came back
+with the tidings that, notwithstanding the drenching rain of yesterday,
+men had been seeking us in all directions. We had been kept, however, in
+peace and safety "under the shadow of the Almighty."
+
+The boatmen were now so thoroughly alarmed that they would stay no
+longer, and moved off at dawn. I was confined to my quarters by
+lameness, and had no alternative but to go with them. In the afternoon
+we reached Ping-wang, on the way to Shanghai.
+
+ "Ill that GOD blesses is our good,
+ And unblest good is ill;
+ And all is right that seems most wrong,
+ If it be His sweet will."
+
+[Illustration]
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XII
+
+CALLED TO SWATOW
+
+
+HAVING to leave the neighbourhood of Black Town thus unexpectedly was a
+real disappointment to us, as we had hoped to spend some time
+evangelising in that district. We were to prove, however, that no
+unforeseen mischance had happened, but that these circumstances which
+seemed so trying were necessary links in the chain of a divinely ordered
+providence, guiding to other and wider spheres.
+
+GOD does not permit persecution to arise without sufficient reason. . . .
+He was leading us by a way that we knew not; but it was none the less
+His way.
+
+ "O LORD, how happy should we be
+ If we would cast our care on Thee,
+ If we from self would rest;
+ And feel at heart that One above,
+ In perfect wisdom, perfect love,
+ Is working for the best!"
+
+When we reached Shanghai, thinking to return inland in a few days with
+fresh supplies of books and money, we met a Christian captain who had
+been trading at Swatow, and he put very strongly before us the need of
+that region, and the fact that there were British merchants living on
+Double Island, selling opium and engaged in the coolie trade
+(practically a slave traffic), while there was no British missionary to
+preach the Gospel. The SPIRIT OF GOD impressed me with the feeling that
+this was His call, but for days I felt that I could not obey it. I had
+never had such a spiritual father as Mr. Burns; I had never known such
+holy, happy fellowship; and I said to myself that it could not be GOD'S
+will that we should separate.
+
+In great unrest of soul I went one evening, with Mr. Burns, to take tea
+at the house of the Rev. R. Lowrie, of the American Presbyterian
+Mission, at the South Gate of Shanghai. After tea Mrs. Lowrie played
+over to us "The Missionary Call."[2] I had never heard it before, and it
+greatly affected me. My heart was almost broken before it was finished,
+and I said to the LORD, in the words that had been sung--
+
+ "And I will go!
+ I may no longer doubt to give up friends, and idol hopes,
+ And every tie that binds my heart. . . .
+ Henceforth, then, it matters not, if storm or sunshine
+ be my earthly lot, bitter or sweet my cup;
+ I only pray, GOD, make me holy,
+ And my spirit nerve for the stern hour of strife."
+
+Upon leaving I asked Mr. Burns to come home with me to the little house
+that was still my headquarters in the native city, and there, with many
+tears, told him how the LORD had been leading me, and how rebellious I
+had been and unwilling to leave him for this new sphere of labour. He
+listened with a strange look of surprise, and of pleasure rather than
+pain; and answered that he had determined that very night to tell me
+that he had heard the LORD'S call to Swatow, and that his one regret had
+been the prospect of the severance of our happy fellowship. We went
+together; and thus was recommenced missionary work in that part of
+China, which in later years has been so abundantly blessed.
+
+Long before this time the Rev. R. Lechler, of the Basel Missionary
+Society, had widely itinerated in the neighbourhood of Swatow and the
+surrounding regions. Driven about from place to place, he had done work
+that was not forgotten, although ultimately he was obliged to retire to
+Hong-kong. For more than forty years this earnest-hearted servant of GOD
+has continued in "labours more abundant"; and quite recently he has left
+Hong-kong, with his devoted wife, to return again inland, and spend the
+strength of his remaining years amongst the people he has so long and
+truly loved.
+
+Captain Bowers, the Christian friend who had been used of GOD in
+bringing the needs of Swatow before Mr. Burns and myself, was overjoyed
+when he heard of our decision to devote ourselves to the evangelisation
+of that busy, important, and populous mart. Being about to sail himself
+on his return journey, he gladly offered us free passages on board the
+_Geelong_, in which we left Shanghai early in the month of March 1856.
+
+A favourable journey of six days brought us to Double Island, where we
+found ourselves landed in the midst of a small but very ungodly
+community of foreigners, engaged in the opium trade and other commercial
+enterprises. Unwilling to be in any way identified with these
+fellow-countrymen, we were most desirous of obtaining quarters at once
+within the native city, situated on a promontory of the mainland, five
+miles farther up, at the mouth of the Han river. Great difficulty was
+experienced in this attempt to obtain a footing amongst the people.
+Indeed, it seemed as though we should fail altogether, and we were
+helplessly cast upon the LORD in prayer. Our GOD soon undertook for us.
+Meeting one day with a Cantonese merchant, a relative of the highest
+official in the town, Mr. Burns addressed him in the Cantonese dialect;
+this gentleman was so pleased at being spoken to by a foreigner in his
+own tongue that he became our friend, and secured us a lodging. We had
+only one little room, however, and not easily shall I forget the long
+hot summer months in that oven-like place, where towards the eaves one
+could touch the heated tiles with one's hand. More room or better
+accommodation it was impossible to obtain.
+
+We varied our stay by visits to the surrounding country; but the
+difficulties and dangers that encountered us here were so great and
+constant, that our former work in the North began to appear safe and
+easy in comparison. The hatred and contempt of the Cantonese was very
+painful, "foreign devil," "foreign dog," or "foreign pig" being the
+commonest appellations; but all this led us into deeper fellowship than
+I had ever known before with Him who was "despised and rejected of men."
+
+In our visits to the country we were liable to be seized at any time and
+held to ransom; and the people commonly declared that the whole district
+was "without emperor, without ruler, and without law." Certainly, might
+was right in those days. On one occasion we were visiting a small town,
+and found that the inhabitants had captured a wealthy man of another
+clan. A large ransom was demanded for his release, and on his refusing
+to pay it they had smashed his ankle-bones, one by one, with a club, and
+thus extorted the promise they desired. There was nothing but GOD'S
+protection to prevent our being treated in the same way. The towns were
+all walled, and one such place would contain ten or twenty thousand
+people of the same clan and surname, who were frequently at war with the
+people living in the next town. To be kindly received in one place was
+not uncommonly a source of danger in the next. In circumstances such as
+these the preserving care of our GOD was often manifested.
+
+After a time the local mandarin became ill, and the native doctors were
+unable to relieve him. He had heard from some who had been under my
+treatment of the benefit derived, and was led to seek our help. GOD
+blessed the medicines given, and grateful for relief, he advised our
+renting a house for a hospital and dispensary. Having his permission, we
+were able to secure the entire premises, one room of which we had
+previously occupied. I had left my stock of medicine and surgical
+instruments under the care of my friend, the late Mr. Wylie, in
+Shanghai, and went back at once to fetch them.
+
+Mr. Burns came down from a town called Am-po, that we had visited
+together several times, to see me off, and returned again when I had
+sailed, with two native evangelists sent up from Hong-kong by the Rev.
+J. Johnson, of the American Baptist Missionary Union. The people were
+willing to listen to their preaching, and to accept their books as a
+gift, but they would not buy them. One night robbers broke in and
+carried off everything they had, with the exception of their stock of
+literature, which was supposed to be valueless. Next morning, very
+early, they were knocked up by persons wishing to buy books, and the
+sales continued; so that by breakfast time they had not only cash enough
+to procure food, but to pay also for the passage of one of the men to
+Double Island, below Swatow, with a letter to Mr. Burns's agent to
+supply him with money. Purchasers continued coming during that day and
+the next, and our friends lacked nothing; but on the third day they
+could not sell a single book. Then, however, when the cash from their
+sales was just exhausted, the messenger returned with supplies.
+
+It was early in July, after about four months' residence in Swatow, that
+I left for Shanghai, intending to return in the course of a few weeks,
+bringing with me my medical apparatus, for further work in association
+with the Rev. William Burns. A new and promising field seemed to be
+opening before us, and it was with much hopeful anticipation that we
+looked forward to the future of the work. Marked blessing was indeed in
+store for the city and neighbourhood of Swatow; but it was not the
+purpose of GOD that either of us should remain to reap the harvest. Mr.
+Burns while in the interior was taken up and imprisoned by the Chinese
+authorities soon after I left, and was sent to Canton. And though he
+returned to Swatow after the war had broken out, he was called away for
+other service, which prevented his subsequent return; while my journey
+to Shanghai proved to be the first step in a diverging pathway leading
+to other spheres.
+
+FOOTNOTE:
+
+[2] For words and music see the end of this chapter.
+
+
+[Illustration: Music: The Missionary Call]
+
+"THE MISSIONARY CALL"
+
+ 1. My soul is not at rest.
+ There comes a strange
+ and secret whisper to
+ my. . . .
+ spirit, like a dream of night,
+ that tells me
+ I am on enchanted
+ ground.
+
+
+ CHORUS FOR FIRST FOUR VERSES.
+
+ _Vivace._ The voice of my departed LORD, "Go, teach all nations,"
+
+ Comes on the night air and awakes mine ear.
+
+
+ CHORUS FOR LAST VERSE.
+
+ Through ages of eternal years,
+ My spirit never shall repent,
+ that toil and suff'ring once were mine . . . below.
+
+
+ 2. Why live I here? the vows of GOD are | on me; | and I may not stop
+ to play with shadows or pluck earthly flowers, | till I my work
+ have done, and | rendered up ac | count.
+
+ 3. And I will | go! | I may no longer doubt to give up friends,
+ and idol | hopes, | and every tie that binds my heart to | thee, my |
+ country.
+
+ 4. Henceforth, then, it matters not, if storm or sunshine be my |
+ earthly lot, | bitter or sweet my | cup; | I only pray: "GOD make me
+ holy, and my spirit nerve for the stern | hour of strife!"
+
+ 5. And when one for whom Satan hath struggled as he hath for | me, |
+ has gained at last that blessed | shore, | Oh! how this heart will
+ glow with | gratitude and | love.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIII
+
+MAN PROPOSES, GOD DISPOSES
+
+
+IT is interesting to notice the various events which united, in the
+providence of GOD, in preventing my return to Swatow, and ultimately led
+to my settling in Ningpo, and making that the centre for the development
+of future labours.
+
+Upon reaching Shanghai, great was my dismay to find that the premises in
+which my medicines and instruments had been stored were burnt down, and
+that all the medicines and many of the instruments were entirely
+destroyed. To me this appeared a great calamity, and I fear I was more
+disposed with faithless Jacob to say, "All these things are against me,"
+than to recognise that "All things work together for good." I had not
+then learned to think of GOD as the One Great Circumstance "in Whom we
+live, and move, and have our being"; and of _all_ lesser, external
+circumstances, as necessarily the kindest, wisest, best, because either
+ordered or permitted by Him. Hence my disappointment and trial were very
+great.
+
+Medicines were expensive in Shanghai, and my means were limited. I
+therefore set out on an inland journey to Ningpo, hoping to obtain a
+supply from Dr. William Parker, a member of the same mission as myself.
+I took with me my few remaining possessions, the principal being my
+watch, a few surgical instruments, a concertina, books for the study of
+Chinese, which in those days were very expensive; but left behind in
+Shanghai a portion of my money.
+
+The country through which I had to pass was suffering much from drought;
+it was the height of summer; and the water in the Grand Canal was very
+low, having been largely drawn upon for the neighbouring rice fields, as
+well as evaporated by the intense heat. I had determined to make the
+journey as much of a mission tour as possible, and set out well supplied
+with Christian tracts and books. After fourteen days spent in travelling
+slowly through the populous country, preaching and distributing books,
+etc., we reached a large town called Shih-mun-wan, and here, finding
+that my supply of literature was exhausted, I determined not to linger
+over the rest of the journey, but to reach Ningpo as speedily as
+possible, _viâ_ the city of Hai-ning.
+
+
+ _August 4th, 1856._
+
+There was no water beyond Shih-mun-wan, so I paid off my boat, hired
+coolies to carry my things as far as to Chang-gan, and ere sunrise we
+were on the way. I walked on alone, leaving my servant to follow with
+the men, who made frequent stoppages to rest; and on reaching a city
+through which we had to pass, I waited for them in a tea-shop just
+outside the North Gate. The coolies came on very slowly, and seemed
+tired when they arrived. I soon found that they were both opium-smokers,
+so that, although they had only carried a load that one strong man would
+think nothing of taking three times the distance, they really seemed
+wearied.
+
+After some rice and tea and an hour's rest--including, I doubt not, a
+smoke of the opium pipe--they were a little refreshed, and I proposed
+moving on, that we might get to Chang-gan before the sun became too
+powerful. My servant, however, had a friend in the city, and he desired
+to spend the day there, and to go on next morning. But to this I
+objected, wishing to reach Hai-ning that night if possible. . . . We
+therefore set off, entered the North Gate, and had passed through about
+a third of the city, when the coolies stopped to rest, and said they
+should be unable to carry the burden on to Chang-gan. Finally, they
+agreed to take it to the South Gate, where they were to be paid in
+proportion to the distance they had carried it; and the servant
+undertook to call other coolies and come along with them.
+
+I walked on before as in the first instance, and the distance being only
+about four miles, soon reached Chang-gan, and waited their arrival,
+meanwhile engaging coolies for the rest of the journey to Hai-ning.
+Having waited a long time, I began to wonder at the delay; and at length
+it became too late to finish the journey to Hai-ning that night. I felt
+somewhat annoyed; and but that my feet were blistered, and the afternoon
+very hot, I should have gone back to meet them and urge them on. At last
+I concluded that my servant must have gone to his friend's, and would
+not appear until evening. But evening came, and still there was no sign
+of them.
+
+Feeling very uneasy, I began diligently to inquire whether they had been
+seen. At last a man responded, "Are you a guest from Shih-mun-wan?" I
+answered in the affirmative. "Are you going to Hai-ning?" "That is my
+destination." "Then your things have gone on before you; for I was
+sitting in a tea-shop when a coolie came in, took a cup of tea, and set
+off for Hai-ning in a great hurry, saying that the bamboo box and bed he
+carried, which were just such as you describe yours to have been, were
+from Shih-mun-wan, and he had to take them to Hai-ning to-night, where
+he was to be paid at the rate of ten cash a pound." From this I
+concluded that my goods were on before me; but it was impossible to
+follow them at once, for I was too tired to walk, and it was already
+dark.
+
+Under these circumstances all I could do was to seek a lodging for the
+night; and no easy task I found it. After raising my heart to GOD to ask
+His aid, I walked through to the farther end of the town, where I
+thought the tidings of a foreigner's being in the place might not have
+spread, and looked out for an inn. I soon came to one, and went in,
+hoping that I might pass unquestioned, as it was already dark. Asking
+the bill of fare, I was told that cold rice--which proved to be more
+than "rather burnt"--and snakes, fried in lamp-oil, were all that could
+be had. Not wishing any question to be raised as to my nationality, I
+was compelled to order some, and tried to make a meal, but with little
+success.
+
+While thus engaged I said to the landlord, "I suppose I can arrange to
+spend the night here?"
+
+To which he replied in the affirmative; but bringing out his book, he
+added--
+
+"In these unsettled times we are required by the authorities to keep a
+record of our lodgers: may I ask your respected family name?"
+
+"My unworthy family name is Tai," I responded.
+
+"And your honourable second name?"
+
+"My humble name is Ia-koh" (James).
+
+"What an extraordinary name! I never heard it before. How do you write
+it?"
+
+I told him, and added, "It is a common name in the district from which I
+come."
+
+"And may I ask whence you come and whither you are going?"
+
+"I am journeying from Shanghai to Ningpo, by way of Hang-chau."
+
+"What may be your honourable profession?"
+
+"I heal the sick."
+
+"Oh! you are a physician," the landlord remarked; and to my intense
+relief closed the book. His wife, however, took up the conversation.
+
+"You are a physician, are you?" said she; "I am glad of that, for I have
+a daughter afflicted with leprosy. If you will cure her, you shall have
+your supper and bed for nothing."
+
+I was curious enough to inquire what my supper and bed were to cost, if
+paid for; and to my amusement found they were worth less than
+three-halfpence of our money!
+
+Being unable to benefit the girl, I declined to prescribe for her,
+saying that leprosy was a very intractable disease, and that I had no
+medicines with me.
+
+The mother, however, brought pen and paper, urging, "You can at least
+write a prescription, which will do no harm, if it does no good."
+
+But this also I declined to do, and requested to be shown my bed. I was
+conducted to a very miserable room on the ground-floor, where, on some
+boards raised upon two stools, I passed the night, without bed or
+pillow, save my umbrella and shoe, and without any mosquito netting. Ten
+or eleven other lodgers were sleeping in the same room, so I could not
+take anything off, for fear of its being stolen; but I was, I found, by
+no means too warm as midnight came on.
+
+
+ _August 5th._
+
+As may be supposed, I arose but little rested or refreshed, and felt
+very far from well. I had to wait a long time ere breakfast was
+obtainable, and then there was another delay before I could get change
+for the only dollar I had with me, in consequence of its being chipped
+in one or two places. More than three hundred cash also were deducted
+from its price on this account, which was a serious loss to me in my
+trying position.
+
+I then sought throughout the town for tidings of my servant and coolies,
+as I thought it possible that they might have arrived later, or have
+come on in the morning. The town is large, long, and straggling, being
+nearly two miles from one end to the other, so this occupied some time.
+I gained no information, however; and, footsore and weary, set out for
+Hai-ning in the full heat of the day. The journey--about eight
+miles--took me a long time; but a halfway village afforded a
+resting-place and a cup of tea, both of which I gladly availed myself
+of. When about to leave again, a heavy shower of rain came on, and the
+delay thus occasioned enabled me to speak a little to the people about
+the truths of the Gospel.
+
+The afternoon was far spent before I approached the northern suburb of
+Hai-ning, where I commenced inquiries, but could hear no tidings of my
+servant or things. I was told that outside the East Gate I should be
+more likely to hear of them, as it was there the sea-junks called. I
+therefore proceeded thither, and sought for them outside the Little East
+Gate, but in vain. Very weary, I sat down in a tea-shop to rest; and
+while there a number of persons from one of the mandarin's offices came
+in, and made inquiries as to who I was, where I had come from, etc. On
+learning the object of my search, one of the men in the tea-shop said,
+"A bamboo box and a bed, such as you describe, were carried past here
+about half an hour ago. The bearer seemed to be going towards either the
+Great East Gate or the South Gate; you had better go to the hongs there
+and inquire." I asked him to accompany me in the search, and promised to
+reward him for his trouble, but he would not. Another man offered to go
+with me, so we set off together, and both inside and outside the two
+gates made diligent inquiries, but all in vain. I then engaged a man to
+make a thorough search, promising him a liberal reward if he should be
+successful. In the meantime I had some dinner, and addressed a large
+concourse of people who had gathered together.
+
+When he returned, having met with no success, I said to him, "I am now
+quite exhausted: will you help me to find quarters for the night, and
+then I will pay you for your trouble?" He was willing to befriend me,
+and we set off in search of lodgings. At the first place or two the
+people would not receive me; for though on our first going in they
+seemed willing to do so, the presence of a man who followed us, and who,
+I found, was engaged in one of the Government offices, seemed to alarm
+them, and I was refused. We now went to a third place, and being no
+longer followed by the mandarin's messenger, we were promised quarters;
+some tea was brought, and I paid the man who had accompanied me for his
+trouble.
+
+Soon after he was gone some official people came in; they soon went
+away, but the result of their visit was that I was told I could not be
+entertained there that night. A young man present blamed them for their
+heartless behaviour, and said, "Never mind, come with me; and if we
+cannot get better lodgings for you, you shall sleep at our house." I
+went with him, but we found the people of his house unwilling to receive
+me. Weary and footsore, so that I could scarcely stand, I had again to
+seek quarters, and at length got promise of them; but a little crowd
+collecting about the door, they desired me to go to a tea-shop and wait
+there till the people had retired, or they would be unable to
+accommodate me. There was no help for it, so I went, accompanied still
+by the young man, and waited till past midnight. Then we left for the
+promised resting-place; but my conductor would not find it, and he led
+me about to another part of the city; and finally, between one and two
+o'clock, he left me to pass the rest of the night as best I could.
+
+I was opposite a temple, but it was closed; so I lay down on the stone
+steps in front of it, and putting my money under my head for a pillow,
+should soon have been asleep in spite of the cold had I not perceived a
+person coming stealthily towards me. As he approached I saw he was one
+of the beggars so common in China, and had no doubt his intention was to
+rob me of my money. I did not stir, but watched his movements, and
+looked to my FATHER not to leave me in this hour of trial. The man came
+up, looked at me for some time to assure himself that I was asleep (it
+was so dark that he could not see my eyes fixed on him), and then began
+to feel about me gently. I said to him in the quietest tone, but so as
+to convince him that I was not, nor had been, sleeping, "What do you
+want?" He made no answer, but went away.
+
+I was very thankful to see him go, and when he was out of sight put as
+much of my cash as would not go into my pocket safely up my sleeve, and
+made my pillow of a stone projection of the wall. It was not long ere I
+began to doze, but I was aroused by the all but noiseless footsteps of
+two persons approaching; for my nervous system was rendered so sensitive
+by exhaustion that the slightest noise startled me. Again I sought
+protection from Him who alone was my stay, and lay still as before, till
+one of them came up and began to feel under my head for the cash. I
+spoke again, and they sat down at my feet. I asked them what they were
+doing; they replied that they, like me, were going to pass the night
+there. I then requested them to take the opposite side, as there was
+plenty of room, and leave this side to me; but they would not move from
+my feet, so I raised myself up and set my back against the wall.
+
+They said, "You had better lie down and sleep; if you do not, you will
+be unable to walk to-morrow. Do not be afraid; we shall not leave you,
+and will see that no one hurts you."
+
+"Listen to me," I replied. "I do not want your protection; I need it
+not; I am not a Chinese; I do not worship your senseless, helpless
+idols. I worship GOD; He is my FATHER; I trust in Him. I know well what
+you are, and what your intentions are, and shall keep my eye on you, and
+shall not sleep."
+
+On this, one of them went away, but soon returned with a third
+companion. I felt very uneasy, but looked to GOD for help. Once or twice
+one of them got up to see if I was asleep. I only said, "Do not be
+mistaken; I am not sleeping." Occasionally my head dropped, and this was
+a signal for one of them to rise; but I at once roused myself and made
+some remark. As the night slowly passed on, I felt very weary; and to
+keep myself awake, as well as to cheer my mind, I sang several hymns,
+repeated aloud some portions of Scripture, and engaged in prayer in
+English, to the great annoyance of my companions, who seemed as if they
+would have given anything to get me to desist. After that they troubled
+me no more; and shortly before dawn of day they left me, and I got a
+little sleep.
+
+
+ _August 6th._
+
+I was awakened by the young man who had so misled me on the previous
+evening. He was very rude, and insisted on my getting up and paying him
+for his trouble, and even went so far as to try to accomplish by force
+what he wanted. This roused me; and in an unguarded moment, with very
+improper feeling, I seized his arm with such a grasp as he little
+expected I was capable of, and dared him to lay a finger upon me again
+or to annoy me further. This quite changed his manner; he let me quietly
+remain till the guns announced the opening of the gates of the city, and
+then he begged me to give him some money to buy opium with. It is
+needless to say this was refused. I gave him the price of two candles,
+that he said he had burnt while with me last night and no more. I
+learned he was connected with one of the mandarin's offices.
+
+As soon as possible, I bought some rice gruel and tea for breakfast, and
+then once more made a personal search after my things. Some hours thus
+spent proving unavailing, I set out on the return journey, and after a
+long, weary, and painful walk reached Chang-gan about noon. Here also my
+inquiries failed to give me any trace of the missing goods; so I had a
+meal cooked in a tea-shop, got a thorough wash and bathed my inflamed
+feet, and after dinner rested and slept till four in the afternoon.
+
+Much refreshed, I then set on to return to the city, at the South Gate
+of which I had parted with my servant and coolies two days before. On
+the way I was led to reflect on the goodness of GOD, and recollected
+that I had not made it a matter of prayer that I might be provided with
+lodgings last night. I felt condemned, too, that I should have been so
+anxious for my few things, while the many precious souls around me had
+caused so little emotion. I came as a sinner and pleaded the blood of
+JESUS, realising that I was accepted in Him--pardoned, cleansed,
+sanctified--and oh the love of JESUS, how great I felt it to be! I knew
+something more than I had ever previously known of what it was to be
+despised and rejected, and to have nowhere to lay one's head; and I felt
+more than ever I had done before the greatness of that love which
+induced Him to leave His home in glory and suffer thus for me; nay, to
+lay down His very life upon the Cross. I thought of Him as "despised and
+rejected of men, a Man of sorrows, and acquainted with grief"; I thought
+of Him at Jacob's well, weary, hungry, and thirsty, yet finding it His
+meat and drink to do His Father's will; and contrasted this with my
+littleness of love. I looked to Him for pardon for the past, and for
+grace and strength to do His will in the future, to tread more closely
+in His footsteps, and be more than ever wholly His. I prayed for myself,
+for friends in England, and for my brethren in the work. Sweet tears of
+mingled joy and sorrow flowed freely, the road was almost forgotten, and
+before I was aware of it I had reached my destination. Outside the South
+Gate I took a cup of tea, asked about my lost luggage, and spoke of the
+love of JESUS. Then I entered the city, and after many vain inquiries
+left it by the North Gate.
+
+I felt so much refreshed both in mind and body by the communion I had on
+my walk to the city that I thought myself able to finish the remaining
+six miles back to Shih-mun-wan that evening. First I went into another
+tea-shop to buy some native cakes, and was making a meal of them when
+who should come in but one of the identical coolies who had carried my
+things the first stage. From him I learned that after I left them they
+had taken my luggage to the South Gate; there my servant went away,
+saying on his return that I had gone on, that he did not intend to start
+at once, but would spend the day with his friend, and then rejoin me;
+they carried the things to this friend's house, and left them there. I
+got him to go with me to the house, and there learned that the man had
+spent the day and night with them, and next morning had called other
+coolies, and set off for Hang-chau. This was all I could gather; so,
+unable to do anything but proceed on my return journey to Shanghai with
+all expedition, I left the city again. It was now too late to go on to
+Shih-mun-wan. I looked to my FATHER as able to supply all my need, and
+received another token of His ceaseless love and care, being invited to
+sleep on a hong-boat, now dry in the bed of the river. The night was
+again very cold and the mosquitoes troublesome. Still, I got a little
+rest, and at sunrise was up and continued my journey.
+
+
+ _August 7th._
+
+I felt very ill at first, and had a sore throat, but reflected on the
+wonderful goodness of GOD in enabling me to bear the heat by day and the
+cold by night so long. I felt also that quite a load was now taken off
+my mind. I had committed myself and my affairs to the LORD, and knew
+that if it was for my good and for His glory my things would be
+restored; if not, all would be for the best. I hoped that the most
+trying part of my journey was now drawing to a close, and this helped
+me, weary and footsore, on the way. When I got to Shih-mun-wan and had
+breakfasted, I found I had still eight hundred and ten cash in hand; and
+I knew that the hong-boat fare to Kia-hing Fu was one hundred and twenty
+cash, and thence to Shanghai three hundred and sixty, leaving me just
+three hundred and thirty cash--or twelve pence and a fraction--for three
+or four days provisions. I went at once to the boat office, but to my
+dismay found that from the dry state of the river goods had not come
+down, so that no boat would leave to-day and perhaps none to-morrow. I
+inquired if there were no letter-boats for Kia-hing Fu, and was told
+that they had already left. The only remaining resource was to ascertain
+if any private boats were going in which I could get a passage. My
+search, however, was in vain; and I could get no boat to undertake to go
+all the way to Shanghai, or my difficulty would have been at an end.
+
+Just at this juncture I saw before me, at a turn in the canal, a
+letter-boat going in the direction of Kia-hing Fu This, I concluded,
+must be one of the Kia-hing boats that had been unexpectedly detained,
+and I set off after it as fast as hope and the necessities of the case
+would carry me. For the time being weariness and sore feet were alike
+forgotten. After a chase of about a mile I overtook it.
+
+"Are you going to Kia-hing Fu?" I called out.
+
+"No," was the only answer.
+
+"Are you going in that direction?"
+
+"No."
+
+"Will you give me a passage as far as you do go that way?"
+
+Still "No," and nothing more.
+
+Completely dispirited and exhausted, I sank down on the grass and
+fainted away.
+
+As consciousness returned some voices reached my ear, and I found they
+were talking about me. One said, "He speaks pure Shanghai dialect," and
+from their own speech I knew them to be Shanghai people. Raising myself,
+I saw that they were on a large hong-boat on the other side of the
+canal, and after a few words they sent their small boat to fetch me, and
+I went on board the junk. They were very kind, and gave me some tea; and
+when I was refreshed and able to partake of it, some food also. I then
+took my shoes and stockings off to ease my feet, and the boatman kindly
+provided me with hot water to bathe them. When they heard my story, and
+saw the blisters on my feet, they evidently pitied me, and hailed every
+boat that passed to see if it was going my way. Not finding one, by and
+by, after a few hours' sleep, I went ashore with the captain, intending
+to preach in the temple of Kwan-ti.
+
+Before leaving the junk I told the captain and those on board that I was
+now unable to help myself; that I had not strength to walk to Kia-hing
+Fu, and having been disappointed in getting a passage to-day, I should
+no longer have sufficient means to take me there by letter-boat, which
+was an expensive mode of travelling; that I knew not how the GOD whom I
+served would help me, but that I had no doubt He would do so; and that
+my business now was to serve Him where I was. I also told them that the
+help which I knew would come ought to be an evidence to them of the
+truth of the religion which I and the other missionaries at Shanghai
+preached.
+
+On our way to the town, while engaged in conversation with the captain,
+we saw a letter-boat coming up. The captain drew my attention to it; but
+I reminded him that I had no longer the means of paying my passage by
+it. He hailed it, nevertheless, and found that it was going to a place
+about nine English miles from Shanghai, whence one of the boatmen would
+carry the mails overland to the city. He then said, "This gentleman is a
+foreigner from Shanghai, who has been robbed, and has no longer the
+means of returning. If you will take him with you as far as you go, and
+then engage a sedan chair to carry him the rest of the way, he will pay
+you in Shanghai. You see my boat is lying aground yonder for want of
+water, and cannot get away. Now, I will stand surety; and if this
+gentleman does not pay when you get to Shanghai, I will do so on your
+return." This unsolicited kindness on the part of a Chinaman, a perfect
+stranger, will appear the more remarkable to any one acquainted with the
+character of the Chinese, who are generally most reluctant to risk their
+money. Those on the letter-boat agreeing to the terms, I was taken on
+board as a passenger. Oh, how thankful I felt for this providential
+interposition, and to be once more on my way to Shanghai!
+
+Letter-boats such as the one on which I was now travelling are of a
+long narrow build, and very limited as to their inside accommodation.
+One has to lie down all the time they are in motion, as a slight
+movement would easily upset them. This was no irksome condition to me,
+however; on the contrary, I was only too glad to be quiet. They are the
+quickest boats I have seen in China. Each one is worked by two men, who
+relieve one another continuously night and day. They row with their
+feet, and paddle with their hands; or if the wind is quite favourable,
+row with their feet, and with one hand manage a small sail, while
+steering with the other.
+
+After a pleasant and speedy journey, I reached Shanghai in safety on
+August 9th, through the help of Him who has said, "I will never leave
+thee, nor forsake thee;" "Lo, I am with you alway, even unto the end of
+the world."
+
+[Illustration]
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIV
+
+PROVIDENTIAL GUIDANCE
+
+
+IT now seemed very clear that the lost property--including everything I
+possessed in China, with the exception of a small sum of money
+providentially left in Shanghai--had been deliberately stolen by my
+servant, who had gone off with it to Hang-chau. The first question, of
+course, was how best to act for the good of the man who had been the
+cause of so much trouble. It would not have been difficult to take steps
+that would have led to his punishment; though the likelihood of any
+reparation being made for the loss sustained was very small. But the
+consideration which weighed most heavily was that the thief was a man
+for whose salvation I had laboured and prayed; and I felt that to
+prosecute him would not be to emphasise the teaching of the Sermon on
+the Mount, in which we had read together, "Resist not evil," and other
+similar precepts. Finally, concluding that his soul was of more value
+than the £40 worth of things I had lost, I wrote and told him this,
+urging upon him his need of repentance and faith in the LORD JESUS
+CHRIST. The course I took commended itself to my Christian friends in
+England, one of whom was afterwards led to send me a cheque for £40--the
+first of many subsequently received from the same kind helper.
+
+Having obtained the little money left in Shanghai, I again set out for
+Ningpo, to seek assistance from Dr. Parker in replacing the medicines I
+had previously lost by fire. This being satisfactorily accomplished, I
+returned once more to Shanghai, _en route_ for Swatow, hoping soon to
+rejoin my much-loved friend, Mr. Burns, in the work in that important
+centre. GOD had willed it otherwise, however; and the delay caused by
+the robbery was just sufficient to prevent me from starting for the
+South as I had intended.
+
+Over the political horizon storm-clouds had long been gathering,
+precursors of coming war; and early in October of this year (1856) the
+affair of the Lorcha _Arrow_ at Canton led to the definite commencement
+of hostilities. Very soon China was deeply involved in a second
+prolonged struggle with foreign powers; and missionary operations, in
+the South at any rate, had to be largely suspended. Tidings of these
+events, together with letters from Mr. Burns, arrived just in time to
+meet me in Shanghai as I was leaving for Swatow; and thus hindered, I
+could not but realise the hand of GOD in closing the door I had so much
+desired to enter.
+
+While in Ningpo, I had made the acquaintance of Mr. John Jones, who,
+with Dr. Parker, represented the Chinese Evangelisation Society in that
+city. Hindered from returning to Swatow, I now decided to join these
+brethren in the Ningpo work, and set out at once upon the journey. On
+the afternoon of the second day, when already about thirty miles distant
+from Shanghai, Mr. Jones and I drew near the large and important city of
+Sung-kiang, and I spoke of going ashore to preach the Gospel to the
+thronging multitudes that lined the banks and crowded the approaches to
+the city gates.
+
+Among the passengers on board the boat was one intelligent man, who in
+the course of his travels had been a good deal abroad, and had even
+visited England, where he went by the name of Peter. As might be
+expected, he had heard something of the Gospel, but had never
+experienced its saving power. On the previous evening I had drawn him
+into earnest converse about his soul's salvation. The man listened with
+attention, and was even moved to tears, but still no definite result was
+apparent. I was pleased, therefore, when he asked to be allowed to
+accompany me, and to hear me preach.
+
+I went into the cabin of the boat to prepare tracts and books for
+distribution on landing with my Chinese friend, when suddenly I was
+startled by a splash and a cry from without. I sprang on deck, and took
+in the situation at a glance. Peter was gone! The other men were all
+there, on board, looking helplessly at the spot where he had
+disappeared, but making no effort to save him. A strong wind was
+carrying the junk rapidly forward in spite of a steady current in the
+opposite direction, and the low-lying, shrubless shore afforded no
+landmark to indicate how far we had left the drowning man behind.
+
+I instantly let down the sail and leapt overboard in the hope of finding
+him. Unsuccessful, I looked around in agonising suspense, and saw close
+to me a fishing-boat with a peculiar drag-net furnished with hooks,
+which I knew would bring him up.
+
+"Come!" I cried, as hope revived in my heart. "Come and drag over this
+spot directly; a man is drowning just here!"
+
+"Veh bin" (It is not convenient), was the unfeeling answer.
+
+"Don't talk of _convenience_!" cried I in an agony; "a man is drowning,
+I tell you!"
+
+"We are busy fishing," they responded, "and cannot come."
+
+"Never mind your fishing," I said, "I will give you more money than many
+a day's fishing will bring; only come--come at once!"
+
+"How much money will you give us?"
+
+"We cannot stay to discuss that now! Come, or it will be too late. I
+will give you five dollars" (then worth about thirty shillings in English
+money).
+
+"We won't do it for that," replied the men. "Give us twenty dollars, and
+we will drag."
+
+"I do not possess so much: do come quickly, and I will give you all I
+have!"
+
+"How much may that be?"
+
+“I don't know exactly, about fourteen dollars."
+
+At last, but even then slowly enough, the boat was paddled over, and the
+net let down. Less than a minute sufficed to bring up the body of the
+missing man. The fishermen were clamorous and indignant because their
+exorbitant demand was delayed while efforts at resuscitation were being
+made. But all was in vain--life was extinct.
+
+To myself this incident was profoundly sad and full of significance,
+suggesting a far more mournful reality. Were not those fishermen
+actually guilty of this poor Chinaman's death, in that they had the
+means of saving him at hand, if they would but have used them? Assuredly
+they were guilty. And yet, let us pause ere we pronounce judgment
+against them, lest a greater than Nathan answer, "_Thou art the man_."
+Is it so hard-hearted, so wicked a thing to neglect to save the body? Of
+how much sorer punishment, then, is he worthy who leaves the soul to
+perish, and Cain-like says, "Am I my brother's keeper?" The LORD JESUS
+commands, commands _me_, commands _you_, my brother, and _you_, my
+sister. "Go," says He, "go ye into _all_ the world, and preach the
+Gospel to _every_ creature." Shall we say to _Him_, "No, it is not
+convenient"? shall we tell _Him_ that we are busy fishing and cannot
+go? that we have bought a piece of ground and cannot go? that we have
+purchased five yoke of oxen, or have married, or are engaged in other
+and more interesting pursuits, and cannot go? Ere long "we must all
+appear before the judgment seat of CHRIST; that every one may receive
+the things done in his body." Let us remember, let us pray for, let us
+labour for the unevangelised Chinese; _or we shall sin against our own
+souls_. Let us consider _Who_ it is that has said, "If thou _forbear_ to
+deliver them that are drawn unto death, and those that are ready to be
+slain; if thou sayest, Behold, we knew it not; doth not He that
+pondereth the heart consider it? and He that keepeth _thy_ soul, doth
+not he know it? and shall not He render to every man according to his
+works?"
+
+ Through midnight gloom from Macedon,
+ The cry of myriads as of one;
+ The voiceful silence of despair
+ Is eloquent in awful prayer:
+ The soul's exceeding bitter cry,
+ "Come o'er and help us, or we die."
+
+ How mournfully it echoes on,
+ For half the earth is Macedon;
+ These brethren to their brethren call,
+ And by the Love which loves them all,
+ And by the whole world's Life they cry,
+ "O ye that live, behold we die!"
+
+ By other sounds the world is won
+ Than that which wails from Macedon;
+ The roar of gain is round it rolled,
+ Or men unto themselves are sold,
+ And cannot list the alien cry,
+ "O hear and help us, lest we die!"
+
+ Yet with that cry from Macedon
+ The very car of CHRIST rolls on:
+ "_I come; who would abide My day,_
+ _In yonder wilds prepare My way;_
+ _My voice is crying in their cry,_
+ _Help ye the dying, lest ye die_."
+
+ JESU, for men of Man the SON,
+ Yea, THINE the cry from Macedon;
+ Oh, by the kingdom and the power
+ And glory of Thine advent hour,
+ Wake heart and will to hear their cry:
+ Help us to help them, lest we die.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XV
+
+SETTLEMENT IN NINGPO
+
+
+THE autumn of 1856 was well advanced before I reached Ningpo, one of the
+most ancient and influential cities on the coast of China. Opened to the
+residence of foreigners in 1842 by the treaty of Nan-king, it had long
+been the scene of missionary labours. Within its thronging thoroughfares
+the busy tide of life runs high. Four hundred thousand human beings
+dwell within or around the five miles circuit of its ancient wall, every
+one a soul that JESUS loves, for whom He died.
+
+As winter drew on I rented a native house in Wu-gyiao-deo, or Lake Head
+Street. It was not then a very comfortable residence. I have a very
+distinct remembrance of tracing my initials on the snow which during the
+night had collected upon my coverlet in the large barn-like upper room,
+now subdivided into four or five smaller ones, each of which is
+comfortably ceiled. The tiling of an unceiled Chinese house may keep off
+the rain--if it happens to be sound--but it does not afford so good a
+protection against snow, which will beat up through crannies and
+crevices, and find its way within. But however unfinished may have been
+its fittings, the little house was well adapted for work amongst the
+people; and there I thankfully settled down, finding ample scope for
+service,--morning, noon, and night.
+
+During the latter part of this year my mind was greatly exercised about
+continued connection with my Society, it being frequently in debt.
+Personally I had always avoided debt, and kept within my salary, though
+at times only by very careful economy. Now there was no difficulty in
+doing this, for my income was larger, and the country being in a more
+peaceful state, things were not so dear. But the Society itself was in
+debt. The quarterly bills which I and others were instructed to draw
+were often met by borrowed money, and a correspondence commenced which
+terminated in the following year by my resigning from conscientious
+motives.
+
+To me it seemed that the teaching of GOD'S Word was unmistakably clear:
+"Owe no man any thing." To borrow money implied, to my mind, a
+contradiction of Scripture--a confession that GOD had withheld some good
+thing, and a determination to get for ourselves what He had not given.
+Could that which was wrong for one Christian to do be right for an
+association of Christians? Or could any amount of precedents make a
+wrong course justifiable? If the Word taught me anything, it taught me
+to have no connection with debt. I could not think that GOD was poor,
+that He was short of resources, or unwilling to supply any want of
+whatever work was really His. It seemed to me that if there were lack of
+funds to carry on work, then to that degree, in that special
+development, or at that time, it could not be the work of GOD. To
+satisfy my conscience I was therefore compelled to resign connection
+with the Society which had hitherto supplied my salary.
+
+It was a great satisfaction to me that my friend and colleague, Mr.
+Jones, also of the Chinese Evangelisation Society, was led to take the
+same step; and we were both profoundly thankful that the separation
+took place without the least breach of friendly feeling on either side.
+Indeed, we had the joy of knowing that the step we took commended itself
+to several members of the Committee, although as a whole the Society
+could not come to our position. Depending upon GOD alone for supplies,
+we were enabled to continue a measure of connection with our former
+supporters, sending home journals, etc., for publication as before, so
+long as the Society continued to exist.
+
+The step we had taken was not a little trying to faith. I was not at all
+sure what GOD would have me do, or whether He would so meet my need as
+to enable me to continue working as before. I had no friends whatever
+from whom I expected supplies. I did not know what means the LORD might
+use; but I was willing to give up all my time to the service of
+evangelisation among the heathen, if by any means He would supply the
+smallest amount on which I could live; and if He were not pleased to do
+this, I was prepared to undertake whatever work might be necessary to
+supply myself, giving all the time that could be spared from such a
+calling to more distinctly missionary efforts. But GOD blessed and
+prospered me; and how glad and thankful I felt when the separation was
+really effected! I could look right up into my FATHER'S face with a
+satisfied heart, ready, by His grace, to do the next thing as He might
+teach me, and feeling very sure of His loving care.
+
+And how blessedly He did lead me on and provide for me I can never,
+never tell. It was like a continuation of some of my earlier home
+experiences. My faith was not untried; it often, often failed, and I was
+so sorry and ashamed of the failure to trust such a FATHER. But oh! I
+was learning to know Him. I would not even then have missed the trial.
+He became so near, so real, so intimate. The occasional difficulty about
+funds never came from an insufficient supply for personal needs, but in
+consequence of ministering to the wants of scores of the hungry and
+dying ones around us. And trials far more searching in other ways quite
+eclipsed these difficulties; and being deeper, brought forth in
+consequence richer fruits. How glad one is now, not only to know, with
+dear Miss Havergal, that----
+
+ "They who trust Him wholly
+ Find Him wholly true,"
+
+but also that when we fail to trust fully He still remains unchangingly
+faithful. He _is_ wholly true whether we trust or not. "If we believe
+not, He abideth faithful; He cannot deny Himself." But oh, how we
+dishonour our LORD whenever we fail to trust Him, and what peace,
+blessing, and triumph we lose in thus sinning against the Faithful One!
+May we never again presume in anything to doubt Him!
+
+The year 1857 was a troublous time, and closed with the notorious
+bombardment of Canton by the British, and the commencement of our second
+Chinese war. Rumours of trouble were everywhere rife, and in many places
+the missionaries passed through not a little danger. In Ningpo this was
+especially the case, and the preserving care of GOD in answer to prayer
+was consequently most marked. When the awful news of the bombardment of
+Canton reached the Cantonese in Ningpo their wrath and indignation knew
+no bounds, and they immediately set to work to plot the destruction of
+all the foreigners resident in the city and neighbourhood. It was well
+known that many of the foreigners were in the habit of meeting for
+worship every Sunday evening at one of the missionary houses, and the
+plan was to surround the place on a given occasion and make short work
+of all present, cutting off afterwards any who might not be present.
+
+The sanction of the Tao-t'ai, or chief civil magistrate of the city, was
+easily obtained; and nothing remained to hinder the execution of the
+plot, of which the foreigners were of course entirely in ignorance. (A
+similar plot against the Portuguese a few months later was carried out,
+and between fifty and sixty were massacred in open daylight.) It so
+happened, however, that one of those acquainted with the conspiracy had
+a friend engaged in the service of the missionaries; and anxious for his
+safety, he was led to warn him of the coming danger, and urge his
+leaving foreign employ. The servant made the matter known to his master,
+and thus the little community became aware of their peril. Realising the
+gravity of the situation, they determined to meet together at the house
+of one of their number to seek the protection of the Most High, and to
+hide under the shadow of His wings. Nor did they thus meet in vain.
+
+At the very time we were praying the LORD was working. He led an
+inferior mandarin, the Superintendent of Customs, to call upon the
+Tao-t'ai, and remonstrate with him upon the folly of permitting such an
+attempt, which he assured him would rouse the foreigners in other places
+to come with armed forces to avenge the death of their countrymen and
+raze the city to the ground. The Tao-t'ai replied that, when the
+foreigners came for that purpose, he should deny all knowledge of or
+complicity in the plot, and so direct their vengeance against the
+Cantonese, who would in their turn be destroyed; "and thus," said he,
+"we shall get rid of both Cantonese and foreigners by one stroke of
+policy." The Superintendent of Customs assured him that all such
+attempts at evasion would be useless; and, finally, the Tao-t'ai sent to
+the Cantonese, withdrawing his permission, and prohibiting the attack.
+This took place at the very time when we were asking protection of the
+LORD, though we did not become acquainted with the facts until some
+weeks later. Thus again we were led to prove that--
+
+ "Sufficient is His arm alone,
+ And our defence is sure."
+
+I cannot attempt to give any historical record of the events of this
+period, but ere 1857 terminated Mr. Jones and I were cheered by tokens
+of blessing. It is interesting to recall the circumstances connected
+with the first profession of faith in Christ, which encouraged us.
+
+On one occasion I was preaching the glad tidings of salvation through
+the finished work of CHRIST, when a middle-aged man stood up, and
+testified before his assembled countrymen to his faith in the power of
+the Gospel.
+
+"I have long sought for the Truth," said he earnestly, "as my fathers
+did before me; but I have never found it. I have travelled far and near,
+but without obtaining it. I have found no rest in Confucianism,
+Buddhism, or Taoism; but I do find rest in what I have heard here
+to-night. Henceforth I am a believer in JESUS."
+
+This man was one of the leading officers of a sect of reformed Buddhists
+in Ningpo. A short time after his confession of faith in the SAVIOUR
+there was a meeting of the sect over which he had formerly presided. I
+accompanied him to that meeting, and there, to his former
+co-religionists, he testified of the peace he had obtained in believing.
+Soon after, one of his former companions was converted and baptized.
+Both now sleep in JESUS. The first of these two long continued to preach
+to his countrymen the glad tidings of great joy. A few nights after his
+conversion he asked how long this Gospel had been known in England. He
+was told that we had known it for some hundreds of years.
+
+"What!" said he, amazed; "is it possible that for hundreds of years you
+have had the knowledge of these glad tidings in your possession, and yet
+have only now come to preach it to us? My father sought after the Truth
+for more than twenty years, and died without finding it. Oh, why did you
+not come sooner?"
+
+A whole generation has passed away since that mournful inquiry was made;
+but how many, alas! might repeat the same question to-day? More than two
+hundred millions in the meanwhile have been swept into eternity, without
+an offer of salvation. How long shall this continue, and the MASTER'S
+words, "To every creature," remain unheeded?
+
+[Illustration]
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVI
+
+TIMELY SUPPLIES
+
+
+NOT infrequently our GOD brings His people into difficulties on purpose
+that they may come to know Him as they could not otherwise do. Then He
+reveals Himself as "a very present help in trouble," and makes the heart
+glad indeed at each fresh revelation of a FATHER'S faithfulness. We who
+only see so small a part of the sweet issues of trial often feel that we
+would not for anything have missed them; how much more shall we bless
+and magnify His Name when all the hidden things are brought to light!
+
+In the autumn of 1857, just one year after I came to settle in Ningpo, a
+little incident occurred that did much to strengthen our faith in the
+loving-kindness and ever-watchful care of GOD.
+
+A brother in the LORD, the Rev. John Quarterman, of the American
+Presbyterian Mission North, was taken with virulent small-pox, and it
+was my mournful privilege to nurse him through his suffering illness to
+its fatal close. When all was over, it became necessary to lay aside the
+garments worn while nursing, for fear of conveying the infection to
+others. Not having sufficient money in hand to purchase what was needful
+in order to make this change, prayer was the only resource. The LORD
+answered it by the unexpected arrival of a long-lost box of clothing
+from Swatow, that had remained in the care of the Rev. William Burns
+when I left him for Shanghai, in the early summer of the previous year.
+The arrival of the things just at this juncture was as appropriate as it
+was remarkable, and brought a sweet sense of the FATHER'S own providing.
+
+About two months later the following was penned:----
+
+
+ _November 18th, 1857._
+
+Many seem to think that I am very poor. This certainly is true enough in
+one sense, but I thank GOD it is "as poor, yet making many rich; as
+having nothing, yet possessing all things." And my GOD shall supply
+_all_ my need; to Him be all the glory. I would not, if I could, be
+otherwise than I am--entirely dependent myself upon the LORD, and used
+as a channel of help to others.
+
+On Saturday, the 4th inst., our regular home mail arrived. That morning
+we supplied, as usual, a breakfast to the destitute poor, who came to
+the number of seventy. Sometimes they do not reach forty, at others
+again exceeding eighty. They come to us every day, LORD'S Day excepted,
+for then we cannot manage to attend to them and get through all our
+other duties too. Well, on that Saturday morning we paid all expenses,
+and provided ourselves for the morrow, after which we had not a single
+dollar left between us. How the LORD was going to provide for Monday we
+knew not; but over our mantelpiece hung two scrolls in the Chinese
+character--_Ebenezer_, "Hitherto hath the LORD helped us"; and
+_Jehovah-Jireh_, "The LORD will provide"--and He kept us from doubting
+for a moment. That very day the mail came in, _a week sooner than was
+expected_, and Mr. Jones received a bill for two hundred and fourteen
+dollars. We thanked GOD and took courage. The bill was taken to a
+merchant, and although there is usually a delay of several days in
+getting the change, this time he said, "Send down on Monday." We sent,
+and though he had not been able to buy all the dollars, he let us have
+seventy on account; so all was well. Oh, it is sweet to live thus
+directly dependent upon the LORD, who never fails us!
+
+On Monday the poor had their breakfast as usual, for we had not told
+them not to come, being assured that it was the LORD'S work, and that
+the LORD would provide. We could not help our eyes filling with tears of
+gratitude when we saw not only our own needs supplied, but the widow and
+the orphan, the blind and the lame, the friendless and the destitute,
+together provided for by the bounty of Him who feeds the ravens. "O
+magnify the LORD with me, and let us exalt His Name together. . . . Taste
+and see that the LORD is good: blessed is the man that trusteth in Him.
+O fear the LORD, ye His saints: for there is no want to them that fear
+Him. The young lions do lack, and suffer hunger: but they that seek the
+LORD shall not want any good thing"--and if not good, why want it?
+
+But even two hundred dollars cannot last for ever, and by New Year's Day
+supplies were again getting low. At last, on January 6th, 1858, only one
+solitary cash remained--the twentieth part of a penny--in the joint
+possession of Mr. Jones and myself; but though tried we looked to GOD
+once again to manifest His gracious care. Enough provision was found in
+the house to supply a meagre breakfast; after which, having neither food
+for the rest of the day, nor money to buy any, we could only betake
+ourselves to Him who was able to supply all our need with the petition,
+"Give us this day our daily bread."
+
+After prayer and deliberation we thought that perhaps we ought to
+dispose of something we possessed in order to meet our immediate
+requirements. But on looking round we saw nothing that we could well
+spare, and little that the Chinese would purchase for ready money.
+Credit to any extent we might have had, could we conscientiously have
+availed ourselves of it, but this we felt to be unscriptural in itself,
+as well as inconsistent with the position we were in. We had, indeed,
+one article--an iron stove--which we knew the Chinese would readily
+purchase; but we much regretted the necessity of parting with it. At
+length, however, we set out to the founder's, and after a walk of some
+distance came to the river, which we had intended to cross by a floating
+bridge of boats; but here the LORD shut up our path. The bridge had been
+carried away during the preceding night, and the river was only passable
+by means of a ferry, the fare for which was two cash each person. As we
+only possessed one cash, our course clearly was to return and await
+GOD'S own interposition on our behalf.
+
+Upon reaching home, we found that Mrs. Jones had gone with the children
+to dine at a friend's house, in accordance with an invitation accepted
+some days previously. Mr. Jones, though himself included in the
+invitation, refused now to go and leave me to fast alone. So we set to
+work and carefully searched the cupboards; and though there was nothing
+to eat, we found a small packet of cocoa, which, with a little hot
+water, somewhat revived us. After this we again cried to the LORD in our
+trouble, and the LORD heard and saved us out of all our distresses. For
+while we were still upon our knees a letter arrived from England
+containing a remittance.
+
+This timely supply not only met the immediate and urgent need of the
+day; for in the assured confidence that GOD, whose we were and whom we
+served, would not put to shame those whose whole and only trust was in
+Himself. My marriage had been previously arranged to take place just
+fourteen days after this date. And this expectation was not
+disappointed; for "the mountains shall depart, and the hills be removed,
+but My kindness shall not depart from thee, neither shall the covenant
+of My peace be removed." And although during subsequent years our faith
+was often exercised, and sometimes severely, He ever proved faithful to
+His promise, and never suffered us to lack any good thing.
+
+Never, perhaps, was there a union that more fully realised the blessed
+truth, "Whoso findeth a wife findeth a good thing, and obtaineth favour
+of the LORD." My dear wife was not only a precious gift to me; GOD
+blessed her to many others during the twelve eventful years through
+which she was spared to those that loved her and to China.
+
+Hers had been a life connection with missionary work in that great
+empire; for her father, the loved and devoted Samuel Dyer, was amongst
+the very earliest representatives of the London Mission in the East. He
+reached the Straits as early as 1827, and for sixteen years laboured
+assiduously amongst the Chinese in Penang and Singapore, completing at
+the same time a valuable fount of Chinese metallic type, the first of
+the kind that had then been attempted. Dying in 1843, it was never Mr.
+Dyers privilege to realise his hopes of ultimately being able to settle
+on Chinese soil; but his children lived to see the country opened to the
+Gospel, and to take their share in the great work that had been so dear
+to his heart. At the time of her marriage, my dear wife had been already
+living for several years in Ningpo with her friend, Miss Aldersey, in
+whose varied missionary operations she was well qualified to render
+valuable assistance.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVII
+
+GOD A REFUGE FOR US
+
+
+A SOMEWHAT different though not less manifest answer to prayer was
+vouchsafed early in the year 1859. My dear wife was brought very low by
+illness, and at last all hope of recovery seemed gone. Every remedy
+tried had proved unavailing; and Dr. Parker, who was in attendance, had
+nothing more to suggest. Life was ebbing fast away. The only ground of
+hope was that GOD might yet see fit to raise her up, in answer to
+believing but submissive prayer.
+
+The afternoon for the usual prayer meeting among the missionaries had
+arrived, and I sent in a request for prayer, which was most warmly
+responded to. Just at this time a remedy that had not yet been tried was
+suggested to my mind, and I felt that I must hasten to consult Dr.
+Parker as to the propriety of using it. It was a moment of anguish. The
+hollow temples, sunken eyes, and pinched features denoted the near
+approach of death; and it seemed more than questionable as to whether
+life would hold out until my return. It was nearly two miles to Dr.
+Parker's house, and every moment appeared long. On my way thither, while
+wrestling mightily with GOD in prayer, the precious words were brought
+with power to my soul, "Call upon Me in the day of trouble: I will
+deliver thee, and thou shall glorify Me." I was at once enabled to plead
+them in faith, and the result was deep, deep, unspeakable peace and
+joy. All consciousness of distance was gone. Dr. Parker cordially
+approved of the use of the means suggested, but upon arriving at home I
+saw at a glance that the desired change had taken place in the absence
+of this or any other remedy. The pinched aspect of the countenance had
+given place to the calmness of tranquil slumber, and not one
+unfavourable symptom remained to retard recovery to health and strength.
+
+Spared thus in answer to prayer the loss of my own loved one, it was
+with added sympathy and sorrow that I felt for Dr. Parker, when, in the
+autumn of the same year, his own wife was very suddenly removed. It
+being necessary for the doctor to return at once with his motherless
+children to Glasgow, temporary arrangements had to be made for the
+conduct of the Mission Hospital in Ningpo, for which he alone had been
+responsible. Under these circumstances he requested me to take up the
+work, at least so far as the dispensary was concerned. After a few days'
+waiting upon the LORD for guidance, I felt constrained to undertake not
+only the dispensary work, but also that of the hospital; relying solely
+upon the faithfulness of a prayer-hearing GOD to furnish the means
+required for its support.
+
+The funds for the maintenance of the hospital had hitherto been supplied
+by the proceeds of the doctor's foreign medical practice; and with his
+departure these ceased. But had not GOD said that whatever we ask in the
+Name of the LORD JESUS shall be done? And are we not told to seek first
+the kingdom of GOD, not means to advance it, and that all these things
+shall be added to us? Such promises were surely sufficient. Eight days
+before entering upon this responsibility I had not the remotest idea of
+ever doing so; still less could friends at home have anticipated it.
+But the LORD had foreseen the need, and already funds were on the way to
+supply it.
+
+At times there were not less than fifty in-patients in the hospital,
+besides a large number who daily attended the out-patient department.
+Thirty beds were ordinarily allotted to free patients and their
+attendants; and about as many to opium-smokers, who paid for their board
+while being cured of the habit. As all the wants of the sick in the
+wards were supplied gratuitously, in addition to the remedial appliances
+needed for the out-patient work, the daily expenses were considerable;
+besides which, a number of native attendants were required, involving
+their support.
+
+When Dr. Parker handed the hospital over to me he was able to leave
+money that would meet the salaries and working expenses of the current
+month, and little more. Being unable to guarantee their support, his
+native staff retired; and then I mentioned the circumstances to the
+members of our little church, some of whom volunteered to help me,
+depending, like myself, upon the LORD; and they with me continued to
+wait upon GOD that in some way or other He would provide for His own
+work. Day by day the stores diminished, and they were all but exhausted
+when one day a remarkable letter reached me from a friend in England
+which contained a cheque for £50. The letter stated that the sender had
+recently lost his father, and had inherited his property; that not
+desiring to increase his personal expenditure, he wished to hold the
+money which had now been left to him to further the LORD'S work. He
+enclosed the £50, saying that I might know of some special need for it;
+but leaving me free to use it for my own support, or in any way that the
+LORD might lead me; only asking to know how it was applied, and whether
+there was need for more.
+
+After a little season of thanksgiving with my dear wife, I called my
+native helpers into our little chapel, and translated to them the
+letter. I need not say how rejoiced they were, and that we together
+praised GOD. They returned to their work in the hospital with
+overflowing hearts, and told out to the patients what a GOD was ours;
+appealing to them whether their idols had ever helped them so. Both
+helpers and patients were blessed spiritually through this remarkable
+provision, and from that time the LORD provided all that was necessary
+for carrying on the institution, in addition to what was needed for the
+maintenance of my own family, and for sustaining other branches of
+missionary work under my care. When, nine months later, I was obliged
+through failure of health to relinquish this charge, I was able to leave
+more funds in hand for the support of the hospital than were forthcoming
+at the time I undertook it.
+
+But not only were pecuniary supplies vouchsafed in answer to
+prayer--many lives were spared; persons apparently in hopeless stages of
+disease were restored, and success was given in cases of serious and
+dangerous operations. In the case of one poor man, whose legs were
+amputated under very unfavourable circumstances, healthy action took
+place with such rapidity that both wounds were healed in less than two
+weeks. And more permanent benefits than these were conferred. Many were
+convinced of the truth of Christianity; not a few sought the LORD in
+faith and prayer, and experienced the power of the Great Physician to
+cure the sin-sick soul. During the nine months above alluded to sixteen
+patients from the hospital were baptized, and more than thirty others
+became candidates for admission into one or other of the Christian
+churches in the city.
+
+Thus the year 1860 began with openings on all hands, but time and
+strength were sadly too limited to admit of their being used to the
+best advantage. For some time the help of additional workers had been a
+much-felt need; and in January very definite prayer was made to the LORD
+of the harvest that He would thrust forth more labourers into this
+special portion of the great world-field. Writing to relatives at home
+in England, under date of January 16th, 1860, I thus expressed the deep
+longing of our hearts:--
+
+ Do you know any earnest, devoted young men
+ desirous of serving GOD in China, who--not wishing
+ for more than their actual support--would be
+ willing to come out and labour here? Oh, for four
+ or five such helpers! They would probably begin to
+ preach in Chinese in six months time; and in
+ answer to prayer the necessary means for their
+ support would be found.
+
+But no one came to help us then; and under the incessant physical and
+mental strain involved, in the care of the hospital during Dr. Parker's
+absence, as well as the continued discharge of my other missionary
+duties, my own health began rapidly to fail, and it became a serious
+question as to whether it would not be needful to return to England for
+a time.
+
+It was hard to face this possibility. The growing church and work seemed
+to need our presence, and it was no small trial to part from those whom
+we had learned so truly to love in the LORD. Thirty or forty native
+Christians had been gathered into the recently organised church; and the
+well-filled meetings, and the warm-hearted earnestness of the converts,
+all bespoke a future of much promise. At last, however, completely
+prostrated by repeated attacks of illness, the only hope of restoration
+seemed to lie in a voyage to England and a brief stay in its more
+bracing climate; and this necessity, painful though it seemed at the
+time, proved to be only another opportunity for the manifestation of the
+faithfulness and loving care of Him "who worketh all things after the
+counsel of His own will."
+
+As heretofore, the LORD was present with His aid. The means for our
+journey were supplied, and that so liberally that we were able to bring
+with us a native Christian to assist in translation or other literary
+work, and to instruct in the language such helpers as the LORD might
+raise up for the extension of the Mission. That He would give us
+fellow-labourers we had no doubt; for we had been enabled to seek them
+from Him in earnest and believing prayer for many months previously.
+
+The day before leaving China we wrote as follows to our friend W. T.
+Berger, Esq., whom we had known in England, and who had ever
+strengthened our hands in the LORD while in that distant land:--
+
+"We are bringing with us a young Chinese brother to assist in literary
+work, and I hope also in teaching the dialect to those whom the LORD may
+induce to return with us."
+
+And throughout the voyage our earnest cry to GOD was that He would
+overrule our stay at home for good to China, and make it instrumental in
+raising up at least five helpers to labour in the province of
+CHEH-KIANG.
+
+The way in which it pleased the LORD to answer these earnest and
+believing prayers, and the "exceeding abundantly" with which He crowned
+them, we shall now sketch in brief outline.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVIII
+
+A NEW AGENCY NEEDED
+
+
+"My thoughts are not your thoughts, neither are your ways My ways, saith
+the LORD. For as the heavens are higher than the earth, so are My ways
+higher than your ways, and My thoughts than your thoughts."[3] How true
+are these words! When the LORD is bringing in great blessing in the best
+possible way, how oftentimes our unbelieving hearts are feeling, if not
+saying, like Jacob of old, "All these things are against me." Or we are
+filled with fear, as were the disciples when the LORD, walking on the
+waters, drew near to quiet the troubled sea, and to bring them quickly
+to their desired haven. And yet mere common-sense ought to tell us that
+He, whose way is perfect, _can_ make no mistakes; that He who has
+promised to "perfect that which concerneth" us, and whose minute care
+counts the very hairs of our heads, and forms for us our circumstances,
+_must_ know better than we the way to forward our truest interests and
+to glorify His own Name.
+
+ "Blind unbelief is _sure_ to err
+ And scan His work in vain;
+ GOD is His own Interpreter,
+ And He will make it plain."
+
+To me it seemed a great calamity that failure of health compelled my
+relinquishing work for GOD in China, just when it was more fruitful than
+ever before; and to leave the little band of Christians in Ningpo,
+needing much care and teaching, was a great sorrow. Nor was the sorrow
+lessened when, on reaching England, medical testimony assured me that
+return to China, at least for years to come, was impossible. Little did
+I then realise that the long separation from China was a necessary step
+towards the formation of a work which GOD would bless as He has blessed
+the CHINA INLAND MISSION. While in the field, the pressure of claims
+immediately around me was so great that I could not think much of the
+still greater needs of the regions farther inland; and, if they were
+thought of, could do nothing for them. But while detained for some years
+in England, daily viewing the whole country on the large map on the wall
+of my study, I was as near to the vast regions of Inland China as to the
+smaller districts in which I had laboured personally for GOD; and prayer
+was often the only resource by which the burdened heart could gain any
+relief.
+
+As a long absence from China appeared inevitable, the next question was
+how best to serve China while in England, and this led to my engaging
+for several years, with the late Rev. F. F. Gough of the C. M. S., in
+the revision of a version of the New Testament in the colloquial of
+Ningpo for the British and Foreign Bible Society. In undertaking this
+work, in my short-sightedness I saw nothing beyond the use that the
+Book, and the marginal references, would be to the native Christians;
+but I have often seen since that, without those months of feeding and
+feasting on the Word of GOD, I should have been quite unprepared to
+form, on its present basis, a mission like the CHINA INLAND MISSION.
+
+In the study of that Divine Word I learned that, to obtain successful
+labourers, not elaborate appeals for help, but, _first_, earnest _prayer
+to GOD to thrust forth labourers_, and, _second_, the deepening of the
+spiritual life of the church, so that _men should be unable to stay at
+home_, were what was needed. I saw that the Apostolic plan was not to
+raise ways and means, but _to go and do the work_, trusting in His sure
+Word who has said, "Seek ye _first_ the Kingdom of GOD and His
+righteousness, and all these things shall be added unto you."
+
+In the meantime the prayer for workers for CHEH-KIANG was being
+answered. The first, Mr. Meadows, sailed for China with his young wife
+in January 1862, through the kind co-operation and aid of our friend Mr.
+Berger. The second left England in 1864, having her passage provided by
+the Foreign Evangelisation Society. The third and fourth reached Ningpo
+on July 24th, 1865. A fifth soon followed them, reaching Ningpo in
+September 1865. Thus the prayer for the five workers was fully answered;
+and we were encouraged to look to GOD for still greater things.
+
+Months of earnest prayer and not a few abortive efforts had resulted in
+a deep conviction that _a special agency was essential_ for the
+evangelisation of Inland China. At this time I had not only the daily
+help of prayer and conference with my beloved friend and fellow-worker
+the late Rev. F. F. Gough, but also invaluable aid and counsel from Mr.
+and Mrs. Berger, with whom I and my dear wife (whose judgment and piety
+were of priceless value at this juncture) spent many days in prayerful
+deliberation. The grave difficulty of possibly interfering with existing
+missionary operations at home was foreseen; but it was concluded that,
+by simple trust in GOD, suitable agency might be raised up and sustained
+without interfering injuriously with any existing work. I had also a
+growing conviction that GOD would have _me_ to seek from Him the needed
+workers, and to go forth with them. But for a long time unbelief
+hindered my taking the first step.
+
+How inconsistent unbelief always is! I had no doubt that, if I prayed
+for workers, "_in_ the Name" of the LORD JESUS CHRIST, they would be
+given me. I had no doubt that, in answer to such prayer, the means for
+our going forth would be provided, and that doors would be opened before
+us in unreached parts of the Empire. But I had not then learned to trust
+GOD for _keeping_ power and grace for myself, so no wonder that I could
+not trust Him to keep others who might be prepared to go with me. I
+feared that in the midst of the dangers, difficulties, and trials which
+would necessarily be connected with such a work, some who were
+comparatively inexperienced Christians might break down, and bitterly
+reproach me for having encouraged them to undertake an enterprise for
+which they were unequal.
+
+Yet, what was I to do? The feeling of blood-guiltiness became more and
+more intense. Simply because I refused to ask for them, the labourers
+did not come forward--did not go out to China--and every day tens of
+thousands were passing away to Christless graves! Perishing China so
+filled my heart and mind that there was no rest by day, and little sleep
+by night, till health broke down. At the invitation of my beloved and
+honoured friend, Mr. George Pearse (then of the Stock Exchange), I went
+to spend a few days with him in Brighton.
+
+On Sunday, June 25th, 1865, unable to bear the sight of a congregation
+of a thousand or more Christian people rejoicing in their own security,
+while millions were perishing for lack of knowledge, I wandered out on
+the sands alone, in great spiritual agony; and there the LORD conquered
+my unbelief, and I surrendered myself to GOD for this service. I told
+Him that all the responsibility as to issues and consequences must rest
+with Him; that as His servant, it was mine to obey and to follow
+Him--His, to direct, to care for, and to guide me and those who might
+labour with me. Need I say that peace at once flowed into my burdened
+heart? There and then I asked Him for twenty-four fellow-workers, two
+for each of eleven inland provinces which were without a missionary, and
+two for Mongolia; and writing the petition on the margin of the Bible I
+had with me, I returned home with a heart enjoying rest such as it had
+been a stranger to for months, and with an assurance that the LORD would
+bless His own work and that I should share in the blessing. I had
+previously prayed, and asked prayer, that workers might be raised up for
+the eleven then unoccupied provinces, and thrust forth and provided for,
+but had not surrendered myself to be their leader.
+
+About this time, with the help of my dear wife, I wrote the little book,
+_China's Spiritual Need and Claims_. Every paragraph was steeped in
+prayer. With the help of Mr. Berger, who had given valued aid in the
+revision of the manuscript, and who bore the expense of printing an
+edition of 3000 copies, they were soon put in circulation. I spoke
+publicly of the proposed work as opportunity permitted, specially at the
+Perth and Mildmay Conferences of 1865, and continued in prayer for
+fellow-workers, who were soon raised up, and after due correspondence
+were invited to my home, then in the East of London. When one house
+became insufficient, the occupant of the adjoining house removed, and I
+was able to rent it; and when that in its turn became insufficient,
+further accommodation was provided close by. Soon there were a number of
+men and women under preparatory training, and engaging in evangelistic
+work which tested in some measure their qualifications as soul-winners.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+FOOTNOTES:
+
+[3] Isaiah lv. 8, 9.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIX
+
+THE FORMATION OF THE C. I. M.
+
+
+IT was thus that in the year 1865 the CHINA INLAND MISSION was
+organised; and the workers already in the field were incorporated into
+it. W. T. Berger, Esq., then residing at Saint Hill, near East
+Grinstead, without whose help and encouragement I could not have gone
+forward, undertook the direction of the home department of the work
+during my anticipated absence in China; and I proposed, as soon as
+arrangements could be completed, to go out with the volunteers and take
+the direction of the work in the field. For the support of the workers
+already in China, our friends at home were sending in unsolicited
+contributions from time to time, and every need was met.
+
+We had now, however, to look forward to the outgoing of a party of
+sixteen or seventeen, and estimated that from £1500 to £2000 might be
+required to cover outfits, passage-money, and initial expenses. I wrote
+a little pamphlet, calling it "Occasional Paper, No. I." (intending in
+successive numbers to give to donors and friends accounts of the work
+wrought through us in China), and in that paper stated the anticipated
+needs for floating the enterprise. I expected that GOD would incline the
+hearts of some of the readers to send contributions: I had determined
+never to use personal solicitation, or to make collections, or to issue
+collecting-books. Missionary-boxes were thought unobjectionable, and we
+had a few prepared for those who might ask for them, and have continued
+to use them ever since.
+
+It was February 6th, 1866, when I sent my manuscript of "Occasional
+Paper, No. I.," with a design for the cover, to the printer. From delays
+in engraving and printing, it was March 12th when the bales of pamphlets
+were delivered at my house. Now on February 6th a daily prayer-meeting,
+from 12 to 1 o'clock, had been commenced, to ask for the needed funds.
+And that we had not asked in vain, the following extract from
+"Occasional Paper, No. II." will show:--
+
+"The receipts for 1864 were £51:14s.; for 1865, from January to June,
+£221:12:6, besides two free passages; from June to December, £923:12:8.
+Hindrances having occurred, the MS. of the "Occasional Paper, No. I."
+was not completed till February 6th, 1866. Up to this time we had
+received (from December 30th) £170:8:3.
+
+"We felt much encouraged by the receipt of so much money in little more
+than a month, as it was entirely unsolicited by us--save from GOD. But
+it was also evident that we must ask the LORD to do yet greater things
+for us, or it would be impossible for a party of from ten to sixteen to
+leave in the middle of May. _Daily united prayer was therefore offered
+to_ GOD for the funds needful for the outfits and passages of as many as
+He would have to go out in May.
+
+"Owing to the delays mentioned above in the printing of the 'Occasional
+Paper,' it was not ready for the publisher until March 12th. On this day
+I again examined my mission cash-book, and the comparison of the result
+of the two similar periods of one month and six days each, one before
+and one after special prayer for £1500 to £2000, was very striking:--
+
+ "Receipts from December 30th to February 6th, £170 8 3
+ " Feb. 6th to Mar. 12th £1774 5 11
+ "Funds advised, since received 200 0 0
+ --------- £1974 5 11
+
+"This, it will be noticed, was _previous_ to the circulation of the
+'Occasional Paper,' and, consequently, was not the result of it. It was
+the response of a faithful GOD to the united prayers of those whom He
+had called to serve Him in the Gospel of His dear SON.
+
+"We can now compare with these two periods a third of the same extent.
+From March 12th to April 18th the receipts were £529, showing that when
+GOD had supplied the special need, the special supply also ceased. Truly
+there is a LIVING GOD, and HE is the hearer and answerer of prayer."
+
+But this gracious answer to prayer made it a little difficult to
+circulate "Occasional Paper, No. I.," for it stated as a need that which
+was already supplied. The difficulty was obviated by the issue with each
+copy of a coloured inset stating that the funds for outfit and passage
+were already in hand in answer to prayer. We were reminded of the
+difficulty of Moses--not a very common one in the present day--and of
+the proclamation he had to send through the camp to the people to
+prepare no more for the building of the Tabernacle, as the gifts in hand
+were already too much. We are convinced that if there were _less_
+solicitation for money and _more_ dependence upon the power of the HOLY
+GHOST and upon the deepening of spiritual life, the experience of Moses
+would be a common one in every branch of Christian work.
+
+Preparations for sailing to China were at once proceeded with. About
+this time I was asked to give a lecture on China in a village not very
+far from London, and agreed to do so on condition that there should be
+no collection, and that this should be announced on the bills. The
+gentleman who invited me, and who kindly presided as chairman, said he
+had never had that condition imposed before. He accepted it, however,
+and the bills were issued accordingly for the 2nd or 3rd of May. With
+the aid of a large map, something of the extent and population and deep
+spiritual need of China was presented, and many were evidently
+impressed.
+
+At the close of the meeting the chairman said that by my request it had
+been intimated on the bills that there would be no collection; but he
+felt that many present would be distressed and burdened if they had not
+the opportunity of contributing something towards the good work
+proposed. He trusted that as the proposition emanated entirely from
+himself, and expressed, he felt sure, the feelings of many in the
+audience, I should not object to it. I begged, however, that the
+condition agreed to might be carried out; pointing out among other
+reasons for making no collection, that the very reason adduced by our
+kind chairman was, to my mind, one of the strongest for not making it.
+My wish was, not that those present should be relieved by making such
+contribution as might there and then be convenient, under the influence
+of a present emotion; but that each one should go home burdened with the
+deep need of China, and ask of GOD what He would have them to do. If,
+after thought and prayer, they were satisfied that a pecuniary
+contribution was what He wanted of them, it could be given to any
+Missionary Society having agents in China; or it might be posted to our
+London office; but that perhaps in many cases what GOD wanted was _not_
+a money contribution, but personal consecration to His service abroad;
+or the giving up of son or daughter--more precious than silver or
+gold--to His service. I added that I thought the tendency of a
+collection was to leave the impression that the all-important thing was
+_money_, whereas no amount of money could convert a single soul; that
+what was needed was that men and women filled with the HOLY GHOST should
+give _themselves_ to the work: for the support of such there would never
+be a lack of funds. As my wish was evidently very strong, the chairman
+kindly yielded to it, and closed the meeting. He told me, however, at
+the supper-table, that he thought it was a mistake on my part, and that,
+notwithstanding all I had said, a few persons had put some little
+contributions into his hands.
+
+Next morning at breakfast, my kind host came in a little late, and
+acknowledged to not having had a very good night. After breakfast he
+asked me to his study, and giving me the contributions handed to him the
+night before, said, "I thought last night, Mr. Taylor, that you were in
+the wrong about a collection; I am now convinced you were quite right.
+As I thought in the night of that stream of souls in China ever passing
+onward into the dark, I could only cry as you suggested, 'LORD, what
+wilt Thou have _me_ to do?' I think I have obtained the guidance I
+sought, and here it is." He handed me a cheque for £500, adding that if
+there had been a collection he would have given a few pounds to it, but
+now this cheque was the result of having spent no small part of the
+night in prayer.
+
+I need scarcely say how surprised and thankful I was for this gift. I
+had received at the breakfast-table a letter from Messrs. Killick,
+Martin and Co., shipping agents, in which they stated that they could
+offer us the whole passenger accommodation of the ship _Lammermuir_. I
+went direct to the ship, found it in every way suitable, and paid the
+cheque on account. As above stated, the funds deemed needed had been
+already in hand for some time; but the coincidence of the simultaneous
+offer of the ship accommodation and this munificent gift--GOD'S
+"exceeding abundantly"--greatly encouraged my heart.
+
+On the 26th of May we sailed for China in the _Lammermuir_, a missionary
+party of 16 (besides my four children and their nurse, and Miss Bausum
+(afterwards Mrs. Barchet)); in all 22 passengers. Mr. Berger took charge
+of the home department, and thus the C. I. M. was fully inaugurated.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XX
+
+THE MISSION IN 1894
+
+
+THE events sketched in the last two chapters have been more fully
+delineated by Miss Guinness in her interesting _Story of the China
+Inland Mission_, which continues its history to the present date. It is
+indeed a record of the goodness of GOD, every remembrance of which calls
+for gratitude and praise. We can only here briefly mention a few facts,
+referring our readers to Miss Guinness's work for all details.
+
+After a voyage of many mercies the _Lammermuir_ party safely reached
+China, and during the first ten years stations and out-stations were
+opened in many cities and towns in four provinces which hitherto had
+been unreached by the Gospel. At home Mr. and Mrs. Berger continued
+their devoted service until March 19th, 1872, I having returned to
+England the year before. Shortly after this the London Council was
+formed, which has now for several years been assisted by an auxiliary
+Council of ladies. A Scotch Council was also formed in Glasgow a few
+years ago.
+
+A visit to America in 1888 issued in the formation of the Council for
+North America, and a similar Council for Australasia was commenced in
+Melbourne two years later. In the field a China Council was organised in
+1886, composed of senior missionaries who meet quarterly in Shanghai.
+
+Closely associated with the C. I. M. are seven Committees--in England,
+Norway, Sweden (two), Finland, Germany, and the United States--which
+send out and support their own missionaries, who in China have the
+assistance of the educational and other advantages of the C. I. M., and
+who work under its direction.
+
+The staff of the Mission, in May 1893, consisted of 552 missionaries
+(including wives and associates). There were also 326 native helpers (95
+of whom were unpaid), working as pastors, evangelists, teachers,
+colporteurs, Bible-women, etc., in 14 different provinces.
+
+Duly qualified candidates for missionary labour are accepted without
+restriction as to denomination, provided they are sound in the faith in
+all fundamental truths: these go out in dependence upon GOD for temporal
+supplies, with the clear understanding that the officers of the Mission
+do not guarantee any income whatever; and knowing that as they will not
+go into debt, they can only minister to them as the funds sent in from
+time to time will allow. But we praise GOD that during the past
+twenty-eight years such ministry has always been possible; our GOD _has_
+supplied all our need, and has withheld no good thing.
+
+All the expenses of the Mission at home and abroad are met by voluntary
+contributions, sent to the offices of the Mission without personal
+solicitation, by those who wish to aid in this effort to spread the
+knowledge of the Gospel throughout China. The income for the year 1892
+was about £34,000 from all sources--Great Britain, the Continent of
+Europe, North America, Australasia, China, etc.
+
+Some of the missionaries having private property have gone out at their
+own expense, and do not take anything from the Mission funds.
+
+Stations have been opened in ten of the eleven provinces which were
+previously without Protestant missionaries; from one of these, however,
+we have had to retire. The eleventh province has been visited several
+times, and it is hoped that in it permanent work may soon be begun.
+
+More than 200 stations and out-stations have been opened in fourteen of
+the eighteen provinces, in all of which stations either missionaries or
+native labourers are resident. Over 6000 converts have been baptized
+from the commencement, some 4000 of whom are now living and in
+fellowship.
+
+
+THE MISSION IN 1902
+
+The year 1894, in which the first edition of _A Retrospect_ appeared,
+was marked by the erection of large and commodious premises for the work
+of the Mission, and early in the following year the houses in Pyrland
+Road, which had so long formed the home of the Mission in England, were
+vacated, and NEWINGTON GREEN, LONDON, N., became the address of the
+Mission offices and home.
+
+From that date until the Boxer outbreak of 1900 the Mission made steady
+progress, the development of the work in China being accompanied by
+corresponding developments in the home departments of the Mission in
+England, America, and Australasia.
+
+In January 1900, before the Boxer outbreak, there were in connection
+with the Mission, 811 missionaries, including wives and associates; 171
+stations; 223 out-stations; 387 chapels; 581 paid native helpers; 193
+unpaid native helpers; 8557 communicants in fellowship, 12,964 having
+been baptized from the commencement. There were 266 organised churches;
+788 boarding scholars; 1382 day scholars; 6 hospitals; 18 dispensaries;
+and 46 opium refuges.
+
+During the terrible year of 1900, when no fewer than 135 missionaries
+and 53 missionaries' children and many thousands of Chinese Christians
+were cruelly murdered, the China Inland Mission lost 58 missionaries and
+21 children. The records of these unparalleled times of suffering have
+been told in _Martyred Missionaries of the China Inland Mission_ and in
+_Last Letters_, both of which books will be found advertised at the end
+of this volume. Apart from loss of life, there was an immense amount of
+Mission property destroyed, and the missionaries were compelled to
+retire from their stations in most parts of China.
+
+The doors closed by this outbreak have all been reopened in the goodness
+of GOD. In those districts which suffered most from the massacres the
+work has largely been one of reorganisation; but throughout China
+generally there has been a spirit of awakening and a time of enlarged
+opportunity; which is a loud call for more men and women to volunteer to
+step into the gaps and fill the places of those who have fallen.
+
+Among recent developments we would specially mention the opening of a
+new home centre at Philadelphia, U.S.A. The total income of the Mission
+for 1901 was £53,633 = $257,712, and the total received in England
+alone, for 1902, was £51,446 = $246,912. The total membership of the
+Mission in June 1902 was 761.
+
+Current information about the progress of the work in China may be
+obtained from _China's Millions_, the organ of the Mission. It is
+published monthly, and may be ordered through any bookseller from
+Messrs. Morgan and Scott, 12 Paternoster Buildings, E.C., for 1s. per
+year, or direct by post from the offices of the Mission, Newington
+Green, London, N., for 1s. 6d. per annum.
+
+The Australasian edition of _China's Millions_ may be ordered at the
+same price from M. L. Hutchinson, Little Collins Street, or from the
+Mission Offices, 267 Collins Street, Melbourne. The North American
+edition will be sent post free from the Mission Offices, 507 Church
+Street, Toronto, for 50 cents per annum.
+
+Prayer meetings on behalf of the work in China are held at the principal
+home centres of the Mission, as follows: Every Saturday afternoon from 4
+to 6 o'clock, at Newington Green, London. Every Friday evening at 8
+o'clock, at 507 Church Street, Toronto. Every Saturday afternoon at 4
+o'clock, in the Office, 267 Collins Street, Melbourne. A hearty
+invitation to attend any one of these meetings is given to any one
+residing in or visiting any of these cities.
+
+Donations to the Mission, applications from candidates, orders for
+literature, requests for deputation speakers, and other correspondence
+should be forwarded to
+
+ The Secretary,
+ China Inland Mission,
+ Newington Green, London, N.
+
+ The Home Director,
+ China Inland Mission,
+ 507 Church Street, Toronto, Canada.
+
+or
+
+ 702 Witherspoon Buildings, Philadelphia, U.S.A.
+
+or to
+
+ The Secretary,
+ China Inland Mission,
+ 267 Collins Street, Melbourne, Australia.
+
+[Illustration: MAP OF CHINA
+
+ Shewing {1. All Protestant Mission Stations in China up to June 1866,
+ when the C.I.M. was founded (they numbered fifteen) These
+ are underlined in black.
+ {2. The Stations of the China Inland Mission which (with the
+ exception of Ning-Po & Fung-hwa) have been opened since
+ June 1866. These are printed in red.]
+
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+STATIONS OF THE CHINA INLAND MISSION
+
+1900
+
+(BEFORE THE BOXER OUTBREAK)
+
+
+The best guide to the stations of the Mission is the new _China Inland
+Mission Map_ (size 44 × 38 in., mounted on linen, coloured, varnished,
+and hung on rollers), price 8s. _net_, carriage and packing extra.
+Mounted to fold, 8s. _net_, post free.
+
+ Provinces.[4] Stations.[5] WORK BEGUN.
+
+ =Kan-suh=, 1876 LIANG-CHAU 1888
+ SI-NING 1885
+ LAN-CHAU 1885
+ TS'IN-CHAU 1878
+ _Area,[6] 125,450 square miles._ FU K'IANG 1899
+ _Population, 9,285,377._ P'ING-LIANG 1895
+ KING-CHAU 1895
+ TS'ING-NING 1897
+ Chen-yuen 1897
+ Tong-chi 1899
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Shen-si=, 1876. Lung-chau 1893
+ FENG-TSIANG 1888
+ Mei-hien 1893
+ K'IEN-CHAU 1894
+ _Area, 67,400 square miles._ Chau-chih 1893
+ _Population, 8,432,193._ _Sang-kia-chuang_ 1894
+ Hing-p'ing 1893
+ SI-GAN 1893
+ _Ying-kia-wei_ 1893
+ Chen-kia-hu 1897
+ Lan-t'ien 1895
+ K'ien-yang 1897
+ Ch'ang-wu 1897
+ San-shui 1897
+ T'UNG-CHAU 1891
+ Han-ch'eng 1897
+ HAN-CHUNG 1879
+ Ch'eng-ku 1887
+ Si-hsiang 1896
+ Yang-hien 1896
+ HING-AN 1898
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Shan-si=, 1876 TA-T'UNG 1886
+ Hwen-yuen 1898
+ SOH-P'ING 1895
+ Tsö-yuin 1895
+ YING-CHAU 1897
+ Hiao-i 1887
+ Kiai-hiu 1891
+ SIH-CHAU 1885
+ Ta-ning 1885
+ KIH-CHAU 1891
+ Ho-tsin 1893
+ Ping-yao 1888
+ _Area, 56,268 square miles._ HOH-CHAU 1886
+ _Population, 12,211,453._ Hung-t'ung 1886
+ Yoh-yang 1896
+ P'ING-YANG 1879
+ K'üh-wu 1885
+ I-shï 1891
+ Yüin-ch'eng 1888
+ _Mei-ti-kiai_ 1895
+ HIAI-CHAU 1895
+ Lu-ch'eng 1889
+ _Ü-wu_ 1896
+ LU-GAN 1889
+ Kiang-chau 1898
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Chih-li=, 1887 T'IEN-TSIN 1888
+ _Area, 58,949 square miles._ PAO-T'ING 1891
+ _Population, 17,937,000._ Hwuy-luh 1887
+ SHUN-TEH 1888
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Shan-tung=, 1879 _Chefoo_ 1879
+ " Sanatorium 1880
+ " Boys' School 1880
+ _Area, 53,762 square miles._ " Girls' " 1884
+ _Population, 36,247,835._ " Preparatory School 1895
+ _T'ung-shin_ 1889
+ Ning-hai 1886
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Ho-nan=, 1875 Siang-ch'eng 1891
+ _Chau-kia-k'eo_ 1884
+ _Ho-nan_ ...
+ _Ho-peh_ ...
+ _Ho-si_ ...
+ _Area, 66,913 square miles._ CH'EN-CHAU 1895
+ _Population, 22,115,827._ T'ai-k'ang 1895
+ _She-k'i-tien_ 1886
+ Kwang-chau 1899
+ Hin-an 1899
+ _King-tsï-kuan_ 1896
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =W. Si-ch'uan=, 1877 Kwan-hien 1889
+ CH'EN-TU 1881
+ KIA-TING 1888
+ _Area of whole Province, SUI-FU 1888
+ 166,800 square miles._ LU-CHAU 1890
+ Hiao-shï 1899
+ CH'UNG-K'ING 1877
+ Ta-chien-lu 1897
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =E. Si-ch'uan=, 1886 Kwang-yuen 1889
+ _Sin-tien-tsï_ 1892
+ PAO-NING 1886
+ Ying-shan 1898
+ _Population of whole Province, Kü-hien 1898
+ 67,712,897._ SHUN-K'ING 1896
+ Pa-chau 1887
+ SUI-TING 1899
+ Wan-hien 1888
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Hu-peh=, 1874 _Lao-ho-k'eo_ 1887
+ _Area, 70,450 square miles._ _Han-kow_ 1889
+ _Population, 34,244,685._ I-CH'ANG 1895
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Gan-hwuy=, 1869 T'ai-ho 1892
+ VING-CHAU 1897
+ _Ch'eng-yang-kwan_ 1887
+ _K'u-ch'eng_ 1887
+ Fuh-hing-tsih (Lai-gan) 1898
+ LUH-GAN 1890
+ GAN-K'ING 1869
+ _Area, 48,461 square miles._ Training Home ...
+ _Population, 20,596,288._ Wu-hu 1893
+ Kien-p'ing 1894
+ NING-KWOH 1874
+ KWANG-TEH 1890
+ CH'I-CHAU 1889
+ Kien-teh 1892
+ HWUY-CHAU 1884
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Kiang-su=, 1854 Gan-tung 1891
+ Ts'ing-kiang-pu 1869
+ Kao-yiu 1888
+ YANG-CHAU 1868
+ Training Home ...
+ CHIN-KIANG 1888
+ _Area, 44,500 square miles._ Shanghai 1854
+ _Population, 20,905,171._ Financial Department ...
+ Business Department ...
+ Home ...
+ Hospital ...
+ Evangelistic Work ...
+ Literary Work ...
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Yun-nan=, 1877 Bhâmo (Upper Burmah) 1875
+ _Area, 107,969 square miles._ TA-LI 1881
+ _Population, 11,721,576._ YUN-NAN 1882
+ K'ÜH-TS'ING 1889
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Kwei-chau=, 1877 KWEI-YANG 1877
+ GAN-SHUN 1888
+ _Area, 64,554 square miles._ Tuh-shan 1893
+ _Population, 7,669,181._ HING-I 1891
+ (Work among Aborigines) ...
+ _P'ang-hai_ 1897
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Hu-nan=, 1875 CH'ANG-TEH 1898
+ _Area, 74,320 square miles_. SHEN-CHAU 1898
+ _Population, 21,002,604._ Ch'a-ling 1898
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Kiang-si=, 1869 KIU-KIANG 1889
+ Ku-ling Sanatorium 1898
+ _Ta-ku-t'ang_ 1873
+ NAN-K'ANG 1887
+ Gan-ren 1889
+ RAO-CHAU 1898
+ _Peh-kan_ 1893
+ Kwei-k'i 1878
+ _Shang-ts'ing_ 1893
+ Hü-wan 1899
+ Ih-yang 1890
+ _Area, 72,176 square miles._ _Ho-k'eo_ 1878
+ _Population, 24,534,118._ _Yang-k'eo_ 1890
+ Kwang-feng 1889
+ Yuh-shan 1877
+ _Chang-shu_ 1895
+ KUI-GAN 1891
+ _Feng-kang_ 1891
+ KAN-CHAU 1899
+ Sin-feng 1899
+ LIN-KIANG 1898
+ NAN-CH'ANG 1898
+ UEN-CHAU (_Itinerating_) ...
+ Yung-sin 1899
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Cheh-kiang=, 1857 HANG-CHAU 1866
+ SHAO-HING 1866
+ Sin-ch'ang 1870
+ KIU-CHAU 1872
+ Ch'ang-shan 1878
+ Lan-k'i 1894
+ _Area, 39,150 square miles_. KIN-HWA 1875
+ _Population, 11,588,692._ Yung-k'ang 1882
+ Tseh-k'i 1897
+ CH'U-CHAU 1875
+ Lung-ch'uen 1894
+ Uin-ho 1895
+ Song-yang 1896
+ _Siao-mei_ 1896
+ Tsin-yun 1898
+ NING-P'O 1857
+ Fung-hwa 1866
+ Ning-hai 1868
+ T'ien-t'ai 1898
+ T'AI-CHAU 1867
+ Ling-he District ...
+ Hwang-yen 1896
+ T'ai-p'ing 1898
+ WUN-CHAU 1867
+ Bing-yae 1874
+
+FOOTNOTES:
+
+[4] Arranged in three lines from west to east, for easy reference to
+Map. The dates in this column in many cases are of itinerations begun.
+
+[5] Capitals of Provinces in capital letters; of Prefectures in small
+capitals; and of Counties in romans; Market Towns in italics.
+
+[6] Areas and populations are from _The Statesman's Year Book_.
+
+
+[Illustration]
+
+_Printed by_ R. & R. CLARK, LIMITED, _Edinburgh._
+
+ * * * * *
+
+Transcriber's Notes:
+
+Page 109, "my" changed to "My" (My marriage had been)
+
+Page 125, ending ) added. (Miss Bausum (afterwards Mrs. Barchett)); in)
+
+Page 129, format of "God" was changed to "GOD" to match rest of usage.
+(goodness of GOD)
+
+Possible nconsistencies in spelling of Chinese names were retained such
+as Bhâmo and Bhamô.
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of A Retrospect, by James Hudson Taylor
+
+*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK A RETROSPECT ***
+
+***** This file should be named 26744-8.txt or 26744-8.zip *****
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+ http://www.gutenberg.org/2/6/7/4/26744/
+
+Produced by Free Elf, Emmy and the Online Distributed
+Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net Music files created
+by Linda Cantoni.(This file was produced from images
+generously made available by The Internet Archive/Canadian
+Libraries) Full-color map generously provided by The
+Missionary E-texts Archive at
+http://www.missionaryetexts.org
+
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+http://gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH F3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need, is critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at http://www.pglaf.org.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at
+http://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at http://pglaf.org
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit http://pglaf.org
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations.
+To donate, please visit: http://pglaf.org/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ http://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
diff --git a/old/26744.txt b/old/26744.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..06b0c42
--- /dev/null
+++ b/old/26744.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,4703 @@
+The Project Gutenberg EBook of A Retrospect, by James Hudson Taylor
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+Title: A Retrospect
+
+Author: James Hudson Taylor
+
+Release Date: October 1, 2008 [EBook #26744]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ASCII
+
+*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK A RETROSPECT ***
+
+
+
+
+Produced by Free Elf, Emmy and the Online Distributed
+Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net Music files created
+by Linda Cantoni.(This file was produced from images
+generously made available by The Internet Archive/Canadian
+Libraries) Full-color map generously provided by The
+Missionary E-texts Archive at
+http://www.missionaryetexts.org
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+[Illustration: Signature: J. Hudson Taylor.]
+
+
+
+
+A RETROSPECT
+
+BY
+
+J. HUDSON TAYLOR, M.R.C.S., F.R.G.S.
+
+_Thou shalt remember all the way which the Lord thy God led thee._
+
+THIRD EDITION
+
+ TORONTO
+ CHINA INLAND MISSION
+ 507 CHURCH STREET
+
+[Illustration: THE "LAMMERMUIR" PARTY. _See page 125._]
+
+
+
+
+CONTENTS
+
+ CHAP. PAGE
+ I. THE POWER OF PRAYER 1
+ II. THE CALL TO SERVICE 7
+ III. PREPARATION FOR SERVICE 13
+ IV. FURTHER ANSWERS TO PRAYER 19
+ V. LIFE IN LONDON 24
+ VI. STRENGTHENED BY FAITH 30
+ VII. MIGHTY TO SAVE 35
+ VIII. VOYAGE TO CHINA 39
+ IX. EARLY MISSIONARY EXPERIENCES 45
+ X. FIRST EVANGELISTIC EFFORTS 49
+ XI. WITH THE REV. W. C. BURNS 57
+ XII. THE CALL TO SWATOW 70
+ "The Missionary Call": Words and Music 75
+ XIII. MAN PROPOSES, GOD DISPOSES 77
+ XIV. PROVIDENTIAL GUIDANCE 92
+ XV. SETTLEMENT IN NINGPO 98
+ XVI. TIMELY SUPPLIES 105
+ XVII. GOD A REFUGE FOR US 110
+ XVIII. A NEW AGENCY NEEDED 116
+ XIX. FORMATION OF THE C. I. M. 121
+ XX. THE MISSION IN 1894 126
+ THE MISSION IN 1902 128
+ STATIONS OF THE C. I. M. 131
+
+ * * * * *
+
+ MAP OF CHINA
+
+ SHOWING THE STATIONS OF THE CHINA INLAND MISSION:
+ CORRECTED TO JUNE 1900 _To face page_ 131
+
+
+
+
+ILLUSTRATIONS
+
+
+ 1. Portrait of J. Hudson Taylor _Frontispiece_
+ 2. The "Lammermuir" party _Facing "Contents"_
+ PAGE
+ 3. Honorary banner presented to a missionary 1
+ 4. A heavy road in North China 7
+ 5. Salt junk on the Yang-tsi 13
+ 6. Travelling by mule cart on "the great plain" 19
+ 7. Ch'ung-k'ing, the Yang-tsi, and mountains beyond 24
+ 8. Water gate and Custom house, Soo-chow 29
+ 9. View on the Kwang-sin River 30
+ 10. Temple and memorial portal 34
+ 11. "Compassionate heart, benevolent methods" 35
+ 12. Outside the wall of Gan-k'ing 38
+ 13. The new girls school at Chefoo 39
+ 14. Entrance to the Po-yang lake 44
+ 15. A fair wind, at sunset, on the lake 45
+ 16. A view on the grand canal 49
+ 17. Down the Yang-tsi on a cargo boat 57
+ 18. East gate and sentry box, Bhamo, Burmah 69
+ 19. Farmhouse, with buffalo shed attached 70
+ 20. A fishing village on the lake near Yuennan Fu 77
+ 21. Teng-yueh, the westernmost walled city in China 91
+ 22. A small temple near Wun-chau 92
+ 23. Group of Christians at Lan-k'i, Cheh-kiang 97
+ 24. A boat on the Red River, Tonquin 98
+ 25. Students' quarters, Gan-k'ing Training Home 104
+ 26. A Mandarin's sedan chair 105
+ 27. A presentation banner (a mark of high respect) 110
+ 28. View on the Po-yang lake 116
+ 29. A village on the grand canal 121
+ 30. The battlements of Pekin 126
+ 31. Native woodcut of a landscape 131
+ 32. Elder Liu and wife, Kwei-k'i 136
+
+ The hearty thanks of the Mission for the use of
+ photographs and sketches are hereby tendered to
+ Rev. George Hayes for Nos. 4 and 6; Dr. G.
+ Whitfield Guinness for Nos. 8, 12, 16, 25, and 28;
+ Miss Davies for No. 23; Mr. Thomas Selkirk for
+ Nos. 18 and 21; Mr. J. T. Reid for Nos. 14, 15,
+ and 27; Mr. J. S. Rough for No. 30; Mr. Grainger
+ for No. 19; Mr. E. Murray for No. 13, and also to
+ other friends unknown by name.
+
+
+
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER I
+
+THE POWER OF PRAYER
+
+
+THE following account of some of the experiences which eventually led to
+the formation of the CHINA INLAND MISSION, and to its taking the form in
+which it has been developed, first appeared in the pages of _China's
+Millions_. Many of those who read it there asked that it might appear in
+separate form. Miss Guinness incorporated it in the _Story of the China
+Inland Mission_, a record which contained the account of GOD'S goodness
+to the beginning of 1894. But friends still asking for it in pamphlet
+form, for wider distribution, this edition is brought out.
+
+Much of the material was taken from notes of addresses given in China
+during a conference of our missionaries; this will account for the
+direct and narrative form of the papers, which it has not been thought
+necessary to change.
+
+It is always helpful to us to fix our attention on the GOD-ward aspect
+of Christian work; to realise that the work of GOD does not mean so much
+man's work for GOD, as GOD'S own work through man. Furthermore, in our
+privileged position of fellow-workers with Him, while fully recognising
+all the benefits and blessings to be bestowed on a sin-stricken world
+through the proclamation of the Gospel and spread of the Truth, we
+should never lose sight of the higher aspect of our work--that of
+obedience to GOD, of bringing glory to His Name, of gladdening the
+heart of our GOD and FATHER by living and serving as His beloved
+children.
+
+Many circumstances connected with my own early life and service
+presented this aspect of work vividly to me; and as I think of some of
+them, I am reminded of how much the cause of missions is indebted to
+many who are never themselves permitted to see the mission field--many,
+it may be, who are unable to give largely of their substance, and who
+will be not a little surprised in the Great Day to see how much the work
+has been advanced by their love, their sympathy, and their prayers.
+
+For myself, and for the work that I have been permitted to do for GOD, I
+owe an unspeakable debt of gratitude to my beloved and honoured parents,
+who have passed away and entered into rest, but the influence of whose
+lives will never pass away.
+
+Many years ago, probably about 1830, the heart of my dear father, then
+himself an earnest and successful evangelist at home, was deeply stirred
+as to the spiritual state of China by reading several books, and
+especially an account of the travels of Captain Basil Hall. His
+circumstances were such as to preclude the hope of his ever going to
+China for personal service, but he was led to pray that if GOD should
+give him a son, he might be called and privileged to labour in the vast
+needy empire which was then apparently so sealed against the truth. I
+was not aware of this desire or prayer myself until my return to
+England, more than seven years after I had sailed for China; but it was
+very interesting then to know how prayer offered before my birth had
+been answered in this matter.
+
+All thought of my becoming a missionary was abandoned for many years by
+my dear parents on account of the feebleness of my health. When the
+time came, however, GOD gave increased health, and my life has been
+spared, and strength has been given for not a little toilsome service
+both in the mission field and at home, while many stronger men and women
+have succumbed.
+
+I had many opportunities in early years of learning the value of prayer
+and of the Word of GOD; for it was the delight of my dear parents to
+point out that if there were any such Being as GOD, to trust Him, to
+obey Him, and to be fully given up to His service, must of necessity be
+the best and wisest course both for myself and others. But in spite of
+these helpful examples and precepts my heart was unchanged. Often I had
+tried to make myself a Christian; and failing of course in such efforts,
+I began at last to think that for some reason or other I could not be
+saved, and that the best I could do was to take my fill of this world,
+as there was no hope for me beyond the grave.
+
+While in this state of mind I came in contact with persons holding
+sceptical and infidel views, and accepted their teaching, only too
+thankful for some hope of escape from the doom which, if my parents were
+right and the Bible true, awaited the impenitent. It may seem strange to
+say it, but I have often felt thankful for the experience of this time
+of scepticism. The inconsistencies of Christian people, who while
+professing to believe their Bibles were yet content to live just as they
+would if there were no such book, had been one of the strongest
+arguments of my sceptical companions; and I frequently felt at that
+time, and said, that if I pretended to believe the Bible I would at any
+rate attempt to live by it, putting it fairly to the test, and if it
+failed to prove true and reliable, would throw it overboard altogether.
+These views I retained when the LORD was pleased to bring me to
+Himself; and I think I may say that since then I _have_ put GOD'S Word
+to the test. Certainly it has never failed me. I have never had reason
+to regret the confidence I have placed in its promises, or to deplore
+following the guidance I have found in its directions.
+
+Let me tell you how GOD answered the prayers of my dear mother and of my
+beloved sister, now Mrs. Broomhall, for my conversion. On a day which I
+shall never forget, when I was about fifteen years of age, my dear
+mother being absent from home, I had a holiday, and in the afternoon
+looked through my father's library to find some book with which to while
+away the unoccupied hours. Nothing attracting me, I turned over a little
+basket of pamphlets, and selected from amongst them a Gospel tract which
+looked interesting, saying to myself, "There will be a story at the
+commencement, and a sermon or moral at the close: I will take the former
+and leave the latter for those who like it."
+
+I sat down to read the little book in an utterly unconcerned state of
+mind, believing indeed at the time that if there were any salvation it
+was not for me, and with a distinct intention to put away the tract as
+soon as it should seem prosy. I may say that it was not uncommon in
+those days to call conversion "becoming serious"; and judging by the
+faces of some of its professors, it appeared to be a very serious matter
+indeed. Would it not be well if the people of GOD had always tell-tale
+faces, evincing the blessings and gladness of salvation so clearly that
+unconverted people might have to call conversion "becoming joyful"
+instead of "becoming serious"?
+
+Little did I know at the time what was going on in the heart of my dear
+mother, seventy or eighty miles away. She rose from the dinner-table
+that afternoon with an intense yearning for the conversion of her boy,
+and feeling that--absent from home, and having more leisure than she
+could otherwise secure--a special opportunity was afforded her of
+pleading with GOD on my behalf. She went to her room and turned the key
+in the door, resolved not to leave that spot until her prayers were
+answered. Hour after hour did that dear mother plead for me, until at
+length she could pray no longer, but was constrained to praise GOD for
+that which His SPIRIT taught her had already been accomplished--the
+conversion of her only son.
+
+I in the meantime had been led in the way I have mentioned to take up
+this little tract, and while reading it was struck with the sentence,
+"The finished work of CHRIST." The thought passed through my mind, "Why
+does the author use this expression? why not say the atoning or
+propitiatory work of CHRIST?" Immediately the words "It is finished"
+suggested themselves to my mind. What was finished? And I at once
+replied, "A full and perfect atonement and satisfaction for sin: the
+debt was paid by the Substitute; CHRIST died for our sins, and not for
+ours only, but also for the sins of the whole world." Then came the
+thought, "If the whole work was finished and the whole debt paid, what
+is there left for me to do?" And with this dawned the joyful conviction,
+as light was flashed into my soul by the HOLY SPIRIT, that there was
+nothing in the world to be done but to fall down on one's knees, and
+accepting this SAVIOUR and His salvation, to praise Him for evermore.
+Thus while my dear mother was praising GOD on her knees in her chamber,
+I was praising Him in the old warehouse to which I had gone alone to
+read at my leisure this little book.
+
+Several days elapsed ere I ventured to make my beloved sister the
+confidante of my joy, and then only after she had promised not to tell
+any one of my soul secret. When our dear mother came home a fortnight
+later, I was the first to meet her at the door, and to tell her I had
+such glad news to give. I can almost feel that dear mother's arms around
+my neck, as she pressed me to her bosom and said, "I know, my boy; I
+have been rejoicing for a fortnight in the glad tidings you have to tell
+me." "Why," I asked in surprise, "has Amelia broken her promise? She
+said she would tell no one." My dear mother assured me that it was not
+from any human source that she had learned the tidings, and went on to
+tell the little incident mentioned above. You will agree with me that it
+would be strange indeed if I were not a believer in the power of prayer.
+
+Nor was this all. Some little time after, I picked up a pocket-book
+exactly like one of my own, and thinking that it was mine, opened it.
+The lines that caught my eye were an entry in the little diary, which
+belonged to my sister, to the effect that she would give herself daily
+to prayer until GOD should answer in the conversion of her brother.
+Exactly one month later the LORD was pleased to turn me from darkness to
+light.
+
+Brought up in such a circle and saved under such circumstances, it was
+perhaps natural that from the commencement of my Christian life I was
+led to feel that the promises were very real, and that prayer was in
+sober matter of fact transacting business with GOD, whether on one's own
+behalf or on behalf of those for whom one sought His blessing.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II
+
+THE CALL TO SERVICE
+
+
+THE first joys of conversion passed away after a time, and were
+succeeded by a period of painful deadness of soul, with much conflict.
+But this also came to an end, leaving a deepened sense of personal
+weakness and dependence on the LORD as the only KEEPER as well as
+SAVIOUR of His people. How sweet to the soul, wearied and disappointed
+in its struggles with sin, is the calm repose of trust in the SHEPHERD
+of Israel.
+
+Not many months after my conversion, having a leisure afternoon, I
+retired to my own chamber to spend it largely in communion with GOD.
+Well do I remember that occasion. How in the gladness of my heart I
+poured out my soul before GOD; and again and again confessing my
+grateful love to Him who had done everything for me--who had saved me
+when I had given up all hope and even desire for salvation--I besought
+Him to give me some work to do for Him, as an outlet for love and
+gratitude; some self-denying service, no matter what it might be,
+however trying or however trivial; something with which He would be
+pleased, and that I might do for Him who had done so much for me. Well
+do I remember, as in unreserved consecration I put myself, my life, my
+friends, my all, upon the altar, the deep solemnity that came over my
+soul with the assurance that my offering was accepted. The presence of
+GOD became unutterably real and blessed; and though but a child under
+sixteen, I remember stretching myself on the ground, and lying there
+silent before Him with unspeakable awe and unspeakable joy.
+
+For what service I was accepted I knew not; but a deep consciousness
+that I was no longer my own took possession of me, which has never since
+been effaced. It has been a very practical consciousness. Two or three
+years later propositions of an unusually favourable nature were made to
+me with regard to medical study, on the condition of my becoming
+apprenticed to the medical man who was my friend and teacher. But I felt
+I dared not accept any binding engagement such as was suggested. I was
+not my own to give myself away; for I knew not when or how He whose
+alone I was, and for whose disposal I felt I must ever keep myself free,
+might call for service.
+
+Within a few months of this time of consecration the impression was
+wrought into my soul that it was in China the LORD wanted me. It seemed
+to me highly probable that the work to which I was thus called might
+cost my life; for China was not then open as it is now. But few
+missionary societies had at that time workers in China, and but few
+books on the subject of China missions were accessible to me. I learned,
+however, that the Congregational minister of my native town possessed a
+copy of Medhurst's _China_, and I called upon him to ask a loan of the
+book. This he kindly granted, asking me why I wished to read it. I told
+him that GOD had called me to spend my life in missionary service in
+that land. "And how do you propose to go there?" he inquired. I answered
+that I did not at all know; that it seemed to me probable that I should
+need to do as the Twelve and the Seventy had done in Judaea--go without
+purse or scrip, relying on Him who had called me to supply all my need.
+Kindly placing his hand upon my shoulder, the minister replied, "Ah, my
+boy, as you grow older you will get wiser than that. Such an idea would
+do very well in the days when CHRIST Himself was on earth, but not now."
+
+I have grown older since then, but not wiser. I am more than ever
+convinced that if we were to take the directions of our MASTER and the
+assurances He gave to His first disciples more fully as our guide, we
+should find them to be just as suited to our times as to those in which
+they were originally given.
+
+Medhurst's book on China emphasised the value of medical missions there,
+and this directed my attention to medical studies as a valuable mode of
+preparation.
+
+My beloved parents neither discouraged nor encouraged my desire to
+engage in missionary work. They advised me, with such convictions, to
+use all the means in my power to develop the resources of body, mind,
+heart, and soul, and to wait prayerfully upon GOD, quite willing, should
+He show me that I was mistaken, to follow His guidance, or to go forward
+if in due time He should open the way to missionary service. The
+importance of this advice I have often since had occasion to prove. I
+began to take more exercise in the open air to strengthen my physique.
+My feather bed I had taken away, and sought to dispense with as many
+other home comforts as I could, in order to prepare myself for rougher
+lines of life. I began also to do what Christian work was in my power,
+in the way of tract distribution, Sunday-school teaching, and visiting
+the poor and sick, as opportunity afforded.
+
+After a time of preparatory study at home, I went to Hull for medical
+and surgical training. There I became assistant to a doctor who was
+connected with the Hull school of medicine, and was surgeon also to a
+number of factories, which brought many accident cases to our
+dispensary, and gave me the opportunity of seeing and practising the
+minor operations of surgery.
+
+And here an event took place that I must not omit to mention. Before
+leaving home my attention was drawn to the subject of setting apart the
+firstfruits of all one's increase and a proportionate part of one's
+possessions to the LORD'S service. I thought it well to study the
+question with my Bible in hand before I went away from home, and was
+placed in circumstances which might bias my conclusions by the pressure
+of surrounding wants and cares. I was thus led to the determination to
+set apart not less than one-tenth of whatever moneys I might earn or
+become possessed of for the LORD'S service. The salary I received as
+medical assistant in Hull at the time now referred to would have allowed
+me with ease to do this. But owing to changes in the family of my kind
+friend and employer, it was necessary for me to reside out of doors.
+Comfortable quarters were secured with a relative, and in addition to
+the sum determined on as remuneration for my services I received the
+exact amount I had to pay for board and lodging.
+
+Now arose in my mind the question, Ought not this sum also to be tithed?
+It was surely a part of my income, and I felt that if it had been a
+question of Government income tax it certainly would not have been
+excluded. On the other hand, to take a tithe from the whole would not
+leave me sufficient for other purposes; and for some little time I was
+much embarrassed to know what to do. After much thought and prayer I was
+led to leave the comfortable quarters and happy circle in which I was
+now residing, and to engage a little lodging in the suburbs--a
+sitting-room and bedroom in one--undertaking to board myself. In this
+way I was able without difficulty to tithe the whole of my income; and
+while I felt the change a good deal, it was attended with no small
+blessing.
+
+More time was given in my solitude to the study of the Word of GOD, to
+visiting the poor, and to evangelistic work on summer evenings than
+would otherwise have been the case. Brought into contact in this way
+with many who were in distress, I soon saw the privilege of still
+further economising, and found it not difficult to give away much more
+than the proportion of my income I had at first intended.
+
+About this time a friend drew my attention to the question of the
+personal and pre-millennial coming of our LORD JESUS CHRIST, and gave me
+a list of passages bearing upon it, without note or comment, advising me
+to ponder the subject. For a while I gave much time to studying the
+Scriptures about it, with the result that I was led to see that this
+same JESUS who left our earth in His resurrection body was so to come
+again, that His feet were to stand on the Mount of Olives, and that He
+was to take possession of the temporal throne of His father David which
+was promised before His birth. I saw, further, that all through the New
+Testament the coming of the LORD was the great hope of His people, and
+was always appealed to as the strongest motive for consecration and
+service, and as the greatest comfort in trial and affliction. I learned,
+too, that the period of His return for His people was not revealed, and
+that it was their privilege, from day to day and from hour to hour, to
+live as men who wait for the LORD; that thus living it was immaterial,
+so to speak, whether He should or should not come at any particular
+hour, the important thing being to be so ready for Him as to be able,
+whenever He might appear, to give an account of one's stewardship with
+joy, and not with grief.
+
+The effect of this blessed hope was a thoroughly practical one. It led
+me to look carefully through my little library to see if there were any
+books there that were not needed or likely to be of further service, and
+to examine my small wardrobe, to be quite sure that it contained nothing
+that I should be sorry to give an account of should the MASTER come at
+once. The result was that the library was considerably diminished, to
+the benefit of some poor neighbours, and to the far greater benefit of
+my own and that I found I had articles of clothing also which might be
+put to better advantage in other directions.
+
+It has been very helpful to me from time to time through life, as
+occasion has served, to act again in a similar way; and I have never
+gone through my house, from basement to attic, with this object in view,
+without receiving a great accession of spiritual joy and blessing. I
+believe we are all in danger of accumulating--it may be from
+thoughtlessness, or from pressure of occupation--things which would be
+useful to others, while not needed by ourselves, and the retention of
+which entails loss of blessing. If the whole resources of the Church of
+GOD were well utilised, how much more might be accomplished! How many
+poor might be fed and naked clothed, and to how many of those as yet
+unreached the Gospel might be carried! Let me advise this line of things
+as a constant habit of mind, and a profitable course to be practically
+adopted whenever circumstances permit.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III
+
+PREPARATION FOR SERVICE
+
+
+HAVING now the twofold object in view of accustoming myself to endure
+hardness, and of economising in order to be able more largely to assist
+those amongst whom I spent a good deal of time labouring in the Gospel,
+I soon found that I could live upon very much less than I had previously
+thought possible. Butter, milk, and other such luxuries I soon ceased to
+use; and I found that by living mainly on oatmeal and rice, with
+occasional variations, a very small sum was sufficient for my needs. In
+this way I had more than two-thirds of my income available for other
+purposes; and my experience was that the less I spent on myself and the
+more I gave away, the fuller of happiness and blessing did my soul
+become. Unspeakable joy all the day long, and every day, was my happy
+experience. GOD, even my GOD, was a living, bright Reality; and all I
+had to do was joyful service.
+
+It was to me a very grave matter, however, to contemplate going out to
+China, far away from all human aid, there to depend upon the living GOD
+alone for protection, supplies, and help of every kind. I felt that
+one's spiritual muscles required strengthening for such an undertaking.
+There was no doubt that if faith did not fail, GOD would not fail; but,
+then, what if one's faith should prove insufficient? I had not at that
+time learned that even "if we believe not, He abideth faithful, He
+cannot deny Himself"; and it was consequently a very serious question to
+my mind, not whether _He_ was faithful, but whether I had strong enough
+faith to warrant my embarking in the enterprise set before me.
+
+I thought to myself, "When I get out to China, I shall have no claim on
+any one for anything; my only claim will be on GOD. How important,
+therefore, to learn before leaving England to move man, through GOD, by
+prayer alone."
+
+At Hull my kind employer, always busily occupied, wished me to remind
+him whenever my salary became due. This I determined not to do directly,
+but to ask that GOD would bring the fact to his recollection, and thus
+encourage me by answering prayer. At one time, as the day drew near for
+the payment of a quarter's salary, I was as usual much in prayer about
+it. The time arrived, but my kind friend made no allusion to the matter.
+I continued praying, and days passed on, but he did not remember, until
+at length, on settling up my weekly accounts one Saturday night, I found
+myself possessed of only a single coin--one half-crown piece. Still I
+had hitherto had no lack, and I continued in prayer.
+
+That Sunday was a very happy one. As usual my heart was full and
+brimming over with blessing. After attending Divine service in the
+morning, my afternoons and evenings were filled with Gospel work, in the
+various lodging-houses I was accustomed to visit in the lowest part of
+the town. At such times it almost seemed to me as if heaven were begun
+below, and that all that could be looked for was an enlargement of one's
+capacity for joy, not a truer filling than I possessed. After concluding
+my last service about ten o'clock that night, a poor man asked me to go
+and pray with his wife, saying that she was dying. I readily agreed, and
+on the way to his house asked him why he had not sent for the priest, as
+his accent told me he was an Irishman. He had done so, he said, but the
+priest refused to come without a payment of eighteenpence, which the man
+did not possess, as the family was starving. Immediately it occurred to
+my mind that all the money I had in the world was the solitary
+half-crown, and that it was in one coin; moreover, that while the basin
+of water gruel I usually took for supper was awaiting me, and there was
+sufficient in the house for breakfast in the morning, I certainly had
+nothing for dinner on the coming day.
+
+Somehow or other there was at once a stoppage in the flow of joy in my
+heart; but instead of reproving myself I began to reprove the poor man,
+telling him that it was very wrong to have allowed matters to get into
+such a state as he described, and that he ought to have applied to the
+relieving officer. His answer was that he had done so, and was told to
+come at eleven o'clock the next morning, but that he feared that his
+wife might not live through the night. "Ah," thought I, "if only I had
+two shillings and a sixpence instead of this half-crown, how gladly
+would I give these poor people one shilling of it!" But to part with the
+half-crown was far from my thoughts. I little dreamed that the real
+truth of the matter simply was that I could trust in GOD plus
+one-and-sixpence, but was not yet prepared to trust Him only, without
+any money at all in my pocket.
+
+My conductor led me into a court, down which I followed him with some
+degree of nervousness. I had found myself there before, and at my last
+visit had been very roughly handled, while my tracts were torn to
+pieces, and I received such a warning not to come again that I felt
+more than a little concerned. Still, it was the path of duty, and I
+followed on. Up a miserable flight of stairs, into a wretched room, he
+led me; and oh what a sight there presented itself to our eyes! Four or
+five poor children stood about, their sunken cheeks and temples all
+telling unmistakably the story of slow starvation; and lying on a
+wretched pallet was a poor exhausted mother, with a tiny infant
+thirty-six hours old, moaning rather than crying at her side, for it too
+seemed spent and failing. "Ah!" thought I, "if I had two shillings and a
+sixpence instead of half-a-crown, how gladly should they have
+one-and-sixpence of it!" But still a wretched unbelief prevented me from
+obeying the impulse to relieve their distress at the cost of all I
+possessed.
+
+It will scarcely seem strange that I was unable to say much to comfort
+these poor people. I needed comfort myself. I began to tell them,
+however, that they must not be cast down, that though their
+circumstances were very distressing, there was a kind and loving FATHER
+in heaven; but something within me said, "You hypocrite! telling these
+unconverted people about a kind and loving FATHER in heaven, and not
+prepared yourself to trust Him without half-a-crown!" I was nearly
+choked. How gladly would I have compromised with conscience if I had had
+a florin and a sixpence! I would have given the florin thankfully and
+kept the rest; but I was not yet prepared to trust in GOD alone, without
+the sixpence.
+
+To talk was impossible under these circumstances; yet, strange to say, I
+thought I should have no difficulty in praying. Prayer was a delightful
+occupation to me in those days; time thus spent never seemed wearisome,
+and I knew nothing of lack of words. I seemed to think that all I should
+have to do would be to kneel down and engage in prayer, and that relief
+would come to them and to myself together. "You asked me to come and
+pray with your wife," I said to the man, "let us pray." And I knelt
+down. But scarcely had I opened my lips with "Our FATHER who art in
+heaven" than conscience said within, "Dare you mock GOD? Dare you kneel
+down and call Him FATHER with that half-crown in your pocket?" Such a
+time of conflict came upon me then as I have never experienced before or
+since. How I got through that form of prayer I know not, and whether the
+words uttered were connected or disconnected I cannot tell; but I arose
+from my knees in great distress of mind.
+
+The poor father turned to me and said, "You see what a terrible state we
+are in, sir; if you can help us, for GOD'S sake do!" Just then the word
+flashed into my mind, "Give to him that asketh of thee," and in the word
+of a KING there is power. I put my hand into my pocket, and slowly
+drawing forth the half-crown, gave it to the man, telling him that it
+might seem a small matter for me to relieve them, seeing that I was
+comparatively well off, but that in parting with that coin I was giving
+him my all; what I had been trying to tell him was indeed true--GOD
+really was a FATHER, and might be trusted. The joy all came back in full
+flood-tide to my heart; I could say anything and feel it then, and the
+hindrance to blessing was gone--gone, I trust, for ever.
+
+Not only was the poor woman's life saved, but I realised that my life
+was saved too! It might have been a wreck--would have been a wreck
+probably, as a Christian life--had not grace at that time conquered, and
+the striving of GOD'S SPIRIT been obeyed. I well remember how that
+night, as I went home to my lodgings, my heart was as light as my
+pocket. The lonely, deserted streets resounded with a hymn of praise
+which I could not restrain. When I took my basin of gruel before
+retiring, I would not have exchanged it for a prince's feast. I
+reminded the LORD as I knelt at my bedside of His own Word, that he who
+giveth to the poor lendeth to the LORD: I asked Him not to let my loan
+be a long one, or I should have no dinner next day; and with peace
+within and peace without, I spent a happy, restful night.
+
+Next morning for breakfast my plate of porridge remained, and before it
+was consumed the postman's knock was heard at the door. I was not in the
+habit of receiving letters on Monday, as my parents and most of my
+friends refrained from posting on Saturday; so that I was somewhat
+surprised when the landlady came in holding a letter or packet in her
+wet hand covered by her apron. I looked at the letter, but could not
+make out the handwriting. It was either a strange hand or a feigned one,
+and the postmark was blurred. Where it came from I could not tell. On
+opening the envelope I found nothing written within; but inside a sheet
+of blank paper was folded a pair of kid gloves, from which, as I opened
+them in astonishment, half-a-sovereign fell to the ground. "Praise the
+LORD!" I exclaimed; "400 per cent for twelve hours investment; that is
+good interest. How glad the merchants of Hull would be if they could
+lend their money at such a rate!" I then and there determined that a
+bank which could not break should have my savings or earnings as the
+case might be--a determination I have not yet learned to regret.
+
+I cannot tell you how often my mind has recurred to this incident, or
+all the help it has been to me in circumstances of difficulty in
+after-life. If we are faithful to GOD in little things, we shall gain
+experience and strength that will be helpful to us in the more serious
+trials of life.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV
+
+FURTHER ANSWERS TO PRAYER
+
+
+THE remarkable and gracious deliverance I have spoken of, was a great
+joy to me, as well as a strong confirmation of faith; but of course ten
+shillings, however economically used, will not go very far, and it was
+none the less necessary to continue in prayer, asking that the larger
+supply which was still due might be remembered and paid. All my
+petitions, however, appeared to remain unanswered; and before a
+fortnight had elapsed I found myself pretty much in the same position
+that I had occupied on the Sunday night already made so memorable.
+Meanwhile, I continued pleading with GOD, more and more earnestly, that
+He would graciously remind my employer that my salary was overdue. Of
+course it was not the want of the money that distressed me--that could
+have been had at any time for the asking--but the question uppermost in
+my mind was this: "Can I go to China? or will my want of faith and power
+with GOD prove to be so serious an obstacle as to preclude my entering
+upon this much-prized service?"
+
+As the week drew to a close I felt exceedingly embarrassed. There was
+not only myself to consider; on Saturday night a payment would be due to
+my Christian landlady which I knew she could not well dispense with.
+Ought I not, for her sake, to speak about the matter of the salary? Yet
+to do so would be, to myself at any rate, the admission that I was not
+fitted to undertake a missionary enterprise. I gave nearly the whole of
+Thursday and Friday--all the time not occupied in my necessary
+employment--to earnest wrestling with GOD in prayer. But still on
+Saturday morning I was in the same position as before. And now my
+earnest cry was for guidance as to whether it was my duty to break
+silence and speak to my employer, or whether I should still continue to
+wait the FATHER's time. As far as I could judge, I received the
+assurance that to wait His time was best; and that GOD in some way or
+other would interpose on my behalf. So I waited, my heart being now at
+rest and the burden gone.
+
+About five o'clock that Saturday afternoon, when the doctor had finished
+writing his prescriptions, his last circuit for the day being taken, he
+threw himself back in his arm-chair, as he was wont, and began to speak
+of the things of GOD. He was a truly Christian man, and many seasons of
+very happy spiritual fellowship we had together. I was busily watching,
+at the time, a pan in which a decoction was boiling that required a good
+deal of attention. It was indeed fortunate for me that it was so, for
+without any obvious connection with what had been going on, all at once
+he said, "By-the-bye, Taylor, is not your salary due again?" My emotion
+may be imagined! I had to swallow two or three times before I could
+answer. With my eye fixed on the pan and my back to the doctor, I told
+him as quietly as I could that it was overdue some little time. How
+thankful I felt at that moment! GOD surely had heard my prayer, and
+caused him, in this time of my great need, to remember the salary
+without any word or suggestion from me. He replied, "Oh, I am so sorry
+you did not remind me! You know how busy I am; I wish I had thought of
+it a little sooner, for only this afternoon I sent all the money I had
+to the bank, otherwise I would pay you at once." It is impossible to
+describe the revulsion of feeling caused by this unexpected statement. I
+knew not what to do. Fortunately for me my pan boiled up, and I had a
+good reason for rushing with it from the room. Glad indeed I was to get
+away, and keep out of sight until after the doctor had returned to his
+house, and most thankful that he had not perceived my emotion.
+
+As soon as he was gone I had to seek my little sanctum, and pour out my
+heart before the LORD for some time, before calmness--and more than
+calmness--thankfulness, and joy were restored to me. I felt that GOD had
+His own way, and was not going to fail me. I had sought to know His will
+early in the day, and as far as I could judge had received guidance to
+wait patiently; and now GOD was going to work for me in some other way.
+
+That evening was spent, as my Saturday evenings usually were, in reading
+the Word and preparing the subjects on which I expected to speak in the
+various lodging-houses on the morrow. I waited, perhaps, a little longer
+than usual. At last, about ten o'clock, there being no interruption of
+any kind, I put on my overcoat, and was preparing to leave for home,
+rather thankful to know that by that time I should have to let myself in
+with the latch-key, as my landlady retired early to rest. There was
+certainly no help for that night; but perhaps GOD would interpose for me
+by Monday, and I might be able to pay my landlady early in the week the
+money I would have given her before, had it been possible.
+
+Just as I was preparing to turn down the gas, I heard the doctor's step
+in the garden which lay between the dwelling-house and surgery. He was
+laughing to himself very heartily, as though greatly amused by
+something. Entering the surgery, he asked for the ledger, and told me
+that, strange to say, one of his richest patients had just come to pay
+his doctor's bill--was it not an odd thing to do? It never struck me
+that it might have any bearing on my own particular case, or I might
+have felt embarrassed; but looking at it simply from the position of an
+uninterested spectator, I also was highly amused that a man who was
+rolling in wealth should come after ten o'clock at night to pay a
+doctor's bill, which he could any day have met by a cheque with the
+greatest ease. It appeared that somehow or other he could not rest with
+this on his mind, and had been constrained to come at that unusual hour
+to discharge his liability.
+
+The account was duly receipted in the ledger, and the doctor was about
+to leave, when suddenly he turned, and handing me some of the bank notes
+just received, said, to my surprise and thankfulness, "By the way,
+Taylor, you might as well take these notes; I have not any change, but
+can give you the balance next week." Again I was left--my feelings
+undiscovered--to go back to my own little closet and praise the LORD
+with a joyful heart that after all I might go to China.
+
+To me this incident was not a trivial one; and to recall it sometimes,
+in circumstances of great difficulty, in China or elsewhere, has proved
+no small comfort and strength.
+
+By-and-by the time drew near when it was thought desirable that I should
+leave Hull to attend the medical course of the London Hospital. A little
+while spent there, and then I had every reason to believe that my
+life-work in China would commence. But much as I had rejoiced at the
+willingness of GOD to hear and answer prayer and to help His
+half-trusting, half-timid child, I felt that I could not go to China
+without having still further developed and tested my power to rest upon
+His faithfulness; and a marked opportunity for doing so was
+providentially afforded me.
+
+My dear father had offered to bear all the expense of my stay in London.
+I knew, however, that, owing to recent losses, it would mean a
+considerable sacrifice for him to undertake this just when it seemed
+necessary for me to go forward. I had recently become acquainted with
+the Committee of the Chinese Evangelisation Society, in connection with
+which I ultimately left for China, and especially with its secretary, my
+esteemed and much-loved friend Mr. George Pearse, then of the Stock
+Exchange, but now[1] and for many years himself a missionary. Not
+knowing of my father's proposition, the Committee also kindly offered to
+bear my expenses while in London. When these proposals were first made
+to me, I was not quite clear as to what I ought to do, and in writing to
+my father and the secretaries, told them that I would take a few days to
+pray about the matter before deciding any course of action. I mentioned
+to my father that I had had this offer from the Society, and told the
+secretaries also of his proffered aid.
+
+Subsequently, while waiting upon GOD in prayer for guidance, it became
+clear to my mind that I could without difficulty decline both offers.
+The secretaries of the Society would not know that I had cast myself
+wholly on GOD for supplies, and my father would conclude that I had
+accepted the other offer. I therefore wrote declining both propositions,
+and felt that without any one having either care or anxiety on my
+account I was simply in the hands of GOD, and that He, who knew my
+heart, if He wished to encourage me to go to China, would bless my
+effort to depend upon Him alone at home.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+FOOTNOTE:
+
+[1] Since the above was written Mr. George Pearse has died.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER V
+
+LIFE IN LONDON
+
+
+I MUST not now attempt to detail the ways in which the LORD was
+pleased--often to my surprise, as well as to my delight--to help me from
+time to time. I soon found that it was not possible to live quite as
+economically in London as in Hull. To lessen expenses I shared a room
+with a cousin, four miles from the hospital, providing myself with
+board; and after various experiments I found that the most economical
+way was to live almost exclusively on brown bread and water. Thus I was
+able to make the means that GOD gave me last as long as possible. Some
+of my expenses I could not diminish, but my board was largely within my
+own control. A large twopenny loaf of brown bread, purchased daily on my
+long walk from the hospital, furnished me with supper and breakfast; and
+on that diet, with a few apples for lunch, I managed to walk eight or
+nine miles a day, besides being a good deal on foot while attending the
+practice of the hospital and the medical school.
+
+One incident that occurred just about this time I must refer to. The
+husband of my former landlady in Hull was chief officer of a ship that
+sailed from London, and by receiving his half-pay monthly and remitting
+it to her I was able to save her the cost of a commission. This I had
+been doing for several months, when she wrote requesting that I would
+obtain the next payment as early as possible, as her rent was almost
+due, and she depended upon that sum to meet it. The request came at an
+inconvenient time. I was working hard for an examination in the hope of
+obtaining a scholarship which would be of service to me, and felt that I
+could ill afford the time to go during the busiest part of the day to
+the city and procure the money. I had, however, sufficient of my own in
+hand to enable me to send the required sum. I made the remittance
+therefore, purposing, as soon as the examination was over, to go and
+draw the regular allowance with which to refund myself.
+
+Before the time of examination the medical school was closed for a day,
+on account of the funeral of the Duke of Wellington, and I had an
+opportunity of going at once to the office, which was situated in a
+street on Cheapside, and applying for the due amount. To my surprise and
+dismay the cleric told me that he could not pay it, as the officer in
+question had run away from his ship and gone to the gold diggings.
+"Well," I remarked, "that is very inconvenient for me, as I have already
+advanced the money, and I know his wife will have no means of repaying
+it." The clerk said he was sorry, but could of course only act according
+to orders; so there was no help for me in that direction. A little more
+time and thought, however, brought the comforting conclusion to my mind,
+that as I was depending on the LORD for everything, and His means were
+not limited, it was a small matter to be brought a little sooner or
+later into the position of needing fresh supplies from Him; and so the
+joy and the peace were not long interfered with.
+
+Very soon after this, possibly the same evening, while sewing together
+some sheets of paper on which to take notes of the lectures, I
+accidentally pricked the first finger of my right hand, and in a few
+moments forgot all about it. The next day at the hospital I continued
+dissecting as before. The body was that of a person who had died of
+fever, and was more than usually disagreeable and dangerous. I need
+scarcely say that those of us who were at work upon it dissected with
+special care, knowing that the slightest scratch might cost us our
+lives. Before the morning was far advanced I began to feel very weary,
+and while going through the surgical wards at noon was obliged to run
+out, being suddenly very sick--a most unusual circumstance with me, as I
+took but little food and nothing that could disagree with me. After
+feeling faint for some time, a draught of cold water revived me, and I
+was able to rejoin the students. I became more and more unwell, however,
+and ere the afternoon lecture on surgery was over found it impossible to
+hold the pencil and continue taking notes. By the time the next lecture
+was through, my whole arm and right side were full of severe pain, and I
+was both looking and feeling very ill.
+
+Finding that I could not resume work, I went into the dissecting-room to
+bind up the portion I was engaged upon and put away my apparatus, and
+said to the demonstrator, who was a very skilful surgeon, "I cannot
+think what has come over me," describing the symptoms. "Why," said he,
+"what has happened is clear enough: you must have cut yourself in
+dissecting, and you know that this is a case of malignant fever." I
+assured him that I had been most careful, and was quite certain that I
+had no cut or scratch. "Well," he replied, "you certainly must have had
+one;" and he very closely scrutinised my hand to find it, but in vain.
+All at once it occurred to me that I had pricked my finger the night
+before, and I asked him if it were possible that a prick from a needle,
+at that time, could have been still unclosed. His opinion was that this
+was probably the cause of the trouble, and he advised me to get a
+hansom, drive home as fast as I could, and arrange my affairs forthwith.
+"For," he said, "you are a dead man."
+
+My first thought was one of sorrow that I could not go to China; but
+very soon came the feeling, "Unless I am greatly mistaken, I have work
+to do in China, and shall not die." I was glad, however, to take the
+opportunity of speaking to my medical friend, who was a confirmed
+sceptic as to things spiritual, of the joy that the prospect of perhaps
+soon being with my MASTER gave me; telling him at the same time that I
+did not think I should die, as, unless I were much mistaken, I had work
+to do in China; and if so, however severe the struggle, I must be
+brought through. "That is all very well," he answered, "but you get a
+hansom and drive home as fast as you can. You have no time to lose, for
+you will soon be incapable of winding up your affairs."
+
+I smiled a little at the idea of my driving home in a hansom, for by
+this time my means were too exhausted to allow of such a proceeding, and
+I set out to walk the distance if possible. Before long, however, my
+strength gave way, and I felt it was no use to attempt to reach home by
+walking. Availing myself of an omnibus from Whitechapel Church to
+Farringdon Street, and another from Farringdon Street onwards, I
+reached, in great suffering, the neighbourhood of Soho Square, behind
+which I lived. On going into the house I got some hot water from the
+servant, and charging her very earnestly--literally as a dying man--to
+accept eternal life as the gift of GOD through JESUS CHRIST, I bathed my
+head and lanced the finger, hoping to let out some of the poisoned
+blood. The pain was very severe; I fainted away, and was for some time
+unconscious, so long that when I came to myself I found that I had been
+carried to bed.
+
+An uncle of mine who lived near at hand had come in, and sent for his
+own medical man, an assistant surgeon at the Westminster Hospital. I
+assured my uncle that medical help would be of no service to me, and
+that I did not wish to go to the expense involved. He, however, quieted
+me on this score, saying that he had sent for his own doctor, and that
+the bill would be charged to himself. When the surgeon came and learned
+all the particulars, he said, "Well, if you have been living moderately,
+you may pull through; but if you have been going in for beer and that
+sort of thing, there is no manner of chance for you." I thought that if
+sober living was to do anything, few could have a better chance, as
+little but bread and water had been my diet for a good while past. I
+told him I had lived abstemiously, and found that it helped me in study.
+"But now," he said, "you must keep up your strength, for it will be a
+pretty hard struggle." And he ordered me a bottle of port wine every
+day, and as many chops as I could consume. Again I smiled inwardly,
+having no means for the purchase of such luxuries. This difficulty,
+however, was also met by my kind uncle, who sent me at once all that was
+needed.
+
+I was much concerned, notwithstanding the agony I suffered, that my dear
+parents should not be made acquainted with my state. Thought and prayer
+had satisfied me that I was not going to die, but that there was indeed
+a work for me to do in China. If my dear parents should come up and find
+me in that condition, I must lose the opportunity of seeing how GOD was
+going to work for me, now that my money had almost come to an end. So,
+after prayer for guidance, I obtained a promise from my uncle and cousin
+not to write to my parents, but to leave me to communicate with them
+myself. I felt it was a very distinct answer to prayer when they gave me
+this promise, and I took care to defer all communication with them
+myself until the crisis was past and the worst of the attack over. At
+home they knew that I was working hard for an examination, and did not
+wonder at my silence.
+
+Days and nights of suffering passed slowly by; but at length, after
+several weeks, I was sufficiently restored to leave my room; and then I
+learned that two men, though not from the London Hospital, who had had
+dissection wounds at the same time as myself, had both succumbed, while
+I was spared in answer to prayer to work for GOD in China.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VI
+
+STRENGTHENED BY FAITH
+
+
+ONE day the doctor coming in found me on the sofa, and was surprised to
+learn that with assistance I had walked downstairs. "Now," he said, "the
+best thing you can go is to get off to the country as soon as you feel
+equal to the journey. You must rusticate until you have recovered a fair
+amount of health and strength, for if you begin your work too soon the
+consequences may still be serious." When he had left, as I lay very
+exhausted on the sofa, I just told the LORD all about it, and that I was
+refraining from making my circumstances known to those who would delight
+to meet my need, in order that my faith might be strengthened by
+receiving help from Himself in answer to prayer alone. What was I to do?
+And I waited for His answer.
+
+It seemed to me as if He were directing my mind to the conclusion to go
+again to the shipping office, and inquire about the wages I had been
+unable to draw. I reminded the LORD that I could not afford to take a
+conveyance, and that it did not seem at all likely that I should succeed
+in getting the money, and asked whether this impulse was not a mere
+clutching at a straw, some mental process of my own, rather than His
+guidance and teaching. After prayer, however, and renewed waiting upon
+GOD, I was confirmed in my belief that He Himself was teaching me to go
+to the office.
+
+The next question was, "How am I to go?" I had had to seek help in
+coming downstairs, and the place was at least two miles away. The
+assurance was brought vividly home to me that whatever I asked of GOD in
+the name of CHRIST would be done, that the FATHER might be glorified in
+the SON; that what I had to do was to seek strength for the long walk,
+to receive it by faith, and to set out upon it. Unhesitatingly I told
+the LORD that I was quite willing to take the walk if He would give me
+the strength. I asked in the name of CHRIST that the strength might be
+immediately given; and sending the servant up to my room for my hat and
+stick, I set out, not to _attempt_ to walk, but TO WALK to Cheapside.
+
+Although undoubtedly strengthened by faith, I never took so much
+interest in shop windows as I did upon that journey. At every second or
+third step I was glad to lean a little against the plate glass, and take
+time to examine the contents of the windows before passing on. It needed
+a special effort of faith when I got to the bottom of Farringdon Street
+to attempt the toilsome ascent of Snow Hill: there was no Holborn
+Viaduct in those days, and it had to be done. GOD did wonderfully help
+me, and in due time I reached Cheapside, turned into the by-street in
+which the office was found, and sat down much exhausted on the steps
+leading to the first floor, which was my destination. I felt my position
+to be a little peculiar--sitting there on the steps, so evidently
+spent--and the gentlemen who rushed up and downstairs looked at me with
+an inquiring gaze. After a little rest, however, and a further season of
+prayer, I succeeded in climbing the staircase, and to my comfort found
+in the office the clerk with whom I had hitherto dealt in the matter.
+Seeing me looking pale and exhausted, he kindly inquired as to my
+health, and I told him that I had had a serious illness, and was ordered
+to the country, but thought it well to call first, and make further
+inquiry, lest there should have been any mistake about the mate having
+run off to the gold diggings. "Oh," he said, "I am so glad you have
+come, for it turns out that it was an able seaman of the same name that
+ran away. The mate is still on board; the ship has just reached
+Gravesend, and will be up very soon. I shall be glad to give you the
+half-pay up to date, for doubtless it will reach his wife more safely
+through you. We all know what temptations beset the men when they arrive
+at home after a voyage."
+
+Before, however, giving me the sum of money, he insisted upon my coming
+inside and sharing his lunch. I felt it was the LORD indeed who was
+providing for me, and accepted his offer with thankfulness. When I was
+refreshed and rested, he gave me a sheet of paper to write a few lines
+to the wife, telling her of the circumstances. On my way back I procured
+in Cheapside a money order for the balance due to her, and posted it;
+and returning home again, felt myself now quite justified in taking an
+omnibus as far as it would serve me.
+
+Very much better the next morning, after seeing to some little matters
+that I had to settle, I made my way to the surgery of the doctor who had
+attended me, feeling that, although my uncle was prepared to pay the
+bill, it was right for me, now that I had some money in hand, to ask for
+the account myself. The kind surgeon refused to allow me, as a medical
+student, to pay anything for his attendance: but he had supplied me with
+quinine, which he allowed me to pay for to the extent of eight
+shillings. When that was settled, I saw that the sum left was just
+sufficient to take me home; and to my mind the whole thing seemed a
+wonderful interposition of GOD on my behalf.
+
+I knew that the surgeon was sceptical, and told him that I should very
+much like to speak to him freely, if I might do so without offence; that
+I felt that under GOD I owed my life to his kind care, and wished very
+earnestly that he himself might become a partaker of the same precious
+faith that I possessed. So I told him my reason for being in London, and
+about my circumstances, and why I had declined the help of both my
+father and the officers of the Society in connection with which it was
+probable that I should go to China. I told him of the recent
+providential dealings of GOD with me, and how apparently hopeless my
+position had been the day before, when he had ordered me to go to the
+country, unless I would reveal my need, which I had determined not to
+do. I described to him the mental exercises I had gone through; but when
+I added that I had actually got up from the sofa and walked to
+Cheapside, he looked at me incredulously, and "Impossible! Why, I left
+you lying there more like a ghost than a man." And I had to assure him
+again and again that, strengthened by faith, the walk had really been
+taken. I told him also what money was left to me, and what payments
+there had been to make, and showed him that just sufficient remained to
+take me home to Yorkshire, providing for needful refreshment by the way
+and the omnibus journey at the end.
+
+My kind friend was completely broken down, and said with tears in his
+eyes, "I would give all the world for a faith like yours." I, on the
+other hand, had the joy of telling him that it was to be obtained
+without money and without price. We never met again. When I came back to
+town, restored to health and strength, I found that he had had a
+stroke, and left for the country; and I subsequently learned that he
+never rallied. I was able to gain no information as to his state of mind
+when taken away; but I have always felt very thankful that I had the
+opportunity, and embraced it, of bearing that testimony for GOD. I
+cannot but entertain the hope that the MASTER Himself was speaking to
+him through His dealings with me, and that I shall meet him again in the
+Better Land. It would be no small joy to be welcomed by him, when my own
+service is over.
+
+The next day found me in my dear parents' home. My joy in the LORD's
+help and deliverance was so great that I was unable to keep it to
+myself, and before my return to London my dear mother knew the secret of
+my life for some time past. I need scarcely say that when I went up
+again to town I was not allowed to live--as, indeed, I was not fit to
+live--on the same economical lines as before my illness. I needed more
+now, and the LORD did provide.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VII
+
+MIGHTY TO SAVE
+
+
+RETURNING to London when sufficiently recovered to resume my studies,
+the busy life of hospital and lecture-hall was resumed; often relieved
+by happy Sundays of fellowship with Christian friends, especially in
+London or Tottenham. Opportunities for service are to be found in every
+sphere, and mine was no exception. I shall only mention one case now
+that gave me great encouragement in seeking conversion even when it
+seemed apparently hopeless.
+
+GOD had given me the joy of winning souls before, but not in
+surroundings of such special difficulty. With GOD all things are
+possible, and no conversion ever takes place save by the almighty power
+of the HOLY GHOST. The great need, therefore, of every Christian worker
+is to _know_ GOD. Indeed, this is the purpose for which He has given us
+eternal life, as our SAVIOUR Himself says, in the oft misquoted verse,
+John xvii. 3: "This is [the object of] life eternal, [not _to_ know but]
+that they _might_ know Thee the only true GOD, and JESUS CHRIST, whom
+Thou hast sent." I was now to prove the willingness of GOD to answer
+prayer for spiritual blessing under most unpromising circumstances, and
+thus to gain an increased acquaintance with the prayer-answering GOD as
+One "mighty to save."
+
+A short time before leaving for China, it became my duty daily to dress
+the foot of a patient suffering from senile gangrene. The disease
+commenced, as usual, insidiously, and the patient had little idea that
+he was a doomed man, and probably had not long to live. I was not the
+first to attend to him, but when the case was transferred to me, I
+naturally became very anxious about his soul. The family with whom he
+lived were Christians, and from them I learned that he was an avowed
+atheist, and very antagonistic to anything religious. They had, without
+asking his consent, invited a Scripture reader to visit him, but in
+great passion he had ordered him from the room. The vicar of the
+district had also called, hoping to help him; but he had spit in his
+face, and refused to allow him to speak to him. His passionate temper
+was described to me as very violent, and altogether the case seemed to
+be as hopeless as could well be imagined.
+
+Upon first commencing to attend him I prayed much about it; but for two
+or three days said nothing to him of a religious nature. By special care
+in dressing his diseased limb I was able considerably to lessen his
+sufferings, and he soon began to manifest grateful appreciation of my
+services. One day, with a trembling heart, I took advantage of his warm
+acknowledgments to tell him what was the spring of my action, and to
+speak of his own solemn position and need of GOD's mercy through CHRIST.
+It was evidently only by a powerful effort of self-restraint that he
+kept his lips closed. He turned over in bed with his back to me, and
+uttered no word.
+
+I could not get the poor man out of my mind, and very often through each
+day I pleaded with GOD, by His SPIRIT, to save him ere He took him
+hence. After dressing the wound and relieving his pain, I never failed
+to say a few words to him, which I hoped the LORD would bless. He
+always turned his back to me, looking annoyed, but never spoke a word in
+reply.
+
+After continuing this for some time, my heart sank. It seemed to me that
+I was not only doing no good, but perhaps really hardening him and
+increasing his guilt. One day, after dressing his limb and washing my
+hands, instead of returning to the bedside to speak to him, I went to
+the door, and stood hesitating for a few moments with the thought in my
+mind, "Ephraim is joined to his idols; let him alone." I looked at the
+man and saw his surprise, as it was the first time since speaking to him
+that I had attempted to leave without going up to his bedside to say a
+few words for my MASTER. I could bear it no longer. Bursting into tears,
+I crossed the room and said, "My friend, whether you will hear or
+whether you will forbear, I _must_ deliver _my_ soul," and went on to
+speak very earnestly to him, telling him with many tears how much I
+wished that he would let me pray with him. To my unspeakable joy he did
+not turn away, but replied, "If it will be a relief to you, do." I need
+scarcely say that I fell on my knees and poured out my whole soul to GOD
+on his behalf. I believe the LORD then and there wrought a change in his
+soul.
+
+He was never afterwards unwilling to be spoken to and prayed with, and
+within a few days he definitely accepted CHRIST as his SAVIOUR. Oh the
+joy it was to me to see that dear man rejoicing in hope of the glory of
+GOD! He told me that for forty years he had never darkened the door of
+church or chapel, and that then--forty years ago--he had only entered a
+place of worship to be married, and could not be persuaded to go inside
+when his wife was buried. Now, thank GOD, his sin-stained soul, I had
+every reason to believe, was washed, was sanctified, was justified, in
+the Name of the LORD JESUS CHRIST and in the SPIRIT of our GOD.
+Oftentimes, when in my early work in China circumstances rendered me
+almost hopeless of success, I have thought of this man's conversion, and
+have been encouraged to persevere in speaking the Word, whether men
+would hear or whether they would forbear.
+
+The now happy sufferer lived for some time after this change, and was
+never tired of bearing testimony to the grace of GOD. Though his
+condition was most distressing, the alteration in his character and
+behaviour made the previously painful duty of attending him one of real
+pleasure. I have often thought since, in connection with this case and
+the work of GOD generally, of the words, "He that goeth forth _weeping_,
+bearing precious seed, shall doubtless come again rejoicing, bringing
+his sheaves with him." Perhaps if there were more of that intense
+distress for souls that leads to tears, we should more frequently see
+the results we desire. Sometimes it may be that while we are complaining
+of the hardness of the hearts of those we are seeking to benefit, the
+hardness of our own hearts, and our own feeble apprehension of the
+solemn reality of eternal things, may be the true cause of our want of
+success.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VIII
+
+VOYAGE TO CHINA
+
+
+SOON after this the time so long looked forward to arrived--the time
+that I was to leave England for China. After being set apart with many
+prayers for the ministry of GOD's Word among the heathen Chinese I left
+London for Liverpool; and on the 19th of September 1853 a little service
+was held in the stern cabin of the _Dumfries_, which had been secured
+for me by the Committee of the Chinese Evangelisation Society, under
+whose auspices I was going to China.
+
+My beloved, now sainted, mother had come to see me off from Liverpool.
+Never shall I forget that day, nor how she went with me into the little
+cabin that was to be my home for nearly six long months. With a mother's
+loving hand she smoothed the little bed. She sat by my side, and joined
+me in the last hymn that we should sing together before the long
+parting. We knelt down, and she prayed--the last mother's prayer I was
+to hear before starting for China. Then notice was given that we must
+separate, and we had to say good-bye, never expecting to meet on earth
+again.
+
+For my sake she restrained her feelings as much as possible. We parted;
+and she went on shore, giving me her blessing; I stood alone on deck,
+and she followed the ship as we moved towards the dock gates. As we
+passed through the gates, and the separation really commenced, I shall
+never forget the cry of anguish wrung from that mother's heart. It went
+through me like a knife. I never knew so fully, until then, what GOD
+_so_ loved the world meant. And I am quite sure that my precious mother
+learned more of the love of GOD to the perishing in that hour than in
+all her life before.
+
+Oh, how it must grieve the heart of GOD when He sees His children
+indifferent to the needs of that wide world for which His beloved, His
+only begotten SON died!
+
+ Hearken, O daughter, and consider, and incline thine ear;
+ Forget also thine own people, and thy father's house;
+ So shall the KING desire thy beauty:
+ For He is thy LORD; and worship thou Him.
+
+Praise GOD, the number is increasing who are finding out the exceeding
+joys, the wondrous revelations of His mercies, vouchsafed to those who
+follow Him, and emptying themselves, leave all in obedience to His great
+commission.
+
+It was on 19th September 1853 that the _Dumfries_ sailed for China; and
+not until 1st March, in the spring of the following year, did I arrive
+in Shanghai.
+
+Our voyage had a rough beginning, but many had promised to remember us
+in constant prayer. No small comfort was this; for we had scarcely left
+the Mersey when a violent equinoctial gale caught us, and for twelve
+days we were beating backwards and forwards in the Irish Channel, unable
+to get out to sea. The gale steadily increased, and after almost a week
+we lay to for a time; but drifting on a lee coast, we were compelled
+again to make sail, and endeavoured to beat on to windward. The utmost
+efforts of the captain and crew, however, were unavailing; and Sunday
+night, 25th September, found us drifting into Carnarvon Bay, each tack
+becoming shorter, until at last we were within a stone's-throw of the
+rocks. About this time, as the ship, which had refused to stay, was put
+round in the other direction, the Christian captain said to me, "We
+cannot live half an hour now: what of your call to labour for the LORD
+in China?" I had previously passed through a time of much conflict, but
+that was over, and it was a great joy to feel and to tell him that I
+would not for any consideration be in any other position; that I
+strongly expected to reach China; but that, if otherwise, at any rate
+the Master would say it was well that I was found seeking to obey His
+command.
+
+Within a few minutes after wearing ship the captain walked, up to the
+compass, and said to me, "The wind has freed two points; we shall be
+able to beat out of the bay." And so we did. The bowsprit was sprung and
+the vessel seriously strained; but in a few days we got out to sea, and
+the necessary repairs were so thoroughly effected on board that our
+journey to China was in due time satisfactorily accomplished.
+
+One thing was a great trouble to me that night. I was a very young
+believer, and had not sufficient faith in GOD to see Him in and through
+the use of means. I had felt it a duty to comply with the earnest wish
+of my beloved and honoured mother, and for her sake to procure a
+swimming-belt. But in my own soul I felt as if I could not simply trust
+in GOD while I had this swimming-belt; and my heart had no rest until on
+that night, after all hope of being saved was gone, I had given it away.
+Then I had perfect peace; and, strange to say, put several light things
+together, likely to float at the time we struck, without any thought of
+inconsistency or scruple. Ever since, I have seen clearly the mistake I
+made--a mistake that is very common in these days, when erroneous
+teaching on faith-healing does much harm, misleading some as to the
+purposes of GOD, shaking the faith of others, and distressing the minds
+of many. The use of means ought not to lessen our faith in GOD; and our
+faith in GOD ought not to hinder our using whatever means He has given
+us for the accomplishment of His own purposes.
+
+For years after this I always took a swimming-belt with me, and never
+had any trouble about it; for after the storm was over, the question was
+settled for me, through the prayerful study of the Scriptures. GOD gave
+me then to see my mistake, probably to deliver me from a great deal of
+trouble on similar questions now so constantly raised. When in medical
+or surgical charge of any case, I have never thought of neglecting to
+ask GOD's guidance and blessing in the use of appropriate means, nor yet
+of omitting to give Him thanks for answered prayer and restored health.
+But to me it would appear as presumptuous and wrong to neglect the use
+of those measures which He Himself has put within our reach, as to
+neglect to take daily food, and suppose that life and health might be
+maintained by prayer alone.
+
+The voyage was a very tedious one. We lost a good deal of time on the
+equator from calms; and when we finally reached the Eastern Archipelago,
+were again detained from the same cause. Usually a breeze would spring
+up soon after sunset, and last until about dawn. The utmost use was made
+of it, but during the day we lay still with flapping sails, often
+drifting back and losing a good deal of the advantage we had gained
+during the night.
+
+This happened notably on one occasion, when we were in dangerous
+proximity to the north of New Guinea. Saturday night had brought us to a
+point some thirty miles off the land; but during the Sunday morning
+service, which was held on deck, I could not fail to notice that the
+captain looked troubled, and frequently went over to the side of the
+ship. When the service was ended, I learnt from him the cause--a
+four-knot current was carrying us rapidly towards some sunken reefs, and
+we were already so near that it seemed improbable that we should get
+through the afternoon in safety. After dinner the long-boat was put out,
+and all hands endeavoured, without success, to turn the ship's head from
+the shore. As we drifted nearer we could plainly see the natives rushing
+about the sands and lighting fires every here and there. The captain's
+horn-book informed him that these people were cannibals, so that our
+position was not a little alarming.
+
+After standing together on the deck for some time in silence, the
+captain said to me, "Well, we have done everything that can be done; we
+can only await the result." A thought occurred to me, and I replied,
+"No, there is one thing we have not done yet." "What is it?" he queried.
+"Four of us on board are Christians," I answered (the Swedish carpenter
+and our coloured steward, with the captain and myself); "let us each
+retire to his own cabin, and in agreed prayer ask the LORD to give us
+immediately a breeze. He can as easily send it now as at sunset."
+
+The captain complied with this proposal. I went and spoke to the other
+two men, and after prayer with the carpenter we all four retired to wait
+upon GOD. I had a good but very brief season in prayer, and then felt so
+satisfied that our request was granted that I could not continue asking,
+and very soon went up again on deck. The first officer, a godless man,
+was in charge. I went over and asked him to let down the clews or
+corners of the mainsail, which had been drawn up in order to lessen the
+useless flapping of the sail against the rigging. He answered, "What
+would be the good of that?" I told him we had been asking a wind from
+GOD, that it was coming immediately, and we were so near the reef by
+this time that there was not a minute to lose. With a look of
+incredulity and contempt, he said with an oath that he would rather see
+a wind than hear of it! But while he was speaking I watched his eye, and
+followed it up to the royal (the topmost sail), and there, sure enough,
+the corner of the sail was beginning to tremble in the coming breeze.
+"Don't you see the wind is coming? Look at the royal!" I exclaimed. "No,
+it is only a cat's-paw," he rejoined (a mere puff of wind). "Cat's-paw
+or not," I cried, "pray let down the mainsail, and let us have the
+benefit!"
+
+This he was not slow to do. In another minute the heavy tread of the men
+on the deck brought up the captain from his cabin to see what was the
+matter; and he saw that the breeze had indeed come. In a few minutes we
+were ploughing our way at six or seven knots an hour through the water,
+and the multitude of naked savages whom we had seen on the beach had no
+wreckage that night. We were soon out of danger; and though the wind was
+sometimes unsteady, we did not altogether lose it until after passing
+the Pelew Islands.
+
+Thus GOD encouraged me, ere landing on China's shores, to bring every
+variety of need to Him in prayer, and _to expect that He would honour
+the Name_ of the LORD JESUS, and give the help which each emergency
+required.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IX
+
+EARLY MISSIONARY EXPERIENCES
+
+
+ON landing in Shanghai on 1st March 1854, I found myself surrounded with
+difficulties that were wholly unexpected. A band of rebels, known as the
+"Red Turbans," had taken possession of the native city, against which
+was encamped an Imperial army of from forty to fifty thousand men, who
+were a much greater source of discomfort and danger to the little
+European community than were the rebels themselves. Upon landing, I was
+told that to live outside the Settlement was impossible, while within
+the foreign concession apartments were scarcely obtainable at any price.
+The dollar, now worth about three shillings, had risen to a value of
+eight-and-ninepence, and the prospect for one with only a small income
+of English money was dark indeed. However, I had three letters of
+introduction, and counted on counsel and help, especially from one of
+those to whom I had been commended, whose friends I well knew and highly
+valued. Of course I sought him out at once, but only to learn that he
+had been buried a month or two before, having died from fever during the
+time of my voyage.
+
+Saddened by these tidings, I inquired for a missionary to whom another
+of my letters of introduction was addressed; but a further
+disappointment awaited me--he had left for America. The third letter
+remained; but as it had been given by a comparative stranger, I had
+expected less from it than from the other two. It proved, however, to be
+GOD's channel of help. The Rev. Dr. Medhurst, of the London Mission, to
+whom it was addressed, introduced me to Dr. Lockhart, who kindly allowed
+me to live with him for six months. Dr. Medhurst procured my first
+Chinese teacher; and he, Dr. Edkins, and the late Mr. Alexander Wylie
+gave me considerable help with the language.
+
+Those were indeed troublous times, and times of danger. Coming out of
+the city one day with Mr. Wylie, he entered into conversation with two
+coolies, while we waited a little while at the East Gate for a companion
+who was behind us. Before our companion came up an attack upon the city
+from the batteries on the opposite side of the river commenced, which
+caused us to hurry away to a place of less danger, the whiz of the balls
+being unpleasantly near. The coolies, unfortunately, stayed too long,
+and were wounded. On reaching the Settlement we stopped a few minutes to
+make a purchase, and then proceeded at once to the London Mission
+compound, where, at the door of the hospital, we found the two poor
+coolies with whom Mr. Wylie had conversed, their four ankles terribly
+shattered by a cannon ball. The poor fellows declined amputation, and
+both died. We felt how narrow had been our escape.
+
+At another time, early in the morning, I had joined one of the
+missionaries on his verandah to watch the battle proceeding, at a
+distance of perhaps three-quarters of a mile, when suddenly a spent ball
+passed between us and buried itself in the verandah wall. Another day my
+friend Mr. Wylie left a book on the table after luncheon, and returning
+for it about five minutes later, found the arm of the chair on which he
+had been sitting shot clean away. But in the midst of these and many
+other dangers GOD protected us.
+
+After six months' stay with Dr. Lockhart, I rented a native house
+outside the Settlement, and commenced a little missionary work amongst
+my Chinese neighbours, which for a few months continued practicable.
+When the French joined the Imperialists in attacking the city, the
+position of my house became so dangerous that during the last few weeks,
+in consequence of nightly recurring skirmishes, I gave up attempting to
+sleep except in the daytime. One night a fire appeared very near, and I
+climbed up to a little observatory I had arranged on the roof of the
+house, to see whether it was necessary to attempt escape. While there a
+ball struck the ridge of the roof on the opposite side of the
+quadrangle, showering pieces of broken tile all around me, while the
+ball itself rolled down into the court below. It weighed four or five
+pounds; and had it come a few inches higher, would probably have spent
+its force on me instead of on the building. My dear mother kept the ball
+for many years. Shortly after this I had to abandon the house and return
+to the Foreign Settlement--a step that was taken none too soon, for
+before the last of my belongings were removed, the house was burnt to
+the ground.
+
+Of the trials of this early period it is scarcely possible to convey any
+adequate idea. To one of a sensitive nature, the horrors, atrocities,
+and misery connected with war were a terrible ordeal. The embarrassment
+also of the times was considerable. With an income of only eighty pounds
+a year, I was compelled, upon moving into the Settlement, to give one
+hundred and twenty for rent, and sublet half the house; and though the
+Committee of the Chinese Evangelisation Society increased my income
+when, after the arrival of Dr. Parker, they learned more of our
+circumstances, many painful experiences had necessarily been passed
+through. Few can realise how distressing to so young and untried a
+worker these difficulties seemed, or the intense loneliness of the
+position of a pioneer who could not even hint at many of his
+circumstances, as to do so would have been a tacit appeal for help.
+
+The great enemy is always ready with his oft-repeated suggestion, "All
+these things are against me." But oh, how false the word! The cold, and
+even the hunger, the watchings and sleeplessness of nights of danger,
+and the feeling at times of utter isolation and helplessness, were well
+and wisely chosen, and tenderly and lovingly meted out. What
+circumstances could have rendered the Word of GOD more sweet, the
+presence of GOD more real, the help of GOD more precious? They were
+times, indeed, of emptying and humbling, but were experiences that made
+not ashamed, and that strengthened purpose to go forward as GOD might
+direct, with His _proved_ promise, "I will not fail thee, nor forsake
+thee." One can see, even now, that as for GOD, His way is perfect, and
+yet can rejoice that the missionary path of to-day is comparatively a
+smooth and an easy one.
+
+Journeying inland was contrary to treaty arrangements, and attended with
+much difficulty, especially for some time after the battle of Muddy
+Flat, in which an Anglo-American contingent of about three hundred
+marines and seamen, with a volunteer corps of less than a hundred
+residents, attacked the Imperial camp, and drove away from thirty to
+fifty thousand Chinese soldiers, the range of our shot and shell making
+the native artillery useless. Still, in the autumn of 1854 a journey of
+perhaps a week's duration was safely accomplished with Dr. Edkins, who
+of course did the speaking and preaching, while I was able to help in
+the distribution of books.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER X
+
+FIRST EVANGELISTIC EFFORTS
+
+
+A JOURNEY taken in the spring of 1855 with the Rev. J. S. Burden of the
+Church Missionary Society (now the Bishop of Victoria, Hong-kong) was
+attended with some serious dangers.
+
+In the great mouth of the river Yang-tse, distant some thirty miles to
+the north of Shanghai, lies the group of islands of which Ts'ung-ming
+and Hai-men are the largest and most important; and farther up the
+river, where the estuary narrows away from the sea, is situated the
+influential city of T'ung-chau, close to Lang-shan, or the Wolf
+Mountains, famous as a resort for pilgrim devotees. We spent some time
+in evangelising on those islands, and then proceeded to Lang-shan, where
+we preached and gave books to thousands of the devotees who were
+attending an idolatrous festival. From thence we went on to T'ung-chau,
+and of our painful experiences there the following journal will tell:--
+
+
+ _Thursday, April 26th, 1855._
+
+After breakfast we commended ourselves to the care of our Heavenly
+FATHER, and sought His Blessing before proceeding to this great city.
+The day was dull and wet. We felt persuaded that Satan would not allow
+us to assail his kingdom, as we were attempting to do, without raising
+serious opposition; but we were also fully assured that it was the will
+of GOD that we should preach CHRIST in this city, and distribute the
+Word of Truth among its people. We were sorry that we had but few books
+left for such an important place: the result, however, proved that this
+also was providential.
+
+Our native teachers did their best to persuade us not to go into the
+city; but we determined that, by GOD'S help, nothing should hinder us.
+We directed them, however, to remain in one of the boats; and if we did
+not return, to learn whatever they could respecting our fate, and make
+all possible haste to Shanghai with the information. We also arranged
+that the other boat should wait for us, even if we could not get back
+that night, so that we might not be detained for want of a boat in case
+of returning later. We then put our books into two bags, and with a
+servant who always accompanied us on these occasions, set off for the
+city, distant about seven miles. Walking was out of the question, from
+the state of the roads, so we availed ourselves of wheel-barrows, the
+only conveyance to be had in these parts. A wheel-barrow is cheaper than
+a sedan, only requiring one coolie; but is by no means an agreeable
+conveyance on rough, dirty roads.
+
+We had not gone far before the servant requested permission to go back,
+as he was thoroughly frightened by reports concerning the native
+soldiery. Of course we at once consented, not wishing to involve another
+in trouble, and determined to carry the books ourselves, and look for
+physical as well as spiritual strength to Him who had promised to supply
+all our need.
+
+At this point a respectable man came up, and earnestly warned us against
+proceeding, saying that if we did we should find to our sorrow what the
+T'ung-chau militia were like. We thanked him for his kindly counsel, but
+could not act upon it, as our hearts were fixed, whether it were to
+bonds, imprisonment, and death, or whether to distribute our Scriptures
+and tracts in safety, and return unhurt, we knew not; but we were
+determined, by the grace of GOD, not to leave T'ung-chau any longer
+without the Gospel, nor its teeming thousands to die in uncared-for
+ignorance of the Way of life.
+
+After this my wheel-barrow man would proceed no farther, and I had to
+seek another, who was fortunately not difficult to find. As we went on,
+the ride in the mud and rain was anything but agreeable, and we could
+not help feeling the danger of our position, although wavering not for a
+moment. At intervals we encouraged one another with promises from the
+Scripture and verses of hymns. That verse--
+
+ "The perils of the sea, the perils of the land,
+ Should not dishearten thee: thy LORD is nigh at hand.
+ But should thy courage fail, when tried and sore oppressed,
+ His promise shall avail, and set thy soul at rest."
+
+seemed particularly appropriate to our circumstances, and was very
+comforting to me.
+
+On our way we passed through one small town of about a thousand
+inhabitants; and here, in the Mandarin dialect, I preached JESUS to a
+good number of people. Never was I so happy in speaking of the love of
+GOD and the atonement of JESUS CHRIST. My own soul was richly blessed,
+and filled with joy and peace; and I was able to speak with unusual
+freedom and ease. And how rejoiced I was when, afterwards, I heard one
+of our hearers repeating to the newcomers, in his own local dialect, the
+truths upon which I had been dwelling! Oh, how thankful I felt to hear a
+Chinaman, of his own accord, telling his fellow-countrymen that GOD
+loved them; that they were sinners, but that JESUS died instead of
+them, and paid the penalty of their guilt. That one moment repaid me for
+all the trials we had passed through; and I felt that if the LORD should
+grant HIS HOLY SPIRIT to change the heart of that man, we had not come
+in vain.
+
+We distributed a few Testaments and tracts, for the people were able to
+read, and we could not leave them without the Gospel. It was well that
+we did so, for when we reached T'ung-chau we found we had quite as many
+left as we had strength to carry.
+
+Nearing the end of our journey, as we approached the western suburb of
+the city, the prayer of the early Christians, when persecution was
+commencing, came to my mind: "And now, LORD, behold their threatenings,
+and grant unto Thy servants that with all boldness they may speak Thy
+Word." In this petition we most heartily united. Before entering the
+suburb we laid our plans, so as to act in concert, and told our
+wheel-barrow men where to await us, that they might not be involved in
+any trouble on our account. Then looking up to our Heavenly FATHER, we
+committed ourselves to His keeping, took our books, and set on for the
+city.
+
+For some distance we walked along the principal street of the suburb
+leading to the West Gate unmolested, and were amused at the unusual
+title of _Heh-kwei-tsi_ (black devils) which was applied to us. We
+wondered about it at the time, but afterwards found that it was our
+clothes, and not our skin, that gave rise to it. As we passed several of
+the soldiers, I remarked to Mr. Burdon that these were the men we had
+heard so much about, and that they seemed willing to receive us quietly
+enough. Long before we reached the gate, however, a tall powerful man,
+made tenfold fiercer by partial intoxication, let us know that all the
+militia were not so peaceably inclined, by seizing Mr. Burdon by the
+shoulders. My companion endeavoured to shake him off. I turned to see
+what was the matter, and at once we were surrounded by a dozen or more
+brutal men, who hurried us on to the city at a fearful pace.
+
+My bag now began to feel very heavy, and I could not change hands to
+relieve myself. I was soon in a profuse perspiration, and was scarcely
+able to keep pace with them. We demanded to be taken before the chief
+magistrate, but were told that they knew where to take us, and what to
+do with such persons as we were, with the most insulting epithets. The
+man who first seized Mr. Burdon soon afterwards left him for me, and
+became my principal tormentor; for I was neither so tall nor so strong
+as my friend, and was therefore less able to resist him. He all but
+knocked me down again and again, seized me by the hair, took hold of my
+collar so as to almost choke me, and grasped my arms and shoulders,
+making them black and blue. Had this treatment continued much longer, I
+must have fainted. All but exhausted, how refreshing was the remembrance
+of a verse quoted by my dear mother in one of my last home letters--
+
+ "We speak of the realms of the blest,
+ That country so bright and so fair,
+ And oft are its glories confessed;
+ But what must it be to be there!"
+
+To be absent from the body! to be present with the LORD! to be free from
+sin! And this is the end of the worst that man's malice can ever bring
+upon us.
+
+As we were walking along Mr. Burdon tried to give away a few books that
+he was carrying, not knowing whether we might have another opportunity
+of doing so; but the fearful rage of the soldier, and the way he
+insisted on manacles being brought, which fortunately were not at hand,
+convinced us that in our present position we could do no good in
+attempting book-distribution. There was nothing to be done but quietly
+to submit, and go along with our captors.
+
+Once or twice a quarrel arose as to how we should be dealt with; the
+more mild of our conductors saying that we ought to be taken to the
+magistrate's office, but others wishing to kill us at once without
+appeal to any authority. Our minds were kept in perfect peace; and when
+thrown together on one of these occasions, we reminded each other that
+the Apostles rejoiced that they were counted _worthy_ to suffer in the
+cause of CHRIST. Having succeeded in getting my hand into my pocket, I
+produced a Chinese card (if the large red paper, bearing one's name, may
+be so called), and after this was treated with more respect. I demanded
+it should be given to the chief official of the place, and that we
+should be led to his office. Before this we had been unable, say what we
+would, to persuade them that we were foreigners, although we were both
+in English attire.
+
+Oh the long weary streets that we were dragged through! I thought they
+would never end; and seldom have I felt more thankful than when we
+stopped at a place where we were told a mandarin resided. Quite
+exhausted, bathed in perspiration, and with my tongue cleaving to the
+roof of my mouth, I leaned against the wall, and saw that Mr. Burdon was
+in much the same condition. I requested them to bring us chairs, but
+they told us to wait; and when I begged them to give us some tea,
+received only the same answer. Round the doorway a large crowd had
+gathered; and Mr. Burdon, collecting his remaining strength, preached
+CHRIST JESUS to them. Our cards and books had been taken in to the
+mandarin, but he proved to be one of low rank, and after keeping us
+waiting for some time he referred us to his superiors in office.
+
+Upon hearing this, and finding that it was their purpose to turn us out
+again into the crowded streets, we positively refused to move a single
+step, and insisted on chairs being brought. After some demur this was
+done; we seated ourselves in them, and were carried on. On the road we
+felt so glad of the rest which the chairs afforded us, and so thankful
+at having been able to preach JESUS in spite of Satan's malice, that our
+joy was depicted on our countenances; and as we passed along we heard
+some say that we did not look like bad men, while others seemed to pity
+us. When we arrived at the magistrate's office, I wondered where we were
+being taken; for though we passed through some great gates that looked
+like those of the city wall, we were still evidently within the city. A
+second pair of gates suggested the idea that it was a prison into which
+we were being carried; but when we came in sight of a large tablet, with
+the inscription "_Ming chi fu mu_" (the father and mother of the
+people), we felt that we had been conveyed to the right place; this
+being the title assumed by the mandarins.
+
+Our cards were again sent in, and after a short delay we were taken into
+the presence of Ch'en Ta Lao-ie (the Great Venerable Father Ch'en), who,
+as it proved, had formerly been Tao-tai of Shanghai, and consequently
+knew the importance of treating foreigners with courtesy. Coming before
+him, some of the people fell on their knees and bowed down to the
+ground, and my conductor motioned for me to do the same, but without
+success. This mandarin, who seemed to be the highest authority of
+T'ung-chau, and wore an opaque blue button on his cap, came out to meet
+us, and treated us with every possible token of respect. He took us to
+an inner apartment, a more private room, but was followed by a large
+number of writers, runners, and other semi-officials. I related the
+object of our visit, and begged permission to give him copies of our
+books and tracts, for which he thanked me. As I handed him a copy of the
+New Testament with part of the Old (from Genesis to Ruth) and some
+tracts, I tried to explain a little about them, and also to give him a
+brief summary of our teachings. . . . He listened very attentively, as of
+course did all the others present. He then ordered some refreshments to
+be brought in, which were very welcome, and himself partook of them with
+us.
+
+After a long stay, we asked permission to see something of the city, and
+to distribute the books we had brought, before our return. To this he
+kindly consented. We then mentioned that we had been most
+disrespectfully treated as we came in, but that we did not attach much
+importance to the fact, being aware that the soldiers knew no better.
+Not desiring, however, to have such an experience repeated, we requested
+him to give orders that we were not to be further molested. This also he
+promised to do, and with every possible token of respect accompanied us
+to the door of his official residence, sending several runners to see
+that we were respectfully treated. We distributed our books well and
+quickly, and left the city quite in state. It was amusing to us to see
+the way in which the runners made use of their tails. When the street
+was blocked by the crowd, they turned them into whips, and laid them
+about the people's shoulders to right and left!
+
+We had a little trouble in finding our wheel-barrows; but eventually
+succeeding, we paid off the chair coolies, mounted our humble vehicles,
+and returned to the river, accompanied for fully half the distance by an
+attendant from the magistrate's office. Early in the evening we got back
+to the boats in safety, sincerely thankful to our Heavenly FATHER for
+His gracious protection and aid.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XI
+
+WITH THE REV. WILLIAM BURNS
+
+
+AFTER the retaking of Shanghai by the Imperialists, in February 1855, I
+was enabled to rent a house within the walls of the native city, and
+gladly availed myself of this opportunity to reside amidst the crowded
+population left to inhabit the ruins that had survived the war. Here I
+made my headquarters, though often absent on more or less prolonged
+itinerations.
+
+At the suggestion of the Rev. Dr. Medhurst, the veteran leader of the
+London Mission, I was led at about this period to adopt the native
+costume in preference to foreign dress, to facilitate travel and
+residence inland. The Chinese had permitted a foreign firm to build a
+silk factory some distance inland, with the proviso that the style of
+building must be purely Chinese, and that there should be nothing
+external to suggest that it was foreign. Much benefit was found to
+result from this change of costume; and I, and most of those associated
+with me, have continued to use native dress.
+
+The T'ai-p'ing rebellion, commenced in 1851, had by this time reached
+the height of its ephemeral success. The great city of Nan-king had
+fallen before the invading host; and there, within two hundred miles of
+Shanghai, the rebels had established their headquarters, and proceeded
+to fortify themselves for further conquests. During the summer of 1855
+various attempts were made to visit the leaders of the movement, in
+order to bring to bear some decidedly Christian influence upon them; but
+so little success was met with, that these efforts were abandoned.
+
+I, amongst others, had sought to reach Nan-king; but finding it
+impossible to do so, turned my attention again to evangelistic work on
+the island of Ts'ung-ming. After some time I was enabled so far to
+overcome the prejudice and fears of the people as to rent a little house
+and settle down in their midst. This was a great joy and encouragement
+to me; but before many weeks were over complaints were made by the local
+authorities to the British Consul, who compelled me to retire; though
+the French Consul had himself secured to the Romish missionaries a
+property within three or four miles of the house I had to vacate. Sorely
+tried and disappointed by this unexpected hindrance, I reluctantly
+returned to Shanghai, little dreaming of the blessing that GOD had in
+store for me there.
+
+A few months previously the Rev. William Burns, of the English
+Presbyterian Mission, had arrived in that port on his return journey
+from home; and before proceeding to his former sphere of service in the
+southern province of FU-KIEN, he had endeavoured, like myself, without
+success, to visit the T'ai-p'ing rebels at Nan-king. Failing in this
+attempt, he made his headquarters in Shanghai for a season, devoting
+himself to the evangelisation of the surrounding populous regions. Thus
+in the autumn of the year I was providentially led into association with
+this beloved and honoured servant of GOD.
+
+We journeyed together, evangelising cities and towns in southern
+KIANG-SU and north CHEH-KIANG, living in our boats, and following the
+course of the canals and rivers which here spread like a network over
+the whole face of the rich and fertile country. Mr. Burns at that time
+was wearing English dress; but saw that while I was the younger and in
+every way less experienced, I had the quiet hearers, while he was
+followed by the rude boys, and by the curious but careless; that I was
+invited to the homes of the people, while he received an apology that
+the crowd that would follow precluded his being invited. After some
+weeks of observation he also adopted the native dress, and enjoyed the
+increased facilities which it gave.
+
+Those happy months were an unspeakable joy and privilege to me. His love
+for the Word was delightful, and his holy, reverential life and constant
+communings with GOD made fellowship with him satisfying to the deep
+cravings of my heart. His accounts of revival work and of persecutions
+in Canada, and Dublin, and in Southern China were most instructive, as
+well as interesting; for with true spiritual insight he often pointed
+out GOD's purposes in trial in a way that made all life assume quite a
+new aspect and value. His views especially about evangelism as the great
+work of the Church, and the order of lay evangelists as a lost order
+that Scripture required to be restored, were seed-thoughts which were to
+prove fruitful in the subsequent organisation of the China Inland
+Mission.
+
+Externally, however, our path was not always a smooth one; but when
+permitted to stay for any length of time in town or city, the
+opportunity was well utilised. We were in the habit of leaving our
+boats, after prayer for blessing, at about nine o'clock in the morning,
+with a light bamboo stool in hand. Selecting a suitable station, one
+would mount the stool and speak for twenty minutes, while the other was
+pleading for blessing; and then changing places, the voice of the first
+speaker had a rest. After an hour or two thus occupied, we would move on
+to another point at some distance from the first, and speak again.
+Usually about midday we returned to our boats for dinner, fellowship,
+and prayer, and then resumed our out-door work until dusk. After tea and
+further rest, we would go with our native helpers to some tea-shop,
+where several hours might be spent in free conversation with the people.
+Not infrequently before leaving a town we had good reason to believe
+that much truth had been grasped; and we placed many Scriptures and
+books in the hands of those interested. The following letter was written
+by Mr. Burns to his mother at home in Scotland about this time:--
+
+
+ "TWENTY-FIVE MILES FROM SHANGHAI,
+ _January 26th, 1856_.
+
+ "Taking advantage of a rainy day which confines me
+ to my boat, I pen a few lines, in addition to a
+ letter to Dundee, containing particulars which I
+ need not repeat. It is now forty-one days since I
+ left Shanghai on this last occasion. A young
+ English missionary, Mr. Taylor, of the Chinese
+ Evangelisation Society, has been my companion
+ during these weeks--he in his boat, and I in
+ mine--and we have experienced much mercy, and on
+ some occasions considerable assistance in our
+ work.
+
+ "I must once more tell the story I have had to
+ tell already more than once--how four weeks ago,
+ on December 29th, I put on the Chinese dress,
+ which I am now wearing. Mr. Taylor had made this
+ change a few months before, and I found that he
+ was, in consequence, so much less incommoded in
+ preaching, etc., by the crowd, that I concluded it
+ was my duty to follow his example. We were at that
+ time more than double the distance from Shanghai
+ that we are now, and would still have been at as
+ great a distance had we not met at one place with
+ a band of lawless people, who demanded money and
+ threatened to break our boats if their demands
+ were refused. The boatmen were very much alarmed,
+ and insisted on returning to some place nearer
+ home. These people had previously broken in,
+ violently, a part of Mr. Taylor's boat, because
+ their unreasonable demand for books was not
+ complied with.
+
+ "We have a large, very large, field of labour in
+ this region, though it might be difficult in the
+ meantime for one to establish himself in any
+ particular place; the people listen with
+ attention, but we need the Power from on High to
+ convince and convert. Is there any spirit of
+ prayer on our behalf among GOD's people in
+ Kilsyth? or is there any effort to seek this
+ spirit? How great the need is, and how great the
+ arguments and motives for prayer in this case. The
+ harvest here is indeed great, and the labourers
+ are few, and imperfectly fitted without much grace
+ for such a work. And yet grace can make the few
+ and feeble instruments the means of accomplishing
+ great things--things greater than we can even
+ conceive."
+
+The incident referred to in this letter, which led to our return to
+Shanghai more speedily than we had at first intended, took place on the
+northern border of CHEH-KIANG. We had reached a busy market town known
+by the name of Wu-chen, or Black Town, the inhabitants of which, we had
+been told, were the wildest and most lawless people in that part of the
+country. Such indeed we found them to be: the town was a refuge for salt
+smugglers and other bad characters. The following extracts are taken
+from my journal, written at the time:--
+
+
+ _January 8th, 1856._
+
+Commenced our work in Wu-chen this morning by distributing a large
+number of tracts and some Testaments. The people seemed much surprised,
+and we could not learn that any foreigner had been here before. We
+preached twice--once in the temple of the God of War, and afterwards in
+an empty space left by a fire, which had completely destroyed many
+houses. In the afternoon we preached again to a large and attentive
+audience on the same site; and in the evening adjourned to a tea-shop,
+where we had a good opportunity of speaking until it got noised abroad
+that we were there, when, too many people coming in, we were obliged to
+leave. Our native assistants, Tsien and Kuei-hua, were able, however, to
+remain. Returning to our boats, we spoke to a number of people standing
+on a bridge, and felt we had abundant reason to be thankful and
+encouraged by the result of our first day's labour.
+
+
+ _January 10th._
+
+First sent Tsien and Kuei-hua to distribute some sheet tracts. After
+their return we went with them, and in a space cleared by fire we
+separated, and addressed two audiences. On our return to the boats for
+lunch, we found people waiting, as usual, and desiring books. Some were
+distributed to those who were able to read them; and then asking them
+kindly to excuse us while we took our midday meal, I went into my boat
+and shut the door.
+
+Hardly was there time to pour out a cup of tea when a battering began,
+and the roof was at once broken in. I went out at the back, and found
+four or five men taking the large lumps of frozen earth turned up in a
+field close by--weighing, I should suppose, from seven to fourteen
+pounds each--and throwing them at the boat. Remonstrance was of no
+avail, and it was not long ere a considerable part of the upper
+structure of the boat was broken to pieces, and a quantity of earth
+covered the things inside. Finally, Tsien got a boat that was passing to
+land him at a short distance, and by a few tracts drew away the
+attention of the men, thus ending the assault.
+
+We now learned that of those who had done the mischief only two were
+natives of the place, the others being salt smugglers, and that the
+cause was our not having satisfied their unreasonable demand for books.
+Most providentially no one was injured; and as soon as quiet was
+somewhat restored, we all met in Mr. Burns's boat and joined in
+thanksgiving that we had been preserved from personal harm, praying also
+for the perpetrators of the mischief, and that it might be over-ruled
+for good to us and to those with us. We then took our lunch and went on
+shore, and but a few steps from the boats addressed a large multitude
+that soon assembled. We were specially assisted; never were we heard
+with more attention, and not one voice was found to sympathise with the
+men who had molested us. In the evening, at the tea-shops, the same
+spirit was manifested, and some seemed to hear with joy the glad tidings
+of salvation through a crucified and risen SAVIOUR.
+
+As we came home we passed a barber's shop still open, and I went in, and
+while getting my head shaved had an opportunity of speaking to a few
+people, and afterwards pasted a couple of sheet tracts on the wall for
+the benefit of future customers.
+
+
+ _January 11th._
+
+A respectable shop-keeper of the name of Yao, who on the first or second
+day of our stay at Wu-chen had received portions of the New Testament
+and a tract, came yesterday, when our boat was broken, to beg for some
+more books. At that time we were all in confusion from the damage done,
+and from the earth thrown into the boat, and so invited him to come
+again in a day or two's time, when we would gladly supply him. This
+morning he appeared and handed in the following note:--
+
+"On a former day I begged Burns and Taylor, the two '_Rabbis_,' to give
+me good books. It happened at that time those of our town whose hearts
+were deceived by _Satan_, not knowing the _Son of David_, went so far as
+to dare to '_raca_' and '_moreh_' and injure your respected boat. I
+thank you for promising afterwards to give the books, and beg the
+following: Complete New Testament, 'Discourse of a Good Man when near
+his Death,' 'Important Christian Doctrines,' an Almanack, 'Principles of
+Christianity,' 'Way to make the World happy,'--of each one copy. Sung
+and Tsien, and all teachers I hope are well. Further compliments are
+unwritten."
+
+This note is interesting, as showing that he had been reading the New
+Testament attentively, as the italicised words were all taken from it.
+His use of "raca" and "moreh" for reviling, shows their meaning was not
+lost upon him.
+
+After supplying this man, we went out with Tsien and Kuei-hua to the
+east of the town, and spoke in the street for a short time. Upon
+returning to the boats, I was visited by two CHIH-LI men, who are in the
+magistrate's office here. I was greatly helped in speaking to them of a
+crucified SAVIOUR in the Mandarin dialect; and though one of them did
+not pay much attention, the other did, and made inquiries that showed
+the interest he was feeling. When they had left, I went on shore and
+spoke to the people collected there, to whom Kuei-hua had been
+preaching. The setting sun afforded a parable, and reminded one of the
+words of JESUS, "The night cometh, when no man can work;" and as I spoke
+of the uncertain duration of this life, and of our ignorance as to the
+time of CHRIST'S return, a degree of deep seriousness prevailed that I
+had never previously witnessed in China. I engaged in prayer, and the
+greatest decorum was observed. I then returned to my boat with a
+Buddhist priest who had been in the audience, and he admitted that
+Buddhism was a system of deceit that could give no hope in death.
+
+
+ _January 12th._
+
+In the afternoon we addressed the people on shore close to our boats,
+also in one of the streets of the city, and in a tea-shop, books being
+distributed on each occasion. In the evening we went as usual to speak
+in the tea-shops, but determined to go to the opposite end of the town,
+in order to afford those who lived there a better opportunity of meeting
+with us. It was a long straggling place, nearly two English miles in
+length. As Mr. Burns and I were accustomed to talk together in Chinese,
+this conclusion was known to those in the boats.
+
+After we had proceeded a short distance we changed our minds, and went
+instead to the usual tea-shop, thinking that persons might have gone
+there expecting to meet us. But this was not the case; and we did not
+find such serious hearers as we had done on previous occasions. On this
+account Mr. Burns proposed leaving earlier than usual, and we did so,
+telling Tsien and Kuei-hua that they might remain a little longer.
+Returning to the boats, we gave away a few books; but, singularly
+enough, were left to go alone, no one accompanying us, as is so
+generally the case. Instead of being a clear night, as it was when we
+started, we found that it had become intensely dark. On our way we met
+the boatman, whose manner seemed very strange, and without giving us any
+explanation he blew out the candle of our lantern; we relighted the
+lantern, telling him not to put it out again, when to our surprise he
+deliberately removed the candle and threw it into the canal. He then
+walked down along a low wall jutting out to the river's edge, and gazed
+into the water.
+
+Not knowing what was the matter with him, I ran forward to hold him,
+fearful lest he were going to drown himself; but to my great relief he
+came quietly back. In answer to our repeated questions he told us not to
+speak, for some bad men were seeking to destroy the boats, and they had
+moved away to avoid them. He then led us to the place where one of them
+was lying. Before long Tsien and Kuei-hua came and got safely on board,
+and soon after we were joined by the teacher Sung, and the boat moved
+away.
+
+The cause of all this disturbance was then explained. A man professing
+to be the constable had come to the boats in our absence, with a written
+demand for ten dollars and a quantity of opium. He stated that there
+were more than fifty country people (salt smugglers) awaiting our reply
+in an adjoining tea-shop; and if we gave them what they wanted, and
+three hundred cash to pay for their tea, we might remain in peace; but
+that if not, they would come at once and destroy our boats. Sung told
+them that we could not comply with their demand; for, not being engaged
+in trade, but only in preaching and book-distribution, we had not an
+atom of opium, and that our money was nearly all expended. The man,
+however, told him plainly that he did not believe him, and Sung had no
+alternative but to seek us out, desiring the man to await our reply. Not
+knowing that we had changed our plans, he sought us in the wrong
+direction, and of course in vain.
+
+In the meanwhile the boatmen had succeeded in moving off. They were very
+much alarmed; and having so recently had proof of what these men would
+do in open daylight, felt no desire to experience what they might
+attempt by night. Moving away, therefore, they had separated, so that if
+one boat should be injured the other might afford us a refuge. It was
+after this that we had providentially met the boatman, and had been
+safely led on board. As Sung repassed the place where we were previously
+moored, he saw between the trees a dozen or more men, and heard them
+inquiring where the boats had gone to; but no one could tell.
+Fortunately they sought in vain.
+
+After a while the two boats joined, and rowed together for some time. It
+was already late, and to travel by night in that part of the country was
+not the way to avoid danger from evil men; so the question arose as to
+what should be done. This we left for the boatmen to decide; they had
+moved off of their own accord, and we felt that whatever we personally
+might desire we could not constrain others to remain in a position of
+danger on our account. We urged them, however, to do quickly whatever
+they intended to do, as the morrow was the LORD'S DAY, when we should
+not wish to travel. We also informed them that wherever we were we must
+fulfil our mission, and preach the Gospel; it therefore made but little
+difference where we might stay, for even if we passed the night
+unperceived, we were sure to be found out on the following morning. The
+men consequently concluded that we might as well return to the place
+from which we had started; to this we fully agreed, and they turned back
+accordingly. But--whether by accident or no we could not tell--they got
+into another stream, and rowed for some time they knew not whither. At
+last, as it was very dark, they moored for the night.
+
+We then called all the boatmen together, with our native assistants, and
+read to them the ninety-first Psalm. It may be imagined how appropriate
+to our position and need and how sweetly consoling was this portion of
+GOD'S Word:--
+
+ "He that dwelleth in the secret place of the MOST HIGH
+ Shall abide under the shadow of the ALMIGHTY.
+ I will say of the LORD, _He_ is my refuge and my fortress:
+ My GOD; in Him will I trust.
+
+ "Surely He shall deliver thee from the snare of the fowler,
+ And from the noisome pestilence.
+
+ He shall cover thee with His feathers, and under His wings
+ shalt thou trust:
+ His truth shall be thy shield and buckler.
+ Thou shalt not be afraid for the terror by night;
+ Nor for the arrow that flieth by day.
+
+ "Because he hath set his love upon Me, therefore will I deliver him.
+ I will set him on high, because he hath known My Name.
+ He shall call upon Me, and I will answer him;
+ I will be with him in trouble;--I will deliver him, and honour him.
+ With long life will I satisfy him,--and show him My salvation."
+
+Committing ourselves in prayer to His care and keeping Who had covered
+us with thick darkness and permitted us to escape from the hand of the
+violent, we retired for the night; which--thanks to the kind protection
+of the WATCHMAN OF ISRAEL, who neither slumbers nor forgets His
+people--we passed in peace and quietness, and were enabled, in some
+measure, to realise the truth of that precious word, "_Thou_ art my
+_Hiding-place_, and my _Shield_."
+
+
+ _Sunday, January 13th._
+
+This morning I was awakened about 4 A.M. by violent pain in the
+knee-joint. I had bruised it the day before, and severe inflammation was
+the result. To my great surprise I heard the rain pouring down in
+torrents, the weather having previously been particularly fine. On
+looking out, we found ourselves so near our former stopping-place, that,
+had nothing happened to prevent it, we should not have felt justified in
+neglecting to go into the town to preach as usual; but the rain was so
+heavy all day that no one could leave the boats. Thus we enjoyed a
+delightful day of rest, such as we had not had for some time; and the
+weather prevented much inquiry being made for us. Had the day been fine
+we should most likely have been discovered, even if we had not left the
+boats. As it was, we were allowed to think in peace, with wonder and
+gratitude, of the gracious dealings of our GOD, who had thus led us
+apart into "a desert place" to rest awhile.
+
+
+ _Monday, January 14th._
+
+A cloudless morning. One of the native assistants went before daybreak
+to get some clothes which had been given out for washing. He came back
+with the tidings that, notwithstanding the drenching rain of yesterday,
+men had been seeking us in all directions. We had been kept, however, in
+peace and safety "under the shadow of the Almighty."
+
+The boatmen were now so thoroughly alarmed that they would stay no
+longer, and moved off at dawn. I was confined to my quarters by
+lameness, and had no alternative but to go with them. In the afternoon
+we reached Ping-wang, on the way to Shanghai.
+
+ "Ill that GOD blesses is our good,
+ And unblest good is ill;
+ And all is right that seems most wrong,
+ If it be His sweet will."
+
+[Illustration]
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XII
+
+CALLED TO SWATOW
+
+
+HAVING to leave the neighbourhood of Black Town thus unexpectedly was a
+real disappointment to us, as we had hoped to spend some time
+evangelising in that district. We were to prove, however, that no
+unforeseen mischance had happened, but that these circumstances which
+seemed so trying were necessary links in the chain of a divinely ordered
+providence, guiding to other and wider spheres.
+
+GOD does not permit persecution to arise without sufficient reason. . . .
+He was leading us by a way that we knew not; but it was none the less
+His way.
+
+ "O LORD, how happy should we be
+ If we would cast our care on Thee,
+ If we from self would rest;
+ And feel at heart that One above,
+ In perfect wisdom, perfect love,
+ Is working for the best!"
+
+When we reached Shanghai, thinking to return inland in a few days with
+fresh supplies of books and money, we met a Christian captain who had
+been trading at Swatow, and he put very strongly before us the need of
+that region, and the fact that there were British merchants living on
+Double Island, selling opium and engaged in the coolie trade
+(practically a slave traffic), while there was no British missionary to
+preach the Gospel. The SPIRIT OF GOD impressed me with the feeling that
+this was His call, but for days I felt that I could not obey it. I had
+never had such a spiritual father as Mr. Burns; I had never known such
+holy, happy fellowship; and I said to myself that it could not be GOD'S
+will that we should separate.
+
+In great unrest of soul I went one evening, with Mr. Burns, to take tea
+at the house of the Rev. R. Lowrie, of the American Presbyterian
+Mission, at the South Gate of Shanghai. After tea Mrs. Lowrie played
+over to us "The Missionary Call."[2] I had never heard it before, and it
+greatly affected me. My heart was almost broken before it was finished,
+and I said to the LORD, in the words that had been sung--
+
+ "And I will go!
+ I may no longer doubt to give up friends, and idol hopes,
+ And every tie that binds my heart. . . .
+ Henceforth, then, it matters not, if storm or sunshine
+ be my earthly lot, bitter or sweet my cup;
+ I only pray, GOD, make me holy,
+ And my spirit nerve for the stern hour of strife."
+
+Upon leaving I asked Mr. Burns to come home with me to the little house
+that was still my headquarters in the native city, and there, with many
+tears, told him how the LORD had been leading me, and how rebellious I
+had been and unwilling to leave him for this new sphere of labour. He
+listened with a strange look of surprise, and of pleasure rather than
+pain; and answered that he had determined that very night to tell me
+that he had heard the LORD'S call to Swatow, and that his one regret had
+been the prospect of the severance of our happy fellowship. We went
+together; and thus was recommenced missionary work in that part of
+China, which in later years has been so abundantly blessed.
+
+Long before this time the Rev. R. Lechler, of the Basel Missionary
+Society, had widely itinerated in the neighbourhood of Swatow and the
+surrounding regions. Driven about from place to place, he had done work
+that was not forgotten, although ultimately he was obliged to retire to
+Hong-kong. For more than forty years this earnest-hearted servant of GOD
+has continued in "labours more abundant"; and quite recently he has left
+Hong-kong, with his devoted wife, to return again inland, and spend the
+strength of his remaining years amongst the people he has so long and
+truly loved.
+
+Captain Bowers, the Christian friend who had been used of GOD in
+bringing the needs of Swatow before Mr. Burns and myself, was overjoyed
+when he heard of our decision to devote ourselves to the evangelisation
+of that busy, important, and populous mart. Being about to sail himself
+on his return journey, he gladly offered us free passages on board the
+_Geelong_, in which we left Shanghai early in the month of March 1856.
+
+A favourable journey of six days brought us to Double Island, where we
+found ourselves landed in the midst of a small but very ungodly
+community of foreigners, engaged in the opium trade and other commercial
+enterprises. Unwilling to be in any way identified with these
+fellow-countrymen, we were most desirous of obtaining quarters at once
+within the native city, situated on a promontory of the mainland, five
+miles farther up, at the mouth of the Han river. Great difficulty was
+experienced in this attempt to obtain a footing amongst the people.
+Indeed, it seemed as though we should fail altogether, and we were
+helplessly cast upon the LORD in prayer. Our GOD soon undertook for us.
+Meeting one day with a Cantonese merchant, a relative of the highest
+official in the town, Mr. Burns addressed him in the Cantonese dialect;
+this gentleman was so pleased at being spoken to by a foreigner in his
+own tongue that he became our friend, and secured us a lodging. We had
+only one little room, however, and not easily shall I forget the long
+hot summer months in that oven-like place, where towards the eaves one
+could touch the heated tiles with one's hand. More room or better
+accommodation it was impossible to obtain.
+
+We varied our stay by visits to the surrounding country; but the
+difficulties and dangers that encountered us here were so great and
+constant, that our former work in the North began to appear safe and
+easy in comparison. The hatred and contempt of the Cantonese was very
+painful, "foreign devil," "foreign dog," or "foreign pig" being the
+commonest appellations; but all this led us into deeper fellowship than
+I had ever known before with Him who was "despised and rejected of men."
+
+In our visits to the country we were liable to be seized at any time and
+held to ransom; and the people commonly declared that the whole district
+was "without emperor, without ruler, and without law." Certainly, might
+was right in those days. On one occasion we were visiting a small town,
+and found that the inhabitants had captured a wealthy man of another
+clan. A large ransom was demanded for his release, and on his refusing
+to pay it they had smashed his ankle-bones, one by one, with a club, and
+thus extorted the promise they desired. There was nothing but GOD'S
+protection to prevent our being treated in the same way. The towns were
+all walled, and one such place would contain ten or twenty thousand
+people of the same clan and surname, who were frequently at war with the
+people living in the next town. To be kindly received in one place was
+not uncommonly a source of danger in the next. In circumstances such as
+these the preserving care of our GOD was often manifested.
+
+After a time the local mandarin became ill, and the native doctors were
+unable to relieve him. He had heard from some who had been under my
+treatment of the benefit derived, and was led to seek our help. GOD
+blessed the medicines given, and grateful for relief, he advised our
+renting a house for a hospital and dispensary. Having his permission, we
+were able to secure the entire premises, one room of which we had
+previously occupied. I had left my stock of medicine and surgical
+instruments under the care of my friend, the late Mr. Wylie, in
+Shanghai, and went back at once to fetch them.
+
+Mr. Burns came down from a town called Am-po, that we had visited
+together several times, to see me off, and returned again when I had
+sailed, with two native evangelists sent up from Hong-kong by the Rev.
+J. Johnson, of the American Baptist Missionary Union. The people were
+willing to listen to their preaching, and to accept their books as a
+gift, but they would not buy them. One night robbers broke in and
+carried off everything they had, with the exception of their stock of
+literature, which was supposed to be valueless. Next morning, very
+early, they were knocked up by persons wishing to buy books, and the
+sales continued; so that by breakfast time they had not only cash enough
+to procure food, but to pay also for the passage of one of the men to
+Double Island, below Swatow, with a letter to Mr. Burns's agent to
+supply him with money. Purchasers continued coming during that day and
+the next, and our friends lacked nothing; but on the third day they
+could not sell a single book. Then, however, when the cash from their
+sales was just exhausted, the messenger returned with supplies.
+
+It was early in July, after about four months' residence in Swatow, that
+I left for Shanghai, intending to return in the course of a few weeks,
+bringing with me my medical apparatus, for further work in association
+with the Rev. William Burns. A new and promising field seemed to be
+opening before us, and it was with much hopeful anticipation that we
+looked forward to the future of the work. Marked blessing was indeed in
+store for the city and neighbourhood of Swatow; but it was not the
+purpose of GOD that either of us should remain to reap the harvest. Mr.
+Burns while in the interior was taken up and imprisoned by the Chinese
+authorities soon after I left, and was sent to Canton. And though he
+returned to Swatow after the war had broken out, he was called away for
+other service, which prevented his subsequent return; while my journey
+to Shanghai proved to be the first step in a diverging pathway leading
+to other spheres.
+
+FOOTNOTE:
+
+[2] For words and music see the end of this chapter.
+
+
+[Illustration: Music: The Missionary Call]
+
+"THE MISSIONARY CALL"
+
+ 1. My soul is not at rest.
+ There comes a strange
+ and secret whisper to
+ my. . . .
+ spirit, like a dream of night,
+ that tells me
+ I am on enchanted
+ ground.
+
+
+ CHORUS FOR FIRST FOUR VERSES.
+
+ _Vivace._ The voice of my departed LORD, "Go, teach all nations,"
+
+ Comes on the night air and awakes mine ear.
+
+
+ CHORUS FOR LAST VERSE.
+
+ Through ages of eternal years,
+ My spirit never shall repent,
+ that toil and suff'ring once were mine . . . below.
+
+
+ 2. Why live I here? the vows of GOD are | on me; | and I may not stop
+ to play with shadows or pluck earthly flowers, | till I my work
+ have done, and | rendered up ac | count.
+
+ 3. And I will | go! | I may no longer doubt to give up friends,
+ and idol | hopes, | and every tie that binds my heart to | thee, my |
+ country.
+
+ 4. Henceforth, then, it matters not, if storm or sunshine be my |
+ earthly lot, | bitter or sweet my | cup; | I only pray: "GOD make me
+ holy, and my spirit nerve for the stern | hour of strife!"
+
+ 5. And when one for whom Satan hath struggled as he hath for | me, |
+ has gained at last that blessed | shore, | Oh! how this heart will
+ glow with | gratitude and | love.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIII
+
+MAN PROPOSES, GOD DISPOSES
+
+
+IT is interesting to notice the various events which united, in the
+providence of GOD, in preventing my return to Swatow, and ultimately led
+to my settling in Ningpo, and making that the centre for the development
+of future labours.
+
+Upon reaching Shanghai, great was my dismay to find that the premises in
+which my medicines and instruments had been stored were burnt down, and
+that all the medicines and many of the instruments were entirely
+destroyed. To me this appeared a great calamity, and I fear I was more
+disposed with faithless Jacob to say, "All these things are against me,"
+than to recognise that "All things work together for good." I had not
+then learned to think of GOD as the One Great Circumstance "in Whom we
+live, and move, and have our being"; and of _all_ lesser, external
+circumstances, as necessarily the kindest, wisest, best, because either
+ordered or permitted by Him. Hence my disappointment and trial were very
+great.
+
+Medicines were expensive in Shanghai, and my means were limited. I
+therefore set out on an inland journey to Ningpo, hoping to obtain a
+supply from Dr. William Parker, a member of the same mission as myself.
+I took with me my few remaining possessions, the principal being my
+watch, a few surgical instruments, a concertina, books for the study of
+Chinese, which in those days were very expensive; but left behind in
+Shanghai a portion of my money.
+
+The country through which I had to pass was suffering much from drought;
+it was the height of summer; and the water in the Grand Canal was very
+low, having been largely drawn upon for the neighbouring rice fields, as
+well as evaporated by the intense heat. I had determined to make the
+journey as much of a mission tour as possible, and set out well supplied
+with Christian tracts and books. After fourteen days spent in travelling
+slowly through the populous country, preaching and distributing books,
+etc., we reached a large town called Shih-mun-wan, and here, finding
+that my supply of literature was exhausted, I determined not to linger
+over the rest of the journey, but to reach Ningpo as speedily as
+possible, _via_ the city of Hai-ning.
+
+
+ _August 4th, 1856._
+
+There was no water beyond Shih-mun-wan, so I paid off my boat, hired
+coolies to carry my things as far as to Chang-gan, and ere sunrise we
+were on the way. I walked on alone, leaving my servant to follow with
+the men, who made frequent stoppages to rest; and on reaching a city
+through which we had to pass, I waited for them in a tea-shop just
+outside the North Gate. The coolies came on very slowly, and seemed
+tired when they arrived. I soon found that they were both opium-smokers,
+so that, although they had only carried a load that one strong man would
+think nothing of taking three times the distance, they really seemed
+wearied.
+
+After some rice and tea and an hour's rest--including, I doubt not, a
+smoke of the opium pipe--they were a little refreshed, and I proposed
+moving on, that we might get to Chang-gan before the sun became too
+powerful. My servant, however, had a friend in the city, and he desired
+to spend the day there, and to go on next morning. But to this I
+objected, wishing to reach Hai-ning that night if possible. . . . We
+therefore set off, entered the North Gate, and had passed through about
+a third of the city, when the coolies stopped to rest, and said they
+should be unable to carry the burden on to Chang-gan. Finally, they
+agreed to take it to the South Gate, where they were to be paid in
+proportion to the distance they had carried it; and the servant
+undertook to call other coolies and come along with them.
+
+I walked on before as in the first instance, and the distance being only
+about four miles, soon reached Chang-gan, and waited their arrival,
+meanwhile engaging coolies for the rest of the journey to Hai-ning.
+Having waited a long time, I began to wonder at the delay; and at length
+it became too late to finish the journey to Hai-ning that night. I felt
+somewhat annoyed; and but that my feet were blistered, and the afternoon
+very hot, I should have gone back to meet them and urge them on. At last
+I concluded that my servant must have gone to his friend's, and would
+not appear until evening. But evening came, and still there was no sign
+of them.
+
+Feeling very uneasy, I began diligently to inquire whether they had been
+seen. At last a man responded, "Are you a guest from Shih-mun-wan?" I
+answered in the affirmative. "Are you going to Hai-ning?" "That is my
+destination." "Then your things have gone on before you; for I was
+sitting in a tea-shop when a coolie came in, took a cup of tea, and set
+off for Hai-ning in a great hurry, saying that the bamboo box and bed he
+carried, which were just such as you describe yours to have been, were
+from Shih-mun-wan, and he had to take them to Hai-ning to-night, where
+he was to be paid at the rate of ten cash a pound." From this I
+concluded that my goods were on before me; but it was impossible to
+follow them at once, for I was too tired to walk, and it was already
+dark.
+
+Under these circumstances all I could do was to seek a lodging for the
+night; and no easy task I found it. After raising my heart to GOD to ask
+His aid, I walked through to the farther end of the town, where I
+thought the tidings of a foreigner's being in the place might not have
+spread, and looked out for an inn. I soon came to one, and went in,
+hoping that I might pass unquestioned, as it was already dark. Asking
+the bill of fare, I was told that cold rice--which proved to be more
+than "rather burnt"--and snakes, fried in lamp-oil, were all that could
+be had. Not wishing any question to be raised as to my nationality, I
+was compelled to order some, and tried to make a meal, but with little
+success.
+
+While thus engaged I said to the landlord, "I suppose I can arrange to
+spend the night here?"
+
+To which he replied in the affirmative; but bringing out his book, he
+added--
+
+"In these unsettled times we are required by the authorities to keep a
+record of our lodgers: may I ask your respected family name?"
+
+"My unworthy family name is Tai," I responded.
+
+"And your honourable second name?"
+
+"My humble name is Ia-koh" (James).
+
+"What an extraordinary name! I never heard it before. How do you write
+it?"
+
+I told him, and added, "It is a common name in the district from which I
+come."
+
+"And may I ask whence you come and whither you are going?"
+
+"I am journeying from Shanghai to Ningpo, by way of Hang-chau."
+
+"What may be your honourable profession?"
+
+"I heal the sick."
+
+"Oh! you are a physician," the landlord remarked; and to my intense
+relief closed the book. His wife, however, took up the conversation.
+
+"You are a physician, are you?" said she; "I am glad of that, for I have
+a daughter afflicted with leprosy. If you will cure her, you shall have
+your supper and bed for nothing."
+
+I was curious enough to inquire what my supper and bed were to cost, if
+paid for; and to my amusement found they were worth less than
+three-halfpence of our money!
+
+Being unable to benefit the girl, I declined to prescribe for her,
+saying that leprosy was a very intractable disease, and that I had no
+medicines with me.
+
+The mother, however, brought pen and paper, urging, "You can at least
+write a prescription, which will do no harm, if it does no good."
+
+But this also I declined to do, and requested to be shown my bed. I was
+conducted to a very miserable room on the ground-floor, where, on some
+boards raised upon two stools, I passed the night, without bed or
+pillow, save my umbrella and shoe, and without any mosquito netting. Ten
+or eleven other lodgers were sleeping in the same room, so I could not
+take anything off, for fear of its being stolen; but I was, I found, by
+no means too warm as midnight came on.
+
+
+ _August 5th._
+
+As may be supposed, I arose but little rested or refreshed, and felt
+very far from well. I had to wait a long time ere breakfast was
+obtainable, and then there was another delay before I could get change
+for the only dollar I had with me, in consequence of its being chipped
+in one or two places. More than three hundred cash also were deducted
+from its price on this account, which was a serious loss to me in my
+trying position.
+
+I then sought throughout the town for tidings of my servant and coolies,
+as I thought it possible that they might have arrived later, or have
+come on in the morning. The town is large, long, and straggling, being
+nearly two miles from one end to the other, so this occupied some time.
+I gained no information, however; and, footsore and weary, set out for
+Hai-ning in the full heat of the day. The journey--about eight
+miles--took me a long time; but a halfway village afforded a
+resting-place and a cup of tea, both of which I gladly availed myself
+of. When about to leave again, a heavy shower of rain came on, and the
+delay thus occasioned enabled me to speak a little to the people about
+the truths of the Gospel.
+
+The afternoon was far spent before I approached the northern suburb of
+Hai-ning, where I commenced inquiries, but could hear no tidings of my
+servant or things. I was told that outside the East Gate I should be
+more likely to hear of them, as it was there the sea-junks called. I
+therefore proceeded thither, and sought for them outside the Little East
+Gate, but in vain. Very weary, I sat down in a tea-shop to rest; and
+while there a number of persons from one of the mandarin's offices came
+in, and made inquiries as to who I was, where I had come from, etc. On
+learning the object of my search, one of the men in the tea-shop said,
+"A bamboo box and a bed, such as you describe, were carried past here
+about half an hour ago. The bearer seemed to be going towards either the
+Great East Gate or the South Gate; you had better go to the hongs there
+and inquire." I asked him to accompany me in the search, and promised to
+reward him for his trouble, but he would not. Another man offered to go
+with me, so we set off together, and both inside and outside the two
+gates made diligent inquiries, but all in vain. I then engaged a man to
+make a thorough search, promising him a liberal reward if he should be
+successful. In the meantime I had some dinner, and addressed a large
+concourse of people who had gathered together.
+
+When he returned, having met with no success, I said to him, "I am now
+quite exhausted: will you help me to find quarters for the night, and
+then I will pay you for your trouble?" He was willing to befriend me,
+and we set off in search of lodgings. At the first place or two the
+people would not receive me; for though on our first going in they
+seemed willing to do so, the presence of a man who followed us, and who,
+I found, was engaged in one of the Government offices, seemed to alarm
+them, and I was refused. We now went to a third place, and being no
+longer followed by the mandarin's messenger, we were promised quarters;
+some tea was brought, and I paid the man who had accompanied me for his
+trouble.
+
+Soon after he was gone some official people came in; they soon went
+away, but the result of their visit was that I was told I could not be
+entertained there that night. A young man present blamed them for their
+heartless behaviour, and said, "Never mind, come with me; and if we
+cannot get better lodgings for you, you shall sleep at our house." I
+went with him, but we found the people of his house unwilling to receive
+me. Weary and footsore, so that I could scarcely stand, I had again to
+seek quarters, and at length got promise of them; but a little crowd
+collecting about the door, they desired me to go to a tea-shop and wait
+there till the people had retired, or they would be unable to
+accommodate me. There was no help for it, so I went, accompanied still
+by the young man, and waited till past midnight. Then we left for the
+promised resting-place; but my conductor would not find it, and he led
+me about to another part of the city; and finally, between one and two
+o'clock, he left me to pass the rest of the night as best I could.
+
+I was opposite a temple, but it was closed; so I lay down on the stone
+steps in front of it, and putting my money under my head for a pillow,
+should soon have been asleep in spite of the cold had I not perceived a
+person coming stealthily towards me. As he approached I saw he was one
+of the beggars so common in China, and had no doubt his intention was to
+rob me of my money. I did not stir, but watched his movements, and
+looked to my FATHER not to leave me in this hour of trial. The man came
+up, looked at me for some time to assure himself that I was asleep (it
+was so dark that he could not see my eyes fixed on him), and then began
+to feel about me gently. I said to him in the quietest tone, but so as
+to convince him that I was not, nor had been, sleeping, "What do you
+want?" He made no answer, but went away.
+
+I was very thankful to see him go, and when he was out of sight put as
+much of my cash as would not go into my pocket safely up my sleeve, and
+made my pillow of a stone projection of the wall. It was not long ere I
+began to doze, but I was aroused by the all but noiseless footsteps of
+two persons approaching; for my nervous system was rendered so sensitive
+by exhaustion that the slightest noise startled me. Again I sought
+protection from Him who alone was my stay, and lay still as before, till
+one of them came up and began to feel under my head for the cash. I
+spoke again, and they sat down at my feet. I asked them what they were
+doing; they replied that they, like me, were going to pass the night
+there. I then requested them to take the opposite side, as there was
+plenty of room, and leave this side to me; but they would not move from
+my feet, so I raised myself up and set my back against the wall.
+
+They said, "You had better lie down and sleep; if you do not, you will
+be unable to walk to-morrow. Do not be afraid; we shall not leave you,
+and will see that no one hurts you."
+
+"Listen to me," I replied. "I do not want your protection; I need it
+not; I am not a Chinese; I do not worship your senseless, helpless
+idols. I worship GOD; He is my FATHER; I trust in Him. I know well what
+you are, and what your intentions are, and shall keep my eye on you, and
+shall not sleep."
+
+On this, one of them went away, but soon returned with a third
+companion. I felt very uneasy, but looked to GOD for help. Once or twice
+one of them got up to see if I was asleep. I only said, "Do not be
+mistaken; I am not sleeping." Occasionally my head dropped, and this was
+a signal for one of them to rise; but I at once roused myself and made
+some remark. As the night slowly passed on, I felt very weary; and to
+keep myself awake, as well as to cheer my mind, I sang several hymns,
+repeated aloud some portions of Scripture, and engaged in prayer in
+English, to the great annoyance of my companions, who seemed as if they
+would have given anything to get me to desist. After that they troubled
+me no more; and shortly before dawn of day they left me, and I got a
+little sleep.
+
+
+ _August 6th._
+
+I was awakened by the young man who had so misled me on the previous
+evening. He was very rude, and insisted on my getting up and paying him
+for his trouble, and even went so far as to try to accomplish by force
+what he wanted. This roused me; and in an unguarded moment, with very
+improper feeling, I seized his arm with such a grasp as he little
+expected I was capable of, and dared him to lay a finger upon me again
+or to annoy me further. This quite changed his manner; he let me quietly
+remain till the guns announced the opening of the gates of the city, and
+then he begged me to give him some money to buy opium with. It is
+needless to say this was refused. I gave him the price of two candles,
+that he said he had burnt while with me last night and no more. I
+learned he was connected with one of the mandarin's offices.
+
+As soon as possible, I bought some rice gruel and tea for breakfast, and
+then once more made a personal search after my things. Some hours thus
+spent proving unavailing, I set out on the return journey, and after a
+long, weary, and painful walk reached Chang-gan about noon. Here also my
+inquiries failed to give me any trace of the missing goods; so I had a
+meal cooked in a tea-shop, got a thorough wash and bathed my inflamed
+feet, and after dinner rested and slept till four in the afternoon.
+
+Much refreshed, I then set on to return to the city, at the South Gate
+of which I had parted with my servant and coolies two days before. On
+the way I was led to reflect on the goodness of GOD, and recollected
+that I had not made it a matter of prayer that I might be provided with
+lodgings last night. I felt condemned, too, that I should have been so
+anxious for my few things, while the many precious souls around me had
+caused so little emotion. I came as a sinner and pleaded the blood of
+JESUS, realising that I was accepted in Him--pardoned, cleansed,
+sanctified--and oh the love of JESUS, how great I felt it to be! I knew
+something more than I had ever previously known of what it was to be
+despised and rejected, and to have nowhere to lay one's head; and I felt
+more than ever I had done before the greatness of that love which
+induced Him to leave His home in glory and suffer thus for me; nay, to
+lay down His very life upon the Cross. I thought of Him as "despised and
+rejected of men, a Man of sorrows, and acquainted with grief"; I thought
+of Him at Jacob's well, weary, hungry, and thirsty, yet finding it His
+meat and drink to do His Father's will; and contrasted this with my
+littleness of love. I looked to Him for pardon for the past, and for
+grace and strength to do His will in the future, to tread more closely
+in His footsteps, and be more than ever wholly His. I prayed for myself,
+for friends in England, and for my brethren in the work. Sweet tears of
+mingled joy and sorrow flowed freely, the road was almost forgotten, and
+before I was aware of it I had reached my destination. Outside the South
+Gate I took a cup of tea, asked about my lost luggage, and spoke of the
+love of JESUS. Then I entered the city, and after many vain inquiries
+left it by the North Gate.
+
+I felt so much refreshed both in mind and body by the communion I had on
+my walk to the city that I thought myself able to finish the remaining
+six miles back to Shih-mun-wan that evening. First I went into another
+tea-shop to buy some native cakes, and was making a meal of them when
+who should come in but one of the identical coolies who had carried my
+things the first stage. From him I learned that after I left them they
+had taken my luggage to the South Gate; there my servant went away,
+saying on his return that I had gone on, that he did not intend to start
+at once, but would spend the day with his friend, and then rejoin me;
+they carried the things to this friend's house, and left them there. I
+got him to go with me to the house, and there learned that the man had
+spent the day and night with them, and next morning had called other
+coolies, and set off for Hang-chau. This was all I could gather; so,
+unable to do anything but proceed on my return journey to Shanghai with
+all expedition, I left the city again. It was now too late to go on to
+Shih-mun-wan. I looked to my FATHER as able to supply all my need, and
+received another token of His ceaseless love and care, being invited to
+sleep on a hong-boat, now dry in the bed of the river. The night was
+again very cold and the mosquitoes troublesome. Still, I got a little
+rest, and at sunrise was up and continued my journey.
+
+
+ _August 7th._
+
+I felt very ill at first, and had a sore throat, but reflected on the
+wonderful goodness of GOD in enabling me to bear the heat by day and the
+cold by night so long. I felt also that quite a load was now taken off
+my mind. I had committed myself and my affairs to the LORD, and knew
+that if it was for my good and for His glory my things would be
+restored; if not, all would be for the best. I hoped that the most
+trying part of my journey was now drawing to a close, and this helped
+me, weary and footsore, on the way. When I got to Shih-mun-wan and had
+breakfasted, I found I had still eight hundred and ten cash in hand; and
+I knew that the hong-boat fare to Kia-hing Fu was one hundred and twenty
+cash, and thence to Shanghai three hundred and sixty, leaving me just
+three hundred and thirty cash--or twelve pence and a fraction--for three
+or four days provisions. I went at once to the boat office, but to my
+dismay found that from the dry state of the river goods had not come
+down, so that no boat would leave to-day and perhaps none to-morrow. I
+inquired if there were no letter-boats for Kia-hing Fu, and was told
+that they had already left. The only remaining resource was to ascertain
+if any private boats were going in which I could get a passage. My
+search, however, was in vain; and I could get no boat to undertake to go
+all the way to Shanghai, or my difficulty would have been at an end.
+
+Just at this juncture I saw before me, at a turn in the canal, a
+letter-boat going in the direction of Kia-hing Fu This, I concluded,
+must be one of the Kia-hing boats that had been unexpectedly detained,
+and I set off after it as fast as hope and the necessities of the case
+would carry me. For the time being weariness and sore feet were alike
+forgotten. After a chase of about a mile I overtook it.
+
+"Are you going to Kia-hing Fu?" I called out.
+
+"No," was the only answer.
+
+"Are you going in that direction?"
+
+"No."
+
+"Will you give me a passage as far as you do go that way?"
+
+Still "No," and nothing more.
+
+Completely dispirited and exhausted, I sank down on the grass and
+fainted away.
+
+As consciousness returned some voices reached my ear, and I found they
+were talking about me. One said, "He speaks pure Shanghai dialect," and
+from their own speech I knew them to be Shanghai people. Raising myself,
+I saw that they were on a large hong-boat on the other side of the
+canal, and after a few words they sent their small boat to fetch me, and
+I went on board the junk. They were very kind, and gave me some tea; and
+when I was refreshed and able to partake of it, some food also. I then
+took my shoes and stockings off to ease my feet, and the boatman kindly
+provided me with hot water to bathe them. When they heard my story, and
+saw the blisters on my feet, they evidently pitied me, and hailed every
+boat that passed to see if it was going my way. Not finding one, by and
+by, after a few hours' sleep, I went ashore with the captain, intending
+to preach in the temple of Kwan-ti.
+
+Before leaving the junk I told the captain and those on board that I was
+now unable to help myself; that I had not strength to walk to Kia-hing
+Fu, and having been disappointed in getting a passage to-day, I should
+no longer have sufficient means to take me there by letter-boat, which
+was an expensive mode of travelling; that I knew not how the GOD whom I
+served would help me, but that I had no doubt He would do so; and that
+my business now was to serve Him where I was. I also told them that the
+help which I knew would come ought to be an evidence to them of the
+truth of the religion which I and the other missionaries at Shanghai
+preached.
+
+On our way to the town, while engaged in conversation with the captain,
+we saw a letter-boat coming up. The captain drew my attention to it; but
+I reminded him that I had no longer the means of paying my passage by
+it. He hailed it, nevertheless, and found that it was going to a place
+about nine English miles from Shanghai, whence one of the boatmen would
+carry the mails overland to the city. He then said, "This gentleman is a
+foreigner from Shanghai, who has been robbed, and has no longer the
+means of returning. If you will take him with you as far as you go, and
+then engage a sedan chair to carry him the rest of the way, he will pay
+you in Shanghai. You see my boat is lying aground yonder for want of
+water, and cannot get away. Now, I will stand surety; and if this
+gentleman does not pay when you get to Shanghai, I will do so on your
+return." This unsolicited kindness on the part of a Chinaman, a perfect
+stranger, will appear the more remarkable to any one acquainted with the
+character of the Chinese, who are generally most reluctant to risk their
+money. Those on the letter-boat agreeing to the terms, I was taken on
+board as a passenger. Oh, how thankful I felt for this providential
+interposition, and to be once more on my way to Shanghai!
+
+Letter-boats such as the one on which I was now travelling are of a
+long narrow build, and very limited as to their inside accommodation.
+One has to lie down all the time they are in motion, as a slight
+movement would easily upset them. This was no irksome condition to me,
+however; on the contrary, I was only too glad to be quiet. They are the
+quickest boats I have seen in China. Each one is worked by two men, who
+relieve one another continuously night and day. They row with their
+feet, and paddle with their hands; or if the wind is quite favourable,
+row with their feet, and with one hand manage a small sail, while
+steering with the other.
+
+After a pleasant and speedy journey, I reached Shanghai in safety on
+August 9th, through the help of Him who has said, "I will never leave
+thee, nor forsake thee;" "Lo, I am with you alway, even unto the end of
+the world."
+
+[Illustration]
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIV
+
+PROVIDENTIAL GUIDANCE
+
+
+IT now seemed very clear that the lost property--including everything I
+possessed in China, with the exception of a small sum of money
+providentially left in Shanghai--had been deliberately stolen by my
+servant, who had gone off with it to Hang-chau. The first question, of
+course, was how best to act for the good of the man who had been the
+cause of so much trouble. It would not have been difficult to take steps
+that would have led to his punishment; though the likelihood of any
+reparation being made for the loss sustained was very small. But the
+consideration which weighed most heavily was that the thief was a man
+for whose salvation I had laboured and prayed; and I felt that to
+prosecute him would not be to emphasise the teaching of the Sermon on
+the Mount, in which we had read together, "Resist not evil," and other
+similar precepts. Finally, concluding that his soul was of more value
+than the L40 worth of things I had lost, I wrote and told him this,
+urging upon him his need of repentance and faith in the LORD JESUS
+CHRIST. The course I took commended itself to my Christian friends in
+England, one of whom was afterwards led to send me a cheque for L40--the
+first of many subsequently received from the same kind helper.
+
+Having obtained the little money left in Shanghai, I again set out for
+Ningpo, to seek assistance from Dr. Parker in replacing the medicines I
+had previously lost by fire. This being satisfactorily accomplished, I
+returned once more to Shanghai, _en route_ for Swatow, hoping soon to
+rejoin my much-loved friend, Mr. Burns, in the work in that important
+centre. GOD had willed it otherwise, however; and the delay caused by
+the robbery was just sufficient to prevent me from starting for the
+South as I had intended.
+
+Over the political horizon storm-clouds had long been gathering,
+precursors of coming war; and early in October of this year (1856) the
+affair of the Lorcha _Arrow_ at Canton led to the definite commencement
+of hostilities. Very soon China was deeply involved in a second
+prolonged struggle with foreign powers; and missionary operations, in
+the South at any rate, had to be largely suspended. Tidings of these
+events, together with letters from Mr. Burns, arrived just in time to
+meet me in Shanghai as I was leaving for Swatow; and thus hindered, I
+could not but realise the hand of GOD in closing the door I had so much
+desired to enter.
+
+While in Ningpo, I had made the acquaintance of Mr. John Jones, who,
+with Dr. Parker, represented the Chinese Evangelisation Society in that
+city. Hindered from returning to Swatow, I now decided to join these
+brethren in the Ningpo work, and set out at once upon the journey. On
+the afternoon of the second day, when already about thirty miles distant
+from Shanghai, Mr. Jones and I drew near the large and important city of
+Sung-kiang, and I spoke of going ashore to preach the Gospel to the
+thronging multitudes that lined the banks and crowded the approaches to
+the city gates.
+
+Among the passengers on board the boat was one intelligent man, who in
+the course of his travels had been a good deal abroad, and had even
+visited England, where he went by the name of Peter. As might be
+expected, he had heard something of the Gospel, but had never
+experienced its saving power. On the previous evening I had drawn him
+into earnest converse about his soul's salvation. The man listened with
+attention, and was even moved to tears, but still no definite result was
+apparent. I was pleased, therefore, when he asked to be allowed to
+accompany me, and to hear me preach.
+
+I went into the cabin of the boat to prepare tracts and books for
+distribution on landing with my Chinese friend, when suddenly I was
+startled by a splash and a cry from without. I sprang on deck, and took
+in the situation at a glance. Peter was gone! The other men were all
+there, on board, looking helplessly at the spot where he had
+disappeared, but making no effort to save him. A strong wind was
+carrying the junk rapidly forward in spite of a steady current in the
+opposite direction, and the low-lying, shrubless shore afforded no
+landmark to indicate how far we had left the drowning man behind.
+
+I instantly let down the sail and leapt overboard in the hope of finding
+him. Unsuccessful, I looked around in agonising suspense, and saw close
+to me a fishing-boat with a peculiar drag-net furnished with hooks,
+which I knew would bring him up.
+
+"Come!" I cried, as hope revived in my heart. "Come and drag over this
+spot directly; a man is drowning just here!"
+
+"Veh bin" (It is not convenient), was the unfeeling answer.
+
+"Don't talk of _convenience_!" cried I in an agony; "a man is drowning,
+I tell you!"
+
+"We are busy fishing," they responded, "and cannot come."
+
+"Never mind your fishing," I said, "I will give you more money than many
+a day's fishing will bring; only come--come at once!"
+
+"How much money will you give us?"
+
+"We cannot stay to discuss that now! Come, or it will be too late. I
+will give you five dollars" (then worth about thirty shillings in English
+money).
+
+"We won't do it for that," replied the men. "Give us twenty dollars, and
+we will drag."
+
+"I do not possess so much: do come quickly, and I will give you all I
+have!"
+
+"How much may that be?"
+
+“I don't know exactly, about fourteen dollars."
+
+At last, but even then slowly enough, the boat was paddled over, and the
+net let down. Less than a minute sufficed to bring up the body of the
+missing man. The fishermen were clamorous and indignant because their
+exorbitant demand was delayed while efforts at resuscitation were being
+made. But all was in vain--life was extinct.
+
+To myself this incident was profoundly sad and full of significance,
+suggesting a far more mournful reality. Were not those fishermen
+actually guilty of this poor Chinaman's death, in that they had the
+means of saving him at hand, if they would but have used them? Assuredly
+they were guilty. And yet, let us pause ere we pronounce judgment
+against them, lest a greater than Nathan answer, "_Thou art the man_."
+Is it so hard-hearted, so wicked a thing to neglect to save the body? Of
+how much sorer punishment, then, is he worthy who leaves the soul to
+perish, and Cain-like says, "Am I my brother's keeper?" The LORD JESUS
+commands, commands _me_, commands _you_, my brother, and _you_, my
+sister. "Go," says He, "go ye into _all_ the world, and preach the
+Gospel to _every_ creature." Shall we say to _Him_, "No, it is not
+convenient"? shall we tell _Him_ that we are busy fishing and cannot
+go? that we have bought a piece of ground and cannot go? that we have
+purchased five yoke of oxen, or have married, or are engaged in other
+and more interesting pursuits, and cannot go? Ere long "we must all
+appear before the judgment seat of CHRIST; that every one may receive
+the things done in his body." Let us remember, let us pray for, let us
+labour for the unevangelised Chinese; _or we shall sin against our own
+souls_. Let us consider _Who_ it is that has said, "If thou _forbear_ to
+deliver them that are drawn unto death, and those that are ready to be
+slain; if thou sayest, Behold, we knew it not; doth not He that
+pondereth the heart consider it? and He that keepeth _thy_ soul, doth
+not he know it? and shall not He render to every man according to his
+works?"
+
+ Through midnight gloom from Macedon,
+ The cry of myriads as of one;
+ The voiceful silence of despair
+ Is eloquent in awful prayer:
+ The soul's exceeding bitter cry,
+ "Come o'er and help us, or we die."
+
+ How mournfully it echoes on,
+ For half the earth is Macedon;
+ These brethren to their brethren call,
+ And by the Love which loves them all,
+ And by the whole world's Life they cry,
+ "O ye that live, behold we die!"
+
+ By other sounds the world is won
+ Than that which wails from Macedon;
+ The roar of gain is round it rolled,
+ Or men unto themselves are sold,
+ And cannot list the alien cry,
+ "O hear and help us, lest we die!"
+
+ Yet with that cry from Macedon
+ The very car of CHRIST rolls on:
+ "_I come; who would abide My day,_
+ _In yonder wilds prepare My way;_
+ _My voice is crying in their cry,_
+ _Help ye the dying, lest ye die_."
+
+ JESU, for men of Man the SON,
+ Yea, THINE the cry from Macedon;
+ Oh, by the kingdom and the power
+ And glory of Thine advent hour,
+ Wake heart and will to hear their cry:
+ Help us to help them, lest we die.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XV
+
+SETTLEMENT IN NINGPO
+
+
+THE autumn of 1856 was well advanced before I reached Ningpo, one of the
+most ancient and influential cities on the coast of China. Opened to the
+residence of foreigners in 1842 by the treaty of Nan-king, it had long
+been the scene of missionary labours. Within its thronging thoroughfares
+the busy tide of life runs high. Four hundred thousand human beings
+dwell within or around the five miles circuit of its ancient wall, every
+one a soul that JESUS loves, for whom He died.
+
+As winter drew on I rented a native house in Wu-gyiao-deo, or Lake Head
+Street. It was not then a very comfortable residence. I have a very
+distinct remembrance of tracing my initials on the snow which during the
+night had collected upon my coverlet in the large barn-like upper room,
+now subdivided into four or five smaller ones, each of which is
+comfortably ceiled. The tiling of an unceiled Chinese house may keep off
+the rain--if it happens to be sound--but it does not afford so good a
+protection against snow, which will beat up through crannies and
+crevices, and find its way within. But however unfinished may have been
+its fittings, the little house was well adapted for work amongst the
+people; and there I thankfully settled down, finding ample scope for
+service,--morning, noon, and night.
+
+During the latter part of this year my mind was greatly exercised about
+continued connection with my Society, it being frequently in debt.
+Personally I had always avoided debt, and kept within my salary, though
+at times only by very careful economy. Now there was no difficulty in
+doing this, for my income was larger, and the country being in a more
+peaceful state, things were not so dear. But the Society itself was in
+debt. The quarterly bills which I and others were instructed to draw
+were often met by borrowed money, and a correspondence commenced which
+terminated in the following year by my resigning from conscientious
+motives.
+
+To me it seemed that the teaching of GOD'S Word was unmistakably clear:
+"Owe no man any thing." To borrow money implied, to my mind, a
+contradiction of Scripture--a confession that GOD had withheld some good
+thing, and a determination to get for ourselves what He had not given.
+Could that which was wrong for one Christian to do be right for an
+association of Christians? Or could any amount of precedents make a
+wrong course justifiable? If the Word taught me anything, it taught me
+to have no connection with debt. I could not think that GOD was poor,
+that He was short of resources, or unwilling to supply any want of
+whatever work was really His. It seemed to me that if there were lack of
+funds to carry on work, then to that degree, in that special
+development, or at that time, it could not be the work of GOD. To
+satisfy my conscience I was therefore compelled to resign connection
+with the Society which had hitherto supplied my salary.
+
+It was a great satisfaction to me that my friend and colleague, Mr.
+Jones, also of the Chinese Evangelisation Society, was led to take the
+same step; and we were both profoundly thankful that the separation
+took place without the least breach of friendly feeling on either side.
+Indeed, we had the joy of knowing that the step we took commended itself
+to several members of the Committee, although as a whole the Society
+could not come to our position. Depending upon GOD alone for supplies,
+we were enabled to continue a measure of connection with our former
+supporters, sending home journals, etc., for publication as before, so
+long as the Society continued to exist.
+
+The step we had taken was not a little trying to faith. I was not at all
+sure what GOD would have me do, or whether He would so meet my need as
+to enable me to continue working as before. I had no friends whatever
+from whom I expected supplies. I did not know what means the LORD might
+use; but I was willing to give up all my time to the service of
+evangelisation among the heathen, if by any means He would supply the
+smallest amount on which I could live; and if He were not pleased to do
+this, I was prepared to undertake whatever work might be necessary to
+supply myself, giving all the time that could be spared from such a
+calling to more distinctly missionary efforts. But GOD blessed and
+prospered me; and how glad and thankful I felt when the separation was
+really effected! I could look right up into my FATHER'S face with a
+satisfied heart, ready, by His grace, to do the next thing as He might
+teach me, and feeling very sure of His loving care.
+
+And how blessedly He did lead me on and provide for me I can never,
+never tell. It was like a continuation of some of my earlier home
+experiences. My faith was not untried; it often, often failed, and I was
+so sorry and ashamed of the failure to trust such a FATHER. But oh! I
+was learning to know Him. I would not even then have missed the trial.
+He became so near, so real, so intimate. The occasional difficulty about
+funds never came from an insufficient supply for personal needs, but in
+consequence of ministering to the wants of scores of the hungry and
+dying ones around us. And trials far more searching in other ways quite
+eclipsed these difficulties; and being deeper, brought forth in
+consequence richer fruits. How glad one is now, not only to know, with
+dear Miss Havergal, that----
+
+ "They who trust Him wholly
+ Find Him wholly true,"
+
+but also that when we fail to trust fully He still remains unchangingly
+faithful. He _is_ wholly true whether we trust or not. "If we believe
+not, He abideth faithful; He cannot deny Himself." But oh, how we
+dishonour our LORD whenever we fail to trust Him, and what peace,
+blessing, and triumph we lose in thus sinning against the Faithful One!
+May we never again presume in anything to doubt Him!
+
+The year 1857 was a troublous time, and closed with the notorious
+bombardment of Canton by the British, and the commencement of our second
+Chinese war. Rumours of trouble were everywhere rife, and in many places
+the missionaries passed through not a little danger. In Ningpo this was
+especially the case, and the preserving care of GOD in answer to prayer
+was consequently most marked. When the awful news of the bombardment of
+Canton reached the Cantonese in Ningpo their wrath and indignation knew
+no bounds, and they immediately set to work to plot the destruction of
+all the foreigners resident in the city and neighbourhood. It was well
+known that many of the foreigners were in the habit of meeting for
+worship every Sunday evening at one of the missionary houses, and the
+plan was to surround the place on a given occasion and make short work
+of all present, cutting off afterwards any who might not be present.
+
+The sanction of the Tao-t'ai, or chief civil magistrate of the city, was
+easily obtained; and nothing remained to hinder the execution of the
+plot, of which the foreigners were of course entirely in ignorance. (A
+similar plot against the Portuguese a few months later was carried out,
+and between fifty and sixty were massacred in open daylight.) It so
+happened, however, that one of those acquainted with the conspiracy had
+a friend engaged in the service of the missionaries; and anxious for his
+safety, he was led to warn him of the coming danger, and urge his
+leaving foreign employ. The servant made the matter known to his master,
+and thus the little community became aware of their peril. Realising the
+gravity of the situation, they determined to meet together at the house
+of one of their number to seek the protection of the Most High, and to
+hide under the shadow of His wings. Nor did they thus meet in vain.
+
+At the very time we were praying the LORD was working. He led an
+inferior mandarin, the Superintendent of Customs, to call upon the
+Tao-t'ai, and remonstrate with him upon the folly of permitting such an
+attempt, which he assured him would rouse the foreigners in other places
+to come with armed forces to avenge the death of their countrymen and
+raze the city to the ground. The Tao-t'ai replied that, when the
+foreigners came for that purpose, he should deny all knowledge of or
+complicity in the plot, and so direct their vengeance against the
+Cantonese, who would in their turn be destroyed; "and thus," said he,
+"we shall get rid of both Cantonese and foreigners by one stroke of
+policy." The Superintendent of Customs assured him that all such
+attempts at evasion would be useless; and, finally, the Tao-t'ai sent to
+the Cantonese, withdrawing his permission, and prohibiting the attack.
+This took place at the very time when we were asking protection of the
+LORD, though we did not become acquainted with the facts until some
+weeks later. Thus again we were led to prove that--
+
+ "Sufficient is His arm alone,
+ And our defence is sure."
+
+I cannot attempt to give any historical record of the events of this
+period, but ere 1857 terminated Mr. Jones and I were cheered by tokens
+of blessing. It is interesting to recall the circumstances connected
+with the first profession of faith in Christ, which encouraged us.
+
+On one occasion I was preaching the glad tidings of salvation through
+the finished work of CHRIST, when a middle-aged man stood up, and
+testified before his assembled countrymen to his faith in the power of
+the Gospel.
+
+"I have long sought for the Truth," said he earnestly, "as my fathers
+did before me; but I have never found it. I have travelled far and near,
+but without obtaining it. I have found no rest in Confucianism,
+Buddhism, or Taoism; but I do find rest in what I have heard here
+to-night. Henceforth I am a believer in JESUS."
+
+This man was one of the leading officers of a sect of reformed Buddhists
+in Ningpo. A short time after his confession of faith in the SAVIOUR
+there was a meeting of the sect over which he had formerly presided. I
+accompanied him to that meeting, and there, to his former
+co-religionists, he testified of the peace he had obtained in believing.
+Soon after, one of his former companions was converted and baptized.
+Both now sleep in JESUS. The first of these two long continued to preach
+to his countrymen the glad tidings of great joy. A few nights after his
+conversion he asked how long this Gospel had been known in England. He
+was told that we had known it for some hundreds of years.
+
+"What!" said he, amazed; "is it possible that for hundreds of years you
+have had the knowledge of these glad tidings in your possession, and yet
+have only now come to preach it to us? My father sought after the Truth
+for more than twenty years, and died without finding it. Oh, why did you
+not come sooner?"
+
+A whole generation has passed away since that mournful inquiry was made;
+but how many, alas! might repeat the same question to-day? More than two
+hundred millions in the meanwhile have been swept into eternity, without
+an offer of salvation. How long shall this continue, and the MASTER'S
+words, "To every creature," remain unheeded?
+
+[Illustration]
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVI
+
+TIMELY SUPPLIES
+
+
+NOT infrequently our GOD brings His people into difficulties on purpose
+that they may come to know Him as they could not otherwise do. Then He
+reveals Himself as "a very present help in trouble," and makes the heart
+glad indeed at each fresh revelation of a FATHER'S faithfulness. We who
+only see so small a part of the sweet issues of trial often feel that we
+would not for anything have missed them; how much more shall we bless
+and magnify His Name when all the hidden things are brought to light!
+
+In the autumn of 1857, just one year after I came to settle in Ningpo, a
+little incident occurred that did much to strengthen our faith in the
+loving-kindness and ever-watchful care of GOD.
+
+A brother in the LORD, the Rev. John Quarterman, of the American
+Presbyterian Mission North, was taken with virulent small-pox, and it
+was my mournful privilege to nurse him through his suffering illness to
+its fatal close. When all was over, it became necessary to lay aside the
+garments worn while nursing, for fear of conveying the infection to
+others. Not having sufficient money in hand to purchase what was needful
+in order to make this change, prayer was the only resource. The LORD
+answered it by the unexpected arrival of a long-lost box of clothing
+from Swatow, that had remained in the care of the Rev. William Burns
+when I left him for Shanghai, in the early summer of the previous year.
+The arrival of the things just at this juncture was as appropriate as it
+was remarkable, and brought a sweet sense of the FATHER'S own providing.
+
+About two months later the following was penned:----
+
+
+ _November 18th, 1857._
+
+Many seem to think that I am very poor. This certainly is true enough in
+one sense, but I thank GOD it is "as poor, yet making many rich; as
+having nothing, yet possessing all things." And my GOD shall supply
+_all_ my need; to Him be all the glory. I would not, if I could, be
+otherwise than I am--entirely dependent myself upon the LORD, and used
+as a channel of help to others.
+
+On Saturday, the 4th inst., our regular home mail arrived. That morning
+we supplied, as usual, a breakfast to the destitute poor, who came to
+the number of seventy. Sometimes they do not reach forty, at others
+again exceeding eighty. They come to us every day, LORD'S Day excepted,
+for then we cannot manage to attend to them and get through all our
+other duties too. Well, on that Saturday morning we paid all expenses,
+and provided ourselves for the morrow, after which we had not a single
+dollar left between us. How the LORD was going to provide for Monday we
+knew not; but over our mantelpiece hung two scrolls in the Chinese
+character--_Ebenezer_, "Hitherto hath the LORD helped us"; and
+_Jehovah-Jireh_, "The LORD will provide"--and He kept us from doubting
+for a moment. That very day the mail came in, _a week sooner than was
+expected_, and Mr. Jones received a bill for two hundred and fourteen
+dollars. We thanked GOD and took courage. The bill was taken to a
+merchant, and although there is usually a delay of several days in
+getting the change, this time he said, "Send down on Monday." We sent,
+and though he had not been able to buy all the dollars, he let us have
+seventy on account; so all was well. Oh, it is sweet to live thus
+directly dependent upon the LORD, who never fails us!
+
+On Monday the poor had their breakfast as usual, for we had not told
+them not to come, being assured that it was the LORD'S work, and that
+the LORD would provide. We could not help our eyes filling with tears of
+gratitude when we saw not only our own needs supplied, but the widow and
+the orphan, the blind and the lame, the friendless and the destitute,
+together provided for by the bounty of Him who feeds the ravens. "O
+magnify the LORD with me, and let us exalt His Name together. . . . Taste
+and see that the LORD is good: blessed is the man that trusteth in Him.
+O fear the LORD, ye His saints: for there is no want to them that fear
+Him. The young lions do lack, and suffer hunger: but they that seek the
+LORD shall not want any good thing"--and if not good, why want it?
+
+But even two hundred dollars cannot last for ever, and by New Year's Day
+supplies were again getting low. At last, on January 6th, 1858, only one
+solitary cash remained--the twentieth part of a penny--in the joint
+possession of Mr. Jones and myself; but though tried we looked to GOD
+once again to manifest His gracious care. Enough provision was found in
+the house to supply a meagre breakfast; after which, having neither food
+for the rest of the day, nor money to buy any, we could only betake
+ourselves to Him who was able to supply all our need with the petition,
+"Give us this day our daily bread."
+
+After prayer and deliberation we thought that perhaps we ought to
+dispose of something we possessed in order to meet our immediate
+requirements. But on looking round we saw nothing that we could well
+spare, and little that the Chinese would purchase for ready money.
+Credit to any extent we might have had, could we conscientiously have
+availed ourselves of it, but this we felt to be unscriptural in itself,
+as well as inconsistent with the position we were in. We had, indeed,
+one article--an iron stove--which we knew the Chinese would readily
+purchase; but we much regretted the necessity of parting with it. At
+length, however, we set out to the founder's, and after a walk of some
+distance came to the river, which we had intended to cross by a floating
+bridge of boats; but here the LORD shut up our path. The bridge had been
+carried away during the preceding night, and the river was only passable
+by means of a ferry, the fare for which was two cash each person. As we
+only possessed one cash, our course clearly was to return and await
+GOD'S own interposition on our behalf.
+
+Upon reaching home, we found that Mrs. Jones had gone with the children
+to dine at a friend's house, in accordance with an invitation accepted
+some days previously. Mr. Jones, though himself included in the
+invitation, refused now to go and leave me to fast alone. So we set to
+work and carefully searched the cupboards; and though there was nothing
+to eat, we found a small packet of cocoa, which, with a little hot
+water, somewhat revived us. After this we again cried to the LORD in our
+trouble, and the LORD heard and saved us out of all our distresses. For
+while we were still upon our knees a letter arrived from England
+containing a remittance.
+
+This timely supply not only met the immediate and urgent need of the
+day; for in the assured confidence that GOD, whose we were and whom we
+served, would not put to shame those whose whole and only trust was in
+Himself. My marriage had been previously arranged to take place just
+fourteen days after this date. And this expectation was not
+disappointed; for "the mountains shall depart, and the hills be removed,
+but My kindness shall not depart from thee, neither shall the covenant
+of My peace be removed." And although during subsequent years our faith
+was often exercised, and sometimes severely, He ever proved faithful to
+His promise, and never suffered us to lack any good thing.
+
+Never, perhaps, was there a union that more fully realised the blessed
+truth, "Whoso findeth a wife findeth a good thing, and obtaineth favour
+of the LORD." My dear wife was not only a precious gift to me; GOD
+blessed her to many others during the twelve eventful years through
+which she was spared to those that loved her and to China.
+
+Hers had been a life connection with missionary work in that great
+empire; for her father, the loved and devoted Samuel Dyer, was amongst
+the very earliest representatives of the London Mission in the East. He
+reached the Straits as early as 1827, and for sixteen years laboured
+assiduously amongst the Chinese in Penang and Singapore, completing at
+the same time a valuable fount of Chinese metallic type, the first of
+the kind that had then been attempted. Dying in 1843, it was never Mr.
+Dyers privilege to realise his hopes of ultimately being able to settle
+on Chinese soil; but his children lived to see the country opened to the
+Gospel, and to take their share in the great work that had been so dear
+to his heart. At the time of her marriage, my dear wife had been already
+living for several years in Ningpo with her friend, Miss Aldersey, in
+whose varied missionary operations she was well qualified to render
+valuable assistance.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVII
+
+GOD A REFUGE FOR US
+
+
+A SOMEWHAT different though not less manifest answer to prayer was
+vouchsafed early in the year 1859. My dear wife was brought very low by
+illness, and at last all hope of recovery seemed gone. Every remedy
+tried had proved unavailing; and Dr. Parker, who was in attendance, had
+nothing more to suggest. Life was ebbing fast away. The only ground of
+hope was that GOD might yet see fit to raise her up, in answer to
+believing but submissive prayer.
+
+The afternoon for the usual prayer meeting among the missionaries had
+arrived, and I sent in a request for prayer, which was most warmly
+responded to. Just at this time a remedy that had not yet been tried was
+suggested to my mind, and I felt that I must hasten to consult Dr.
+Parker as to the propriety of using it. It was a moment of anguish. The
+hollow temples, sunken eyes, and pinched features denoted the near
+approach of death; and it seemed more than questionable as to whether
+life would hold out until my return. It was nearly two miles to Dr.
+Parker's house, and every moment appeared long. On my way thither, while
+wrestling mightily with GOD in prayer, the precious words were brought
+with power to my soul, "Call upon Me in the day of trouble: I will
+deliver thee, and thou shall glorify Me." I was at once enabled to plead
+them in faith, and the result was deep, deep, unspeakable peace and
+joy. All consciousness of distance was gone. Dr. Parker cordially
+approved of the use of the means suggested, but upon arriving at home I
+saw at a glance that the desired change had taken place in the absence
+of this or any other remedy. The pinched aspect of the countenance had
+given place to the calmness of tranquil slumber, and not one
+unfavourable symptom remained to retard recovery to health and strength.
+
+Spared thus in answer to prayer the loss of my own loved one, it was
+with added sympathy and sorrow that I felt for Dr. Parker, when, in the
+autumn of the same year, his own wife was very suddenly removed. It
+being necessary for the doctor to return at once with his motherless
+children to Glasgow, temporary arrangements had to be made for the
+conduct of the Mission Hospital in Ningpo, for which he alone had been
+responsible. Under these circumstances he requested me to take up the
+work, at least so far as the dispensary was concerned. After a few days'
+waiting upon the LORD for guidance, I felt constrained to undertake not
+only the dispensary work, but also that of the hospital; relying solely
+upon the faithfulness of a prayer-hearing GOD to furnish the means
+required for its support.
+
+The funds for the maintenance of the hospital had hitherto been supplied
+by the proceeds of the doctor's foreign medical practice; and with his
+departure these ceased. But had not GOD said that whatever we ask in the
+Name of the LORD JESUS shall be done? And are we not told to seek first
+the kingdom of GOD, not means to advance it, and that all these things
+shall be added to us? Such promises were surely sufficient. Eight days
+before entering upon this responsibility I had not the remotest idea of
+ever doing so; still less could friends at home have anticipated it.
+But the LORD had foreseen the need, and already funds were on the way to
+supply it.
+
+At times there were not less than fifty in-patients in the hospital,
+besides a large number who daily attended the out-patient department.
+Thirty beds were ordinarily allotted to free patients and their
+attendants; and about as many to opium-smokers, who paid for their board
+while being cured of the habit. As all the wants of the sick in the
+wards were supplied gratuitously, in addition to the remedial appliances
+needed for the out-patient work, the daily expenses were considerable;
+besides which, a number of native attendants were required, involving
+their support.
+
+When Dr. Parker handed the hospital over to me he was able to leave
+money that would meet the salaries and working expenses of the current
+month, and little more. Being unable to guarantee their support, his
+native staff retired; and then I mentioned the circumstances to the
+members of our little church, some of whom volunteered to help me,
+depending, like myself, upon the LORD; and they with me continued to
+wait upon GOD that in some way or other He would provide for His own
+work. Day by day the stores diminished, and they were all but exhausted
+when one day a remarkable letter reached me from a friend in England
+which contained a cheque for L50. The letter stated that the sender had
+recently lost his father, and had inherited his property; that not
+desiring to increase his personal expenditure, he wished to hold the
+money which had now been left to him to further the LORD'S work. He
+enclosed the L50, saying that I might know of some special need for it;
+but leaving me free to use it for my own support, or in any way that the
+LORD might lead me; only asking to know how it was applied, and whether
+there was need for more.
+
+After a little season of thanksgiving with my dear wife, I called my
+native helpers into our little chapel, and translated to them the
+letter. I need not say how rejoiced they were, and that we together
+praised GOD. They returned to their work in the hospital with
+overflowing hearts, and told out to the patients what a GOD was ours;
+appealing to them whether their idols had ever helped them so. Both
+helpers and patients were blessed spiritually through this remarkable
+provision, and from that time the LORD provided all that was necessary
+for carrying on the institution, in addition to what was needed for the
+maintenance of my own family, and for sustaining other branches of
+missionary work under my care. When, nine months later, I was obliged
+through failure of health to relinquish this charge, I was able to leave
+more funds in hand for the support of the hospital than were forthcoming
+at the time I undertook it.
+
+But not only were pecuniary supplies vouchsafed in answer to
+prayer--many lives were spared; persons apparently in hopeless stages of
+disease were restored, and success was given in cases of serious and
+dangerous operations. In the case of one poor man, whose legs were
+amputated under very unfavourable circumstances, healthy action took
+place with such rapidity that both wounds were healed in less than two
+weeks. And more permanent benefits than these were conferred. Many were
+convinced of the truth of Christianity; not a few sought the LORD in
+faith and prayer, and experienced the power of the Great Physician to
+cure the sin-sick soul. During the nine months above alluded to sixteen
+patients from the hospital were baptized, and more than thirty others
+became candidates for admission into one or other of the Christian
+churches in the city.
+
+Thus the year 1860 began with openings on all hands, but time and
+strength were sadly too limited to admit of their being used to the
+best advantage. For some time the help of additional workers had been a
+much-felt need; and in January very definite prayer was made to the LORD
+of the harvest that He would thrust forth more labourers into this
+special portion of the great world-field. Writing to relatives at home
+in England, under date of January 16th, 1860, I thus expressed the deep
+longing of our hearts:--
+
+ Do you know any earnest, devoted young men
+ desirous of serving GOD in China, who--not wishing
+ for more than their actual support--would be
+ willing to come out and labour here? Oh, for four
+ or five such helpers! They would probably begin to
+ preach in Chinese in six months time; and in
+ answer to prayer the necessary means for their
+ support would be found.
+
+But no one came to help us then; and under the incessant physical and
+mental strain involved, in the care of the hospital during Dr. Parker's
+absence, as well as the continued discharge of my other missionary
+duties, my own health began rapidly to fail, and it became a serious
+question as to whether it would not be needful to return to England for
+a time.
+
+It was hard to face this possibility. The growing church and work seemed
+to need our presence, and it was no small trial to part from those whom
+we had learned so truly to love in the LORD. Thirty or forty native
+Christians had been gathered into the recently organised church; and the
+well-filled meetings, and the warm-hearted earnestness of the converts,
+all bespoke a future of much promise. At last, however, completely
+prostrated by repeated attacks of illness, the only hope of restoration
+seemed to lie in a voyage to England and a brief stay in its more
+bracing climate; and this necessity, painful though it seemed at the
+time, proved to be only another opportunity for the manifestation of the
+faithfulness and loving care of Him "who worketh all things after the
+counsel of His own will."
+
+As heretofore, the LORD was present with His aid. The means for our
+journey were supplied, and that so liberally that we were able to bring
+with us a native Christian to assist in translation or other literary
+work, and to instruct in the language such helpers as the LORD might
+raise up for the extension of the Mission. That He would give us
+fellow-labourers we had no doubt; for we had been enabled to seek them
+from Him in earnest and believing prayer for many months previously.
+
+The day before leaving China we wrote as follows to our friend W. T.
+Berger, Esq., whom we had known in England, and who had ever
+strengthened our hands in the LORD while in that distant land:--
+
+"We are bringing with us a young Chinese brother to assist in literary
+work, and I hope also in teaching the dialect to those whom the LORD may
+induce to return with us."
+
+And throughout the voyage our earnest cry to GOD was that He would
+overrule our stay at home for good to China, and make it instrumental in
+raising up at least five helpers to labour in the province of
+CHEH-KIANG.
+
+The way in which it pleased the LORD to answer these earnest and
+believing prayers, and the "exceeding abundantly" with which He crowned
+them, we shall now sketch in brief outline.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVIII
+
+A NEW AGENCY NEEDED
+
+
+"My thoughts are not your thoughts, neither are your ways My ways, saith
+the LORD. For as the heavens are higher than the earth, so are My ways
+higher than your ways, and My thoughts than your thoughts."[3] How true
+are these words! When the LORD is bringing in great blessing in the best
+possible way, how oftentimes our unbelieving hearts are feeling, if not
+saying, like Jacob of old, "All these things are against me." Or we are
+filled with fear, as were the disciples when the LORD, walking on the
+waters, drew near to quiet the troubled sea, and to bring them quickly
+to their desired haven. And yet mere common-sense ought to tell us that
+He, whose way is perfect, _can_ make no mistakes; that He who has
+promised to "perfect that which concerneth" us, and whose minute care
+counts the very hairs of our heads, and forms for us our circumstances,
+_must_ know better than we the way to forward our truest interests and
+to glorify His own Name.
+
+ "Blind unbelief is _sure_ to err
+ And scan His work in vain;
+ GOD is His own Interpreter,
+ And He will make it plain."
+
+To me it seemed a great calamity that failure of health compelled my
+relinquishing work for GOD in China, just when it was more fruitful than
+ever before; and to leave the little band of Christians in Ningpo,
+needing much care and teaching, was a great sorrow. Nor was the sorrow
+lessened when, on reaching England, medical testimony assured me that
+return to China, at least for years to come, was impossible. Little did
+I then realise that the long separation from China was a necessary step
+towards the formation of a work which GOD would bless as He has blessed
+the CHINA INLAND MISSION. While in the field, the pressure of claims
+immediately around me was so great that I could not think much of the
+still greater needs of the regions farther inland; and, if they were
+thought of, could do nothing for them. But while detained for some years
+in England, daily viewing the whole country on the large map on the wall
+of my study, I was as near to the vast regions of Inland China as to the
+smaller districts in which I had laboured personally for GOD; and prayer
+was often the only resource by which the burdened heart could gain any
+relief.
+
+As a long absence from China appeared inevitable, the next question was
+how best to serve China while in England, and this led to my engaging
+for several years, with the late Rev. F. F. Gough of the C. M. S., in
+the revision of a version of the New Testament in the colloquial of
+Ningpo for the British and Foreign Bible Society. In undertaking this
+work, in my short-sightedness I saw nothing beyond the use that the
+Book, and the marginal references, would be to the native Christians;
+but I have often seen since that, without those months of feeding and
+feasting on the Word of GOD, I should have been quite unprepared to
+form, on its present basis, a mission like the CHINA INLAND MISSION.
+
+In the study of that Divine Word I learned that, to obtain successful
+labourers, not elaborate appeals for help, but, _first_, earnest _prayer
+to GOD to thrust forth labourers_, and, _second_, the deepening of the
+spiritual life of the church, so that _men should be unable to stay at
+home_, were what was needed. I saw that the Apostolic plan was not to
+raise ways and means, but _to go and do the work_, trusting in His sure
+Word who has said, "Seek ye _first_ the Kingdom of GOD and His
+righteousness, and all these things shall be added unto you."
+
+In the meantime the prayer for workers for CHEH-KIANG was being
+answered. The first, Mr. Meadows, sailed for China with his young wife
+in January 1862, through the kind co-operation and aid of our friend Mr.
+Berger. The second left England in 1864, having her passage provided by
+the Foreign Evangelisation Society. The third and fourth reached Ningpo
+on July 24th, 1865. A fifth soon followed them, reaching Ningpo in
+September 1865. Thus the prayer for the five workers was fully answered;
+and we were encouraged to look to GOD for still greater things.
+
+Months of earnest prayer and not a few abortive efforts had resulted in
+a deep conviction that _a special agency was essential_ for the
+evangelisation of Inland China. At this time I had not only the daily
+help of prayer and conference with my beloved friend and fellow-worker
+the late Rev. F. F. Gough, but also invaluable aid and counsel from Mr.
+and Mrs. Berger, with whom I and my dear wife (whose judgment and piety
+were of priceless value at this juncture) spent many days in prayerful
+deliberation. The grave difficulty of possibly interfering with existing
+missionary operations at home was foreseen; but it was concluded that,
+by simple trust in GOD, suitable agency might be raised up and sustained
+without interfering injuriously with any existing work. I had also a
+growing conviction that GOD would have _me_ to seek from Him the needed
+workers, and to go forth with them. But for a long time unbelief
+hindered my taking the first step.
+
+How inconsistent unbelief always is! I had no doubt that, if I prayed
+for workers, "_in_ the Name" of the LORD JESUS CHRIST, they would be
+given me. I had no doubt that, in answer to such prayer, the means for
+our going forth would be provided, and that doors would be opened before
+us in unreached parts of the Empire. But I had not then learned to trust
+GOD for _keeping_ power and grace for myself, so no wonder that I could
+not trust Him to keep others who might be prepared to go with me. I
+feared that in the midst of the dangers, difficulties, and trials which
+would necessarily be connected with such a work, some who were
+comparatively inexperienced Christians might break down, and bitterly
+reproach me for having encouraged them to undertake an enterprise for
+which they were unequal.
+
+Yet, what was I to do? The feeling of blood-guiltiness became more and
+more intense. Simply because I refused to ask for them, the labourers
+did not come forward--did not go out to China--and every day tens of
+thousands were passing away to Christless graves! Perishing China so
+filled my heart and mind that there was no rest by day, and little sleep
+by night, till health broke down. At the invitation of my beloved and
+honoured friend, Mr. George Pearse (then of the Stock Exchange), I went
+to spend a few days with him in Brighton.
+
+On Sunday, June 25th, 1865, unable to bear the sight of a congregation
+of a thousand or more Christian people rejoicing in their own security,
+while millions were perishing for lack of knowledge, I wandered out on
+the sands alone, in great spiritual agony; and there the LORD conquered
+my unbelief, and I surrendered myself to GOD for this service. I told
+Him that all the responsibility as to issues and consequences must rest
+with Him; that as His servant, it was mine to obey and to follow
+Him--His, to direct, to care for, and to guide me and those who might
+labour with me. Need I say that peace at once flowed into my burdened
+heart? There and then I asked Him for twenty-four fellow-workers, two
+for each of eleven inland provinces which were without a missionary, and
+two for Mongolia; and writing the petition on the margin of the Bible I
+had with me, I returned home with a heart enjoying rest such as it had
+been a stranger to for months, and with an assurance that the LORD would
+bless His own work and that I should share in the blessing. I had
+previously prayed, and asked prayer, that workers might be raised up for
+the eleven then unoccupied provinces, and thrust forth and provided for,
+but had not surrendered myself to be their leader.
+
+About this time, with the help of my dear wife, I wrote the little book,
+_China's Spiritual Need and Claims_. Every paragraph was steeped in
+prayer. With the help of Mr. Berger, who had given valued aid in the
+revision of the manuscript, and who bore the expense of printing an
+edition of 3000 copies, they were soon put in circulation. I spoke
+publicly of the proposed work as opportunity permitted, specially at the
+Perth and Mildmay Conferences of 1865, and continued in prayer for
+fellow-workers, who were soon raised up, and after due correspondence
+were invited to my home, then in the East of London. When one house
+became insufficient, the occupant of the adjoining house removed, and I
+was able to rent it; and when that in its turn became insufficient,
+further accommodation was provided close by. Soon there were a number of
+men and women under preparatory training, and engaging in evangelistic
+work which tested in some measure their qualifications as soul-winners.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+FOOTNOTES:
+
+[3] Isaiah lv. 8, 9.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIX
+
+THE FORMATION OF THE C. I. M.
+
+
+IT was thus that in the year 1865 the CHINA INLAND MISSION was
+organised; and the workers already in the field were incorporated into
+it. W. T. Berger, Esq., then residing at Saint Hill, near East
+Grinstead, without whose help and encouragement I could not have gone
+forward, undertook the direction of the home department of the work
+during my anticipated absence in China; and I proposed, as soon as
+arrangements could be completed, to go out with the volunteers and take
+the direction of the work in the field. For the support of the workers
+already in China, our friends at home were sending in unsolicited
+contributions from time to time, and every need was met.
+
+We had now, however, to look forward to the outgoing of a party of
+sixteen or seventeen, and estimated that from L1500 to L2000 might be
+required to cover outfits, passage-money, and initial expenses. I wrote
+a little pamphlet, calling it "Occasional Paper, No. I." (intending in
+successive numbers to give to donors and friends accounts of the work
+wrought through us in China), and in that paper stated the anticipated
+needs for floating the enterprise. I expected that GOD would incline the
+hearts of some of the readers to send contributions: I had determined
+never to use personal solicitation, or to make collections, or to issue
+collecting-books. Missionary-boxes were thought unobjectionable, and we
+had a few prepared for those who might ask for them, and have continued
+to use them ever since.
+
+It was February 6th, 1866, when I sent my manuscript of "Occasional
+Paper, No. I.," with a design for the cover, to the printer. From delays
+in engraving and printing, it was March 12th when the bales of pamphlets
+were delivered at my house. Now on February 6th a daily prayer-meeting,
+from 12 to 1 o'clock, had been commenced, to ask for the needed funds.
+And that we had not asked in vain, the following extract from
+"Occasional Paper, No. II." will show:--
+
+"The receipts for 1864 were L51:14s.; for 1865, from January to June,
+L221:12:6, besides two free passages; from June to December, L923:12:8.
+Hindrances having occurred, the MS. of the "Occasional Paper, No. I."
+was not completed till February 6th, 1866. Up to this time we had
+received (from December 30th) L170:8:3.
+
+"We felt much encouraged by the receipt of so much money in little more
+than a month, as it was entirely unsolicited by us--save from GOD. But
+it was also evident that we must ask the LORD to do yet greater things
+for us, or it would be impossible for a party of from ten to sixteen to
+leave in the middle of May. _Daily united prayer was therefore offered
+to_ GOD for the funds needful for the outfits and passages of as many as
+He would have to go out in May.
+
+"Owing to the delays mentioned above in the printing of the 'Occasional
+Paper,' it was not ready for the publisher until March 12th. On this day
+I again examined my mission cash-book, and the comparison of the result
+of the two similar periods of one month and six days each, one before
+and one after special prayer for L1500 to L2000, was very striking:--
+
+ "Receipts from December 30th to February 6th, L170 8 3
+ " Feb. 6th to Mar. 12th L1774 5 11
+ "Funds advised, since received 200 0 0
+ --------- L1974 5 11
+
+"This, it will be noticed, was _previous_ to the circulation of the
+'Occasional Paper,' and, consequently, was not the result of it. It was
+the response of a faithful GOD to the united prayers of those whom He
+had called to serve Him in the Gospel of His dear SON.
+
+"We can now compare with these two periods a third of the same extent.
+From March 12th to April 18th the receipts were L529, showing that when
+GOD had supplied the special need, the special supply also ceased. Truly
+there is a LIVING GOD, and HE is the hearer and answerer of prayer."
+
+But this gracious answer to prayer made it a little difficult to
+circulate "Occasional Paper, No. I.," for it stated as a need that which
+was already supplied. The difficulty was obviated by the issue with each
+copy of a coloured inset stating that the funds for outfit and passage
+were already in hand in answer to prayer. We were reminded of the
+difficulty of Moses--not a very common one in the present day--and of
+the proclamation he had to send through the camp to the people to
+prepare no more for the building of the Tabernacle, as the gifts in hand
+were already too much. We are convinced that if there were _less_
+solicitation for money and _more_ dependence upon the power of the HOLY
+GHOST and upon the deepening of spiritual life, the experience of Moses
+would be a common one in every branch of Christian work.
+
+Preparations for sailing to China were at once proceeded with. About
+this time I was asked to give a lecture on China in a village not very
+far from London, and agreed to do so on condition that there should be
+no collection, and that this should be announced on the bills. The
+gentleman who invited me, and who kindly presided as chairman, said he
+had never had that condition imposed before. He accepted it, however,
+and the bills were issued accordingly for the 2nd or 3rd of May. With
+the aid of a large map, something of the extent and population and deep
+spiritual need of China was presented, and many were evidently
+impressed.
+
+At the close of the meeting the chairman said that by my request it had
+been intimated on the bills that there would be no collection; but he
+felt that many present would be distressed and burdened if they had not
+the opportunity of contributing something towards the good work
+proposed. He trusted that as the proposition emanated entirely from
+himself, and expressed, he felt sure, the feelings of many in the
+audience, I should not object to it. I begged, however, that the
+condition agreed to might be carried out; pointing out among other
+reasons for making no collection, that the very reason adduced by our
+kind chairman was, to my mind, one of the strongest for not making it.
+My wish was, not that those present should be relieved by making such
+contribution as might there and then be convenient, under the influence
+of a present emotion; but that each one should go home burdened with the
+deep need of China, and ask of GOD what He would have them to do. If,
+after thought and prayer, they were satisfied that a pecuniary
+contribution was what He wanted of them, it could be given to any
+Missionary Society having agents in China; or it might be posted to our
+London office; but that perhaps in many cases what GOD wanted was _not_
+a money contribution, but personal consecration to His service abroad;
+or the giving up of son or daughter--more precious than silver or
+gold--to His service. I added that I thought the tendency of a
+collection was to leave the impression that the all-important thing was
+_money_, whereas no amount of money could convert a single soul; that
+what was needed was that men and women filled with the HOLY GHOST should
+give _themselves_ to the work: for the support of such there would never
+be a lack of funds. As my wish was evidently very strong, the chairman
+kindly yielded to it, and closed the meeting. He told me, however, at
+the supper-table, that he thought it was a mistake on my part, and that,
+notwithstanding all I had said, a few persons had put some little
+contributions into his hands.
+
+Next morning at breakfast, my kind host came in a little late, and
+acknowledged to not having had a very good night. After breakfast he
+asked me to his study, and giving me the contributions handed to him the
+night before, said, "I thought last night, Mr. Taylor, that you were in
+the wrong about a collection; I am now convinced you were quite right.
+As I thought in the night of that stream of souls in China ever passing
+onward into the dark, I could only cry as you suggested, 'LORD, what
+wilt Thou have _me_ to do?' I think I have obtained the guidance I
+sought, and here it is." He handed me a cheque for L500, adding that if
+there had been a collection he would have given a few pounds to it, but
+now this cheque was the result of having spent no small part of the
+night in prayer.
+
+I need scarcely say how surprised and thankful I was for this gift. I
+had received at the breakfast-table a letter from Messrs. Killick,
+Martin and Co., shipping agents, in which they stated that they could
+offer us the whole passenger accommodation of the ship _Lammermuir_. I
+went direct to the ship, found it in every way suitable, and paid the
+cheque on account. As above stated, the funds deemed needed had been
+already in hand for some time; but the coincidence of the simultaneous
+offer of the ship accommodation and this munificent gift--GOD'S
+"exceeding abundantly"--greatly encouraged my heart.
+
+On the 26th of May we sailed for China in the _Lammermuir_, a missionary
+party of 16 (besides my four children and their nurse, and Miss Bausum
+(afterwards Mrs. Barchet)); in all 22 passengers. Mr. Berger took charge
+of the home department, and thus the C. I. M. was fully inaugurated.
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XX
+
+THE MISSION IN 1894
+
+
+THE events sketched in the last two chapters have been more fully
+delineated by Miss Guinness in her interesting _Story of the China
+Inland Mission_, which continues its history to the present date. It is
+indeed a record of the goodness of GOD, every remembrance of which calls
+for gratitude and praise. We can only here briefly mention a few facts,
+referring our readers to Miss Guinness's work for all details.
+
+After a voyage of many mercies the _Lammermuir_ party safely reached
+China, and during the first ten years stations and out-stations were
+opened in many cities and towns in four provinces which hitherto had
+been unreached by the Gospel. At home Mr. and Mrs. Berger continued
+their devoted service until March 19th, 1872, I having returned to
+England the year before. Shortly after this the London Council was
+formed, which has now for several years been assisted by an auxiliary
+Council of ladies. A Scotch Council was also formed in Glasgow a few
+years ago.
+
+A visit to America in 1888 issued in the formation of the Council for
+North America, and a similar Council for Australasia was commenced in
+Melbourne two years later. In the field a China Council was organised in
+1886, composed of senior missionaries who meet quarterly in Shanghai.
+
+Closely associated with the C. I. M. are seven Committees--in England,
+Norway, Sweden (two), Finland, Germany, and the United States--which
+send out and support their own missionaries, who in China have the
+assistance of the educational and other advantages of the C. I. M., and
+who work under its direction.
+
+The staff of the Mission, in May 1893, consisted of 552 missionaries
+(including wives and associates). There were also 326 native helpers (95
+of whom were unpaid), working as pastors, evangelists, teachers,
+colporteurs, Bible-women, etc., in 14 different provinces.
+
+Duly qualified candidates for missionary labour are accepted without
+restriction as to denomination, provided they are sound in the faith in
+all fundamental truths: these go out in dependence upon GOD for temporal
+supplies, with the clear understanding that the officers of the Mission
+do not guarantee any income whatever; and knowing that as they will not
+go into debt, they can only minister to them as the funds sent in from
+time to time will allow. But we praise GOD that during the past
+twenty-eight years such ministry has always been possible; our GOD _has_
+supplied all our need, and has withheld no good thing.
+
+All the expenses of the Mission at home and abroad are met by voluntary
+contributions, sent to the offices of the Mission without personal
+solicitation, by those who wish to aid in this effort to spread the
+knowledge of the Gospel throughout China. The income for the year 1892
+was about L34,000 from all sources--Great Britain, the Continent of
+Europe, North America, Australasia, China, etc.
+
+Some of the missionaries having private property have gone out at their
+own expense, and do not take anything from the Mission funds.
+
+Stations have been opened in ten of the eleven provinces which were
+previously without Protestant missionaries; from one of these, however,
+we have had to retire. The eleventh province has been visited several
+times, and it is hoped that in it permanent work may soon be begun.
+
+More than 200 stations and out-stations have been opened in fourteen of
+the eighteen provinces, in all of which stations either missionaries or
+native labourers are resident. Over 6000 converts have been baptized
+from the commencement, some 4000 of whom are now living and in
+fellowship.
+
+
+THE MISSION IN 1902
+
+The year 1894, in which the first edition of _A Retrospect_ appeared,
+was marked by the erection of large and commodious premises for the work
+of the Mission, and early in the following year the houses in Pyrland
+Road, which had so long formed the home of the Mission in England, were
+vacated, and NEWINGTON GREEN, LONDON, N., became the address of the
+Mission offices and home.
+
+From that date until the Boxer outbreak of 1900 the Mission made steady
+progress, the development of the work in China being accompanied by
+corresponding developments in the home departments of the Mission in
+England, America, and Australasia.
+
+In January 1900, before the Boxer outbreak, there were in connection
+with the Mission, 811 missionaries, including wives and associates; 171
+stations; 223 out-stations; 387 chapels; 581 paid native helpers; 193
+unpaid native helpers; 8557 communicants in fellowship, 12,964 having
+been baptized from the commencement. There were 266 organised churches;
+788 boarding scholars; 1382 day scholars; 6 hospitals; 18 dispensaries;
+and 46 opium refuges.
+
+During the terrible year of 1900, when no fewer than 135 missionaries
+and 53 missionaries' children and many thousands of Chinese Christians
+were cruelly murdered, the China Inland Mission lost 58 missionaries and
+21 children. The records of these unparalleled times of suffering have
+been told in _Martyred Missionaries of the China Inland Mission_ and in
+_Last Letters_, both of which books will be found advertised at the end
+of this volume. Apart from loss of life, there was an immense amount of
+Mission property destroyed, and the missionaries were compelled to
+retire from their stations in most parts of China.
+
+The doors closed by this outbreak have all been reopened in the goodness
+of GOD. In those districts which suffered most from the massacres the
+work has largely been one of reorganisation; but throughout China
+generally there has been a spirit of awakening and a time of enlarged
+opportunity; which is a loud call for more men and women to volunteer to
+step into the gaps and fill the places of those who have fallen.
+
+Among recent developments we would specially mention the opening of a
+new home centre at Philadelphia, U.S.A. The total income of the Mission
+for 1901 was L53,633 = $257,712, and the total received in England
+alone, for 1902, was L51,446 = $246,912. The total membership of the
+Mission in June 1902 was 761.
+
+Current information about the progress of the work in China may be
+obtained from _China's Millions_, the organ of the Mission. It is
+published monthly, and may be ordered through any bookseller from
+Messrs. Morgan and Scott, 12 Paternoster Buildings, E.C., for 1s. per
+year, or direct by post from the offices of the Mission, Newington
+Green, London, N., for 1s. 6d. per annum.
+
+The Australasian edition of _China's Millions_ may be ordered at the
+same price from M. L. Hutchinson, Little Collins Street, or from the
+Mission Offices, 267 Collins Street, Melbourne. The North American
+edition will be sent post free from the Mission Offices, 507 Church
+Street, Toronto, for 50 cents per annum.
+
+Prayer meetings on behalf of the work in China are held at the principal
+home centres of the Mission, as follows: Every Saturday afternoon from 4
+to 6 o'clock, at Newington Green, London. Every Friday evening at 8
+o'clock, at 507 Church Street, Toronto. Every Saturday afternoon at 4
+o'clock, in the Office, 267 Collins Street, Melbourne. A hearty
+invitation to attend any one of these meetings is given to any one
+residing in or visiting any of these cities.
+
+Donations to the Mission, applications from candidates, orders for
+literature, requests for deputation speakers, and other correspondence
+should be forwarded to
+
+ The Secretary,
+ China Inland Mission,
+ Newington Green, London, N.
+
+ The Home Director,
+ China Inland Mission,
+ 507 Church Street, Toronto, Canada.
+
+or
+
+ 702 Witherspoon Buildings, Philadelphia, U.S.A.
+
+or to
+
+ The Secretary,
+ China Inland Mission,
+ 267 Collins Street, Melbourne, Australia.
+
+[Illustration: MAP OF CHINA
+
+ Shewing {1. All Protestant Mission Stations in China up to June 1866,
+ when the C.I.M. was founded (they numbered fifteen) These
+ are underlined in black.
+ {2. The Stations of the China Inland Mission which (with the
+ exception of Ning-Po & Fung-hwa) have been opened since
+ June 1866. These are printed in red.]
+
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+STATIONS OF THE CHINA INLAND MISSION
+
+1900
+
+(BEFORE THE BOXER OUTBREAK)
+
+
+The best guide to the stations of the Mission is the new _China Inland
+Mission Map_ (size 44 x 38 in., mounted on linen, coloured, varnished,
+and hung on rollers), price 8s. _net_, carriage and packing extra.
+Mounted to fold, 8s. _net_, post free.
+
+ Provinces.[4] Stations.[5] WORK BEGUN.
+
+ =Kan-suh=, 1876 LIANG-CHAU 1888
+ SI-NING 1885
+ LAN-CHAU 1885
+ TS'IN-CHAU 1878
+ _Area,[6] 125,450 square miles._ FU K'IANG 1899
+ _Population, 9,285,377._ P'ING-LIANG 1895
+ KING-CHAU 1895
+ TS'ING-NING 1897
+ Chen-yuen 1897
+ Tong-chi 1899
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Shen-si=, 1876. Lung-chau 1893
+ FENG-TSIANG 1888
+ Mei-hien 1893
+ K'IEN-CHAU 1894
+ _Area, 67,400 square miles._ Chau-chih 1893
+ _Population, 8,432,193._ _Sang-kia-chuang_ 1894
+ Hing-p'ing 1893
+ SI-GAN 1893
+ _Ying-kia-wei_ 1893
+ Chen-kia-hu 1897
+ Lan-t'ien 1895
+ K'ien-yang 1897
+ Ch'ang-wu 1897
+ San-shui 1897
+ T'UNG-CHAU 1891
+ Han-ch'eng 1897
+ HAN-CHUNG 1879
+ Ch'eng-ku 1887
+ Si-hsiang 1896
+ Yang-hien 1896
+ HING-AN 1898
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Shan-si=, 1876 TA-T'UNG 1886
+ Hwen-yuen 1898
+ SOH-P'ING 1895
+ Tsoe-yuin 1895
+ YING-CHAU 1897
+ Hiao-i 1887
+ Kiai-hiu 1891
+ SIH-CHAU 1885
+ Ta-ning 1885
+ KIH-CHAU 1891
+ Ho-tsin 1893
+ Ping-yao 1888
+ _Area, 56,268 square miles._ HOH-CHAU 1886
+ _Population, 12,211,453._ Hung-t'ung 1886
+ Yoh-yang 1896
+ P'ING-YANG 1879
+ K'ueh-wu 1885
+ I-shi 1891
+ Yuein-ch'eng 1888
+ _Mei-ti-kiai_ 1895
+ HIAI-CHAU 1895
+ Lu-ch'eng 1889
+ _Ue-wu_ 1896
+ LU-GAN 1889
+ Kiang-chau 1898
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Chih-li=, 1887 T'IEN-TSIN 1888
+ _Area, 58,949 square miles._ PAO-T'ING 1891
+ _Population, 17,937,000._ Hwuy-luh 1887
+ SHUN-TEH 1888
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Shan-tung=, 1879 _Chefoo_ 1879
+ " Sanatorium 1880
+ " Boys' School 1880
+ _Area, 53,762 square miles._ " Girls' " 1884
+ _Population, 36,247,835._ " Preparatory School 1895
+ _T'ung-shin_ 1889
+ Ning-hai 1886
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Ho-nan=, 1875 Siang-ch'eng 1891
+ _Chau-kia-k'eo_ 1884
+ _Ho-nan_ ...
+ _Ho-peh_ ...
+ _Ho-si_ ...
+ _Area, 66,913 square miles._ CH'EN-CHAU 1895
+ _Population, 22,115,827._ T'ai-k'ang 1895
+ _She-k'i-tien_ 1886
+ Kwang-chau 1899
+ Hin-an 1899
+ _King-tsi-kuan_ 1896
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =W. Si-ch'uan=, 1877 Kwan-hien 1889
+ CH'EN-TU 1881
+ KIA-TING 1888
+ _Area of whole Province, SUI-FU 1888
+ 166,800 square miles._ LU-CHAU 1890
+ Hiao-shi 1899
+ CH'UNG-K'ING 1877
+ Ta-chien-lu 1897
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =E. Si-ch'uan=, 1886 Kwang-yuen 1889
+ _Sin-tien-tsi_ 1892
+ PAO-NING 1886
+ Ying-shan 1898
+ _Population of whole Province, Kue-hien 1898
+ 67,712,897._ SHUN-K'ING 1896
+ Pa-chau 1887
+ SUI-TING 1899
+ Wan-hien 1888
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Hu-peh=, 1874 _Lao-ho-k'eo_ 1887
+ _Area, 70,450 square miles._ _Han-kow_ 1889
+ _Population, 34,244,685._ I-CH'ANG 1895
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Gan-hwuy=, 1869 T'ai-ho 1892
+ VING-CHAU 1897
+ _Ch'eng-yang-kwan_ 1887
+ _K'u-ch'eng_ 1887
+ Fuh-hing-tsih (Lai-gan) 1898
+ LUH-GAN 1890
+ GAN-K'ING 1869
+ _Area, 48,461 square miles._ Training Home ...
+ _Population, 20,596,288._ Wu-hu 1893
+ Kien-p'ing 1894
+ NING-KWOH 1874
+ KWANG-TEH 1890
+ CH'I-CHAU 1889
+ Kien-teh 1892
+ HWUY-CHAU 1884
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Kiang-su=, 1854 Gan-tung 1891
+ Ts'ing-kiang-pu 1869
+ Kao-yiu 1888
+ YANG-CHAU 1868
+ Training Home ...
+ CHIN-KIANG 1888
+ _Area, 44,500 square miles._ Shanghai 1854
+ _Population, 20,905,171._ Financial Department ...
+ Business Department ...
+ Home ...
+ Hospital ...
+ Evangelistic Work ...
+ Literary Work ...
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Yun-nan=, 1877 Bhamo (Upper Burmah) 1875
+ _Area, 107,969 square miles._ TA-LI 1881
+ _Population, 11,721,576._ YUN-NAN 1882
+ K'UeH-TS'ING 1889
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Kwei-chau=, 1877 KWEI-YANG 1877
+ GAN-SHUN 1888
+ _Area, 64,554 square miles._ Tuh-shan 1893
+ _Population, 7,669,181._ HING-I 1891
+ (Work among Aborigines) ...
+ _P'ang-hai_ 1897
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Hu-nan=, 1875 CH'ANG-TEH 1898
+ _Area, 74,320 square miles_. SHEN-CHAU 1898
+ _Population, 21,002,604._ Ch'a-ling 1898
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Kiang-si=, 1869 KIU-KIANG 1889
+ Ku-ling Sanatorium 1898
+ _Ta-ku-t'ang_ 1873
+ NAN-K'ANG 1887
+ Gan-ren 1889
+ RAO-CHAU 1898
+ _Peh-kan_ 1893
+ Kwei-k'i 1878
+ _Shang-ts'ing_ 1893
+ Hue-wan 1899
+ Ih-yang 1890
+ _Area, 72,176 square miles._ _Ho-k'eo_ 1878
+ _Population, 24,534,118._ _Yang-k'eo_ 1890
+ Kwang-feng 1889
+ Yuh-shan 1877
+ _Chang-shu_ 1895
+ KUI-GAN 1891
+ _Feng-kang_ 1891
+ KAN-CHAU 1899
+ Sin-feng 1899
+ LIN-KIANG 1898
+ NAN-CH'ANG 1898
+ UEN-CHAU (_Itinerating_) ...
+ Yung-sin 1899
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------
+ =Cheh-kiang=, 1857 HANG-CHAU 1866
+ SHAO-HING 1866
+ Sin-ch'ang 1870
+ KIU-CHAU 1872
+ Ch'ang-shan 1878
+ Lan-k'i 1894
+ _Area, 39,150 square miles_. KIN-HWA 1875
+ _Population, 11,588,692._ Yung-k'ang 1882
+ Tseh-k'i 1897
+ CH'U-CHAU 1875
+ Lung-ch'uen 1894
+ Uin-ho 1895
+ Song-yang 1896
+ _Siao-mei_ 1896
+ Tsin-yun 1898
+ NING-P'O 1857
+ Fung-hwa 1866
+ Ning-hai 1868
+ T'ien-t'ai 1898
+ T'AI-CHAU 1867
+ Ling-he District ...
+ Hwang-yen 1896
+ T'ai-p'ing 1898
+ WUN-CHAU 1867
+ Bing-yae 1874
+
+FOOTNOTES:
+
+[4] Arranged in three lines from west to east, for easy reference to
+Map. The dates in this column in many cases are of itinerations begun.
+
+[5] Capitals of Provinces in capital letters; of Prefectures in small
+capitals; and of Counties in romans; Market Towns in italics.
+
+[6] Areas and populations are from _The Statesman's Year Book_.
+
+
+[Illustration]
+
+_Printed by_ R. & R. CLARK, LIMITED, _Edinburgh._
+
+ * * * * *
+
+Transcriber's Notes:
+
+Page 109, "my" changed to "My" (My marriage had been)
+
+Page 125, ending ) added. (Miss Bausum (afterwards Mrs. Barchett)); in)
+
+Page 129, format of "God" was changed to "GOD" to match rest of usage.
+(goodness of GOD)
+
+Possible nconsistencies in spelling of Chinese names were retained such
+as Bhamo and Bhamo.
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of A Retrospect, by James Hudson Taylor
+
+*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK A RETROSPECT ***
+
+***** This file should be named 26744.txt or 26744.zip *****
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+ http://www.gutenberg.org/2/6/7/4/26744/
+
+Produced by Free Elf, Emmy and the Online Distributed
+Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net Music files created
+by Linda Cantoni.(This file was produced from images
+generously made available by The Internet Archive/Canadian
+Libraries) Full-color map generously provided by The
+Missionary E-texts Archive at
+http://www.missionaryetexts.org
+
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+http://gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH F3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need, is critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at http://www.pglaf.org.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at
+http://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at http://pglaf.org
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit http://pglaf.org
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations.
+To donate, please visit: http://pglaf.org/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ http://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.